The Notebooks of Leonardo Da Vinci Complete PDF
The Notebooks of Leonardo Da Vinci Complete PDF
The Notebooks of Leonardo Da Vinci Complete PDF
By
Leonardo Da Vinci
1
PREFACE.
A singular fatality has ruled the destiny of nearly all the most
much more by his word than in fact or by deed", and the biographer
2
interest which has been attached to the change of ownership of
in rude characters, and with the left hand, so that any one who is
one long one, or, again, he would quite arbitrarily divide a long
3
whatever to regulate the division and construction of the sentences,
nor are there any accents--and the reader may imagine that such
have failed.
without any connection. A page, for instance, will begin with some
not think that the publication of the texts in the order in which
4
they occur in the originals would at all fulfil his intentions. No
reader could find his way through such a labyrinth; Leonardo himself
Added to this, more than half of the five thousand manuscript pages
which now remain to us, are written on loose leaves, and at present
more or less extent. Nay, even in the volumes, the pages of which
when first writing down his notes, was that each observation should
writings?
What this final arrangement was to be, Leonardo has in most cases
5
this are not insuperable; for, as the subject of the separate
state that I have devoted especial care and thought to the due
any serious interruption till his death. Thus the Manuscripts that
judge from it of the date of any particular text. The exact dates,
not been altered since Leonardo used them. The assistance these
6
sequence with reference to the subjects; while the letters and
the end of Volume II, can, in every instance, easily ascertain, not
merely the period to which the passage belongs, but also exactly
derived from the original texts, which were supposed to have been
lost, but from early copies, in which Leonardo's text had been more
or less mutilated, and which were all fragmentary. The oldest and on
7
the whole the best copy of Leonardo's essays and precepts on
this ancient copy, and the published editions of it, contain much
the human figure--are wholly wanting; on the other hand they contain
passages which, if they are genuine, cannot now be verified from any
of the Vatican copy, which would seem to be the source whence all
the published and extensively known texts were derived; for, instead
8
Manuscripts, and was so happy as to discover among them the original
it gave the key to the mystery which had so long enveloped the first
9
to the Librarians of these various collections for much assistance
Museum, Mr. Holmes, the Queens Librarian at Windsor, the Revd Vere
In correcting the Italian text for the press, I have had the
Senatore del Regno, and from Signor Gustavo Frizzoni, of Milan. The
thanks to Mr. Alfred Marks, of Long Ditton, who has most kindly
10
It is scarcely necessary to add that most of the drawings here
that we should not, long since, have known Leonardo, not merely as a
can be no doubt that in more than one department his principles and
modern science, than with the views of his contemporaries. For this
reason his extraordinary gifts and merits are far more likely to be
appreciated in our own time than they could have been during the
having hardly begun, throwing them aside. The truth is that the
Alexander von Humboldt has borne witness that "he was the first to
start on the road towards the point where all the impressions of our
senses converge in the idea of the Unity of Nature" Nay, yet more
may be said. The very words which are inscribed on the monument of
11
genius:
F. P. R.
12
CONTENTS OF VOLUME I.
II.
LINEAR PERSPECTIVE
13
nature of the outline (49).--Definition of perspective (50).--The
III.
14
the nature of shadows (119--122).--Of the various kinds of shadows
15
(208--210).--Appendix:--On shadows in movement (211--212).--SIXTH
IV.
PERSPECTIVE OF DISAPPEARANCE
V.
THEORY OF COLOURS
16
the reflection of colours (281--283).--On the use of dark and light
(287--288).
VI.
VII.
17
336).--The relative proportions of the torso and of the foot
(390--392).
VIII.
18
the position of the spectator (441--443).--The effects of morning
IX.
19
(509).--On the construction of windows (510--512).--On the best
20
637).--On chemical materials (638--650).--VII. PHILOSOPHY AND
X.
1.
21
How by a certain machine many may stay some time under water. And
water and how long I can remain without eating. And I do not publish
nor divulge these, by reason of the evil nature of men, who would
ships, and sinking them, together with the men in them. Nevertheless
I will impart others, which are not dangerous because the mouth of
the tube through which you breathe is above the water, supported on
the words Casi 39, and most of these cases begin with the word
'Come', like the two here given, which are the 26th and 27th. 7.
drawn with the pen, representing a man with a tube in his mouth, and
at the farther end of the tube a disk. By the tube the word
2.
When you put together the science of the motions of water, remember
22
[Footnote: A comparatively small portion of Leonardo's notes on
Admonition to readers.
3.
4.
order, taken from many papers which I have copied here, hoping to
which they may treat. But I believe that before I am at the end of
this [task] I shall have to repeat the same things several times;
for which, O reader! do not blame me, for the subjects are many and
memory cannot retain them [all] and say: 'I will not write this
copy [a passage] that, not to repeat myself, I should read over all
that had gone before; and all the more since the intervals are long
23
between one time of writing and the next.
his death left four books on Mathematics ready for the press; comp.
Series Vol. I., where this passage is printed, Barto has been
Florence at that time from the Incarnation (Lady day, March 25th).
must suppose that Leonardo means that he has copied out his own MSS.
and not those of others. The first thirteen leaves of the MS. in the
subjects.(5-8).
5.
24
proving them bring forward the propositions already proved. And this
any plan you would be obliged again to devise new machines to prove
its utility and thus would confuse the order of the forty Books and
also the order of the diagrams; that is to say you would have to mix
incoherent work.
6.
7.
The Book of the science of Mechanics must precede the Book of useful
carried out his purpose with one of the Books on anatomy. A borrowed
25
8.
The order of your book must proceed on this plan: first simple
9.
INTRODUCTION.
pleasing--since the men who have come before me have taken for their
own every useful or necessary theme--I must do like one who, being
poor, comes last to the fair, and can find no other way of providing
himself than by taking all the things already seen by other buyers,
and not taken but refused by reason of their lesser value. I, then,
distribute it, not indeed in great cities, but in the poorer towns,
26
irony. In the second and third prefaces, Leonardo characterises his
10.
INTRODUCTION.
I know that many will call this useless work [Footnote: 3. questa
Poliorcetes. Who then can it be--for the name is a very common one?
It may be a clerical error for Demades and the maxim is quite in the
spirit of his writings I have not however been able to find any
The same passage occurs as a simple Memorandum in the MS. Tr. 57,
27
that he took no more account of the wind that came out their mouth
in words, than of that they expelled from their lower parts: men who
desire nothing but material riches and are absolutely devoid of that
of wisdom, which is the food and the only true riches of the mind.
For so much more worthy as the soul is than the body, so much more
noble are the possessions of the soul than those of the body. And
often, when I see one of these men take this work in his hand, I
wonder that he does not put it to his nose, like a monkey, or ask me
dell'uffitio dell'occhio (see No. 21) stands between this and the
INTRODUCTION.
presumptuous persons will think that they may reasonably blame me;
28
MENDELSON of Dorpat, the editor of Herodian, assures me that no such
.... che d'altra parola. This can hardly be reconciled with Mons.
l'art que dans la science et il tenait a passer pour tel meme aux
yeux de la posterite." Gaz. des Beaux arts. Oct. 1877.]; but they
[experience] has been the mistress of those who wrote well. And so,
11.
Though I may not, like them, be able to quote other authors, I shall
29
dressed and decorated with [the fruits], not of their own labours,
but of those of others. And they will not allow me my own. They will
scorn me as an inventor; but how much more might they--who are not
blamed.
INTRODUCTION.
And those men who are inventors and interpreters between Nature and
the mirror. For the first is something in itself, and the other
chance that they wear the human form and without it I might class
12.
that my works are the issue of pure and simple experience, who is
the one true mistress. These rules are sufficient to enable you to
know the true from the false--and this aids men to look only for
things that are possible and with due moderation--and not to wrap
30
yourself in ignorance, a thing which can have no good result, so
13.
Among all the studies of natural causes and reasons Light chiefly
to the reader. They are however but few.]. But its axioms being laid
from the causes, and sometimes arguing the causes from the effects;
31
VITELLONE, with whose works Leonardo was certainly familiar, and by
all the writers of the Renaissance Perspective and Optics were not
deals only with Optics, it is not improbable that the words partirò
14.
There are three branches of perspective; the first deals with the
contains the way in which colours vary as they recede from the eye.
The third and last is concerned with the explanation of how the
32
Linear Perspective. The Perspective of Colour. The Perspective of
Disappearance.
15.
distances.
No. 14, and this is worthy of note when we connect it with the fact
16.
33
Perspective, as bearing on drawing, is divided into three principal
17.
structure of] the eye, while the other two are caused by the
atmosphere which intervenes between the eye and the objects seen by
variety in the figures, so that the men may not all look like
brothers, &c.
[Footnote: This and the two foregoing chapters must have been
34
Leonardo wished to carry out in arranging his researches on
by the French (!) in 1500 (see H. LUDWIG. L. da Vinci: Das Buch van
18.
These rules are of use only in correcting the figures; since every
man makes some mistakes in his first compositions and he who knows
them not, cannot amend them. But you, knowing your errors, will
correct your works and where you find mistakes amend them, and
remember never to fall into them again. But if you try to apply
these rules in composition you will never make an end, and will
These rules will enable you to have a free and sound judgment; since
35
rules, you will be able, merely by your amended judgment, to
else.
19.
Those who are in love with practice without knowledge are like the
sailor who gets into a ship without rudder or compass and who never
gateway; and without this nothing can be done well in the matter of
drawing.
20.
The painter who draws merely by practice and by eye, without any
36
21.
forefathers, the ancients, who tried to define what the Soul and
Life are--which are beyond proof, whereas those things, which can at
of the eye. Leonardo also refers to the science of the eye, in his
&c. Compare also MS. E 15b and F 60b. The principles of astronomical
perspective.]
22.
Here [in the eye] forms, here colours, here the character of every
37
so marvellous a thing ... Oh! marvellous, O stupendous Necessity--by
thy laws thou dost compel every effect to be the direct result of
the diameters of all the images in the eye and the distance from
23.
Distance and Propinquity, Motion and Rest. This little work of mine
painter of the rules and methods by which he should use his art to
24.
ON PAINTING.
38
1st. The pupil of the eye contracts, in proportion to the increase
of light which is reflected in it. 2nd. The pupil of the eye expands
eye perceives and recognises the objects of its vision with greater
and certain birds--as the owl and others--in which the pupil varies
light. 5th. All colours when placed in the shade appear of an equal
placed in a full light, never vary from their true and essential
hue.
25.
OF THE EYE.
Focus of sight.
39
object can never be seen perfectly unless the space between it and
26.
OF THE EYE.
When both eyes direct the pyramid of sight to an object, that object
27.
Objects seen by one and the same eye appear sometimes large, and
sometimes small.
28.
seem as though the object at rest had acquired the motion of the
ON PAINTING.
Objects in relief, when seen from a short distance with one eye,
40
look like a perfect picture. If you look with the eye a, b at
29.
Let the object in relief t be seen by both eyes; if you will look
at the object with the right eye m, keeping the left eye n shut,
shut the right eye and open the left, the object (will occupy the)
space b; and if you open both eyes, the object will no longer
does when seen by both eyes; and why should a picture seen with one
eye give the same effect of relief as real relief would under the
that the face in which the eyes m and n are placed is opposite
to the spectator.]
30.
41
(30-39).
The eye will hold and retain in itself the image of a luminous body
better than that of a shaded object. The reason is that the eye is
in itself perfectly dark and since two things that are alike cannot
gives more distinctness, and counteracts and differs from the usual
31.
This happens because the pupil of the eye is much smaller at midday
32.
The pupil which is largest will see objects the largest. This is
in the sky. When the eye comes out of darkness and suddenly looks up
at these bodies, they at first appear larger and then diminish; and
would see them smaller still, because a smaller part of the pupil
42
would exercise its function.
33.
When the eye, coming out of darkness suddenly sees a luminous body,
it will appear much larger at first sight than after long looking at
it. The illuminated object will look larger and more brilliant, when
seen with two eyes than with only one. A luminous object will appear
34.
Why when the eye has just seen the light, does the half light look
dark to it, and in the same way if it turns from the darkness the
35.
ON PAINTING.
place in shadow, this will look very much darker than it really is.
43
This happens only because the eye when out in the air contracts the
luminous. And the more the pupil contracts, the less luminous do the
objects appear that it sees. But as soon as the eye enters into a
This occurs because the greater the darkness into which the pupil
goes the more its size increases, and this increase makes the
other places.]
36.
ON PERSPECTIVE.
The eye which turns from a white object in the light of the sun and
goes into a less fully lighted place will see everything as dark.
And this happens either because the pupils of the eyes which have
have lost more than 3/4 of their size; and, lacking in size, they
are also deficient in [seeing] power. Though you might say to me: A
little bird (then) coming down would see comparatively little, and
from the smallness of his pupils the white might seem black! To this
44
I should reply that here we must have regard to the proportion of
the mass of that portion of the brain which is given up to the sense
into the shade, nor, in the same way, out of the shade into the
37.
the sky is darker the stars appear of larger size, and if you were
to light up the medium these stars would look smaller; and this
difference arises solely from the pupil which dilates and contracts
the eye and the luminous body. Let the experiment be made, by
placing a candle above your head at the same time that you look at a
star; then gradually lower the candle till it is on a level with the
ray that comes from the star to the eye, and then you will see the
star diminish so much that you will almost lose sight of it.
accompanying diagram.]
45
38.
The pupil of the eye, in the open air, changes in size with every
degree of motion from the sun; and at every degree of its changes
one and the same object seen by it will appear of a different size;
39.
brightness, that make any less brilliant spot seem dark until the
eye has lost the last trace of the impression of the stronger light.
II.
Linear Perspective.
We see clearly from the concluding sentence of section 49, where the
46
art of Painting. They are therefore here placed at the beginning. In
have borrowed the broad lines of his theory from some views commonly
accepted among painters at the time; but he certainly worked out its
this theory has any scientific value at the present day; so much as
this, at any rate, seems certain: that from the artist's point of
47
inalienable condition of the existence of objects in space; on the
other hand, by a natural law, the eye, whatever it sees and wherever
attracts iron".
the Camera obscura, and this is all the more interesting and
From the principle of the transmission of the image to the eye and
48
General remarks on perspective (40-41).
40.
ON PAINTING.
41.
42.
All the problems of perspective are made clear by the five terms of
superficies and the solid. The point is unique of its kind. And the
The line is of three kinds, straight, curved and sinuous and it has
49
excepting in its length, and its ends are two points. The angle is
43.
44.
and this is proved because the natural point has continuity, and any
author says: 'In prima he da sapere che punto è quella parie della
45.
50
of one body is that which begins another. 3, that which is not part
separable from this point, and these when reunited become one again;
46.
surface of each. All the surfaces of a body are not parts of that
body.
47.
The line has in itself neither matter nor substance and may rather
51
be called an imaginary idea than a real object; and this being its
48.
OF DRAWING OUTLINE.
Consider with the greatest care the form of the outlines of every
49.
52
The boundaries of bodies are the least of all things. The
surface; nor is it part of the air surrounding that body, but is the
medium interposted between the air and the body, as is proved in its
lines, and above all when representing objects smaller than nature;
for not only will their external outlines become indistinct, but
50.
Definition of Perspective.
all the objects placed before it. I say in a pyramid, because there
is no object so small that it will not be larger than the spot where
these pyramids are received into the eye. Therefore, if you extend
the lines from the edges of each body as they converge you will
bring them to a single point, and necessarily the said lines must
form a pyramid.]
53
[Perspective is nothing more than a rational demonstration applied
the name I apply to the lines which, starting from the surface and
point.]
that every object sends its image to the eye by a pyramid of lines;
from the other. By a pyramid of lines I mean those which start from
[Footnote: 50. 1-5. Compare with this the Proem. No. 21. The
54
51.
Supposing that the ball figured above is the ball of the eye and let
the small portion of the ball which is cut off by the line s t be
the pupil and all the objects mirrored on the centre of the face of
the eye, by means of the pupil, pass on at once and enter the pupil,
the pupil with the things seen by means of the light. And the pupil
And you must know that the pupil transmits nothing perfectly to the
by the pupil they are not perfectly taken in, because they do not
coincide with the line a b. And the proof is this: If the eye,
shown above, wants to count the letters placed in front, the eye
discern them unless they lie in the line a b; as, for instance, in
the line a c. All visible objects reach the eye by the lines of a
pyramid, and the point of the pyramid is the apex and centre of it,
55
[Footnote: 51. In this problem the eye is conceived of as fixed and
52.
lines.
this point. This being the case it is inevitable that the lines
which come from the object to the point must form a pyramid. And if
any man seeks to prove that the sense of sight does not reside in
this point, but rather in the black spot which is visible in the
middle of the pupil, I might reply to him that a small object could
56
than the said [black] spot would never be seen as a whole; as may be
lines which reach the eye. Let e d be the grains of millet within
these lines. You plainly see that these will never diminish by
it. Therefore you must confess that the eye contains within itself
an opening in the eye, you must confess that the smaller object
53.
PERSPECTIVE.
objects which diminish. The eye can never be a true judge for
of the eye which sees them on that side, excepting by means of the
57
and c n are of a given length and the eye n is in the centre,
from n, therefore it will look smaller. And the same effect will
appear in the three divisions of a face when the eye of the painter
painting.
54.
If you look at the sun or some other luminous body and then shut
your eyes you will see it again inside your eye for a long time.
55.
ELEMENTS OF PERSPECTIVE.
All objects transmit their image to the eye in pyramids, and the
nearer to the eye these pyramids are intersected the smaller will
the image appear of the objects which cause them. Therefore, you may
58
exclusively to the third diagram. For the better understanding of
horizontally (comp. lines 11, 14, 17) for which the word pianura
in the plane a n.
The eye f and the eye t are one and the same thing; but the eye
f marks the distance, that is to say how far you are standing from
the object; and the eye t shows you the direction of it; that is
object you are looking at. And remember that the eye f and the eye
t must always be kept on the same level. For example if you raise
or lower the eye from the distance point f you must do the same
with the direction point t. And if the point f shows how far the
eye is distant from the square plane but does not show on which side
direction and not the distance, in order to ascertain both you must
use both points and they will be one and the same thing. If the eye
f could see a perfect square of which all the sides were equal to
side towards the eye a pole were placed, or some other straight
59
object, set up by a perpendicular line as shown at r s--then, I
say, that if you were to look at the side of the square that is
s, and then look at the farther side and it would appear to you at
objects all placed on the same level, one beyond another, the more
remote they are the higher they will seem, up to the level of the
eye, but no higher; because objects placed upon the level on which
infinity--would never be seen above the eye; since the eye has in
itself the point towards which all the cones tend and converge which
convey the images of the objects to the eye. And this point always
we can see. And from the base line of the first pyramid as far as
[Footnote: The two diagrams above the chapter are explained by the
first five lines. They have, however, more letters than are referred
remark.]
56.
to this point. And from the first base where the vertical plane is
60
placed towards the point in the eye there will be only pyramids
always in a straight line opposite the eye and always moves as the
eye moves--just as when a rod is moved its shadow moves, and moves
with it, precisely as the shadow moves with a body. And each point
intervening vertical plane. But although their bases are equal their
termination of a smaller angle than that of the eye. If you ask me:
reply--so far as concerns the diminishing point which moves with you
which come down with their ends to the path where you are walking,
and you will see that each pair of furrows will look as though they
connection with the preceding I may here remark that the square
57.
61
How to measure the pyramid of vision.
this: If you look into the eye of another person you will see your
own image. Now imagine 2 lines starting from your ears and going to
the ears of that image which you see in the other man's eye; you
will understand that these lines converge in such a way that they
would meet in a point a little way beyond your own image mirrored in
the eye. And if you want to measure the diminution of the pyramid in
the air which occupies the space between the object seen and the
forwards till its ends correspond with those of the tower [Footnote
9: I sua stremi .. della storre (its ends ... of the tower) this
and you will see that the image of the tower seems smaller, as at r
o. Then [again] bring it closer to the eye and you will see the rod
project far beyond the image of the tower from a to b and from
58.
PERSPECTIVE.
62
The instant the atmosphere is illuminated it will be filled with an
and colours assembled in it. And the eye is the target, a loadstone,
of these images.
59.
The whole surface of opaque bodies displays its whole image in all
60.
images of the objects that exist in it, and not their forms merely
but their nature may be clearly seen by the sun, which is a hot and
matter, absorbs light and heat, and reflects in itself the image of
the source of that heat and splendour and, in each minutest portion,
does the same. The Northpole does the same as the loadstone shows;
and the moon and the other planets, without suffering any
diminution, do the same. Among terrestrial things musk does the same
61.
63
All bodies together, and each by itself, give off to the surrounding
complete, each conveying the nature, colour and form of the body
through which they transmit the objects by lines which intersect and
cause reversed pyramids, from the objects, so that they are upside
down on the dark plane where they are first reflected. The reason of
this is--
The text breaks off at line 8. The paragraph No.40 follows here in
64
62.
diverge to form a base, and immediately, from the base the same
and angles are produced from it; and these lines, distributing
equal to the larger angle; and if the base goes twice into each of
the 2 lines of the pyramid the smaller triangle will do the same.
63.
Every body in light and shade fills the surrounding air with
in the air, represent this body throughout space and on every side.
within itself an infinite number of pyramids and each has the same
vision will give to their object angles of equal size; and an eye at
each point will see the object of the same size. The body of the
straight lines, which are produced from the surface of the bodies in
65
light and shade, existing in the air; and the farther they are from
the object which produces them the more acute they become and
of equal power [and value]; all equal to each, and each equal to
in each minutest part, the whole form of the body causing it.
64.
each other and pass through all the surrounding atmosphere; and are
of equal force and value--all being equal to each, each to all. And
65.
PERSPECTIVE.
66
The air is filled with endless images of the objects distributed in
it; and all are represented in all, and all in one, and all in each,
second and the second in the first. The first being reflected in the
as that each mirror has within it a mirror, each smaller than the
last and one inside the other. Thus, by this example, it is clearly
proved that every object sends its image to every spot whence the
object itself can be seen; and the converse: That the same object
may receive in itself all the images of the objects that are in
front of it. Hence the eye transmits through the atmosphere its own
image to all the objects that are in front of it and receives them
into itself, that is to say on its surface, whence they are taken in
by the common sense, which considers them and if they are pleasing
invisible images in the eyes are produced towards the object, as the
image of the object to the eye. That the images of the objects must
When one has reached the other it is returned to the object that
the object and then comes back once more, and this happens
67
endlessly. If you put a light between two flat mirrors with a
at night you put a light between the walls of a room, all the parts
of that wall will be tinted with the image of that light. And they
will receive the light and the light will fall on them, mutually,
degree in the distribution of the solar rays which all together, and
each by itself, convey to the object the image of the body which
causes it. That each body by itself alone fills with its images the
atmosphere around it, and that the same air is able, at the same
time, to receive the images of the endless other objects which are
every smallest part of it; and all the objects in the whole, and all
66.
The images of objects are all diffused through the atmosphere which
receives them; and all on every side in it. To prove this, let a c
68
67.
General conclusions.
All objects project their whole image and likeness, diffused and
the atmosphere. All the images of the objects are in every part of
the atmosphere. The whole, and each part of the image of the
presented to it. Therefore both the part and the whole of the images
of the objects exist, both in the whole and in the parts of the
68.
portion [of the eye] which would give rise to this emanation would
69
time. And this being so, it could not travel so high as the sun in a
month's time when the eye wanted to see it. And if it could reach
remain in a continuous line from the eye to the sun and should
always diverge in such a way as to form between the sun and the eye
the base and the apex of a pyramid. This being the case, if the eye
have to travel through the air as perfumes do, the winds would bent
it and carry it into another place. But we do [in fact] see the mass
of the sun with the same rapidity as [an object] at the distance of
(Milano 1584. Libr. V cp. XXI): Sovviemmi di aver già letto in certi
70
poche parole conclusa da Bramantino in maniera che giudico non
fine, io riferirò per appunto le proprie parole sue (cp. XXII, Prima
per esser lontana, ovvero vicina, per quello effetto non può
sono piccioli, e perciò volendo vedere tanto gran cosa, bisogna che
quella cosa la vede dove è: e da lei agli occhi per quello circuito
69.
A parallel case.
Just as a stone flung into the water becomes the centre and cause of
71
circles, and fills the surrounding air with infinite images of
shut a window that faces west and make a hole [Footnote: 6. Here the
The function of the eye as explained by the camera obscura (70. 71).
70.
If the object in front of the eye sends its image to the eye, the
eye, on the other hand, sends its image to the object, and no
for any reason either in the eye or the object. Therefore we may
than the nature of the objects, to send their images through the
air. If the object opposite to the eye were to send its image to the
eye, the eye would have to do the same to the object, whence it
might seem that these images were an emanation. But, if so, it would
atmosphere. That is: the whole object in the whole atmosphere, and
72
in each part; and all the objects in the whole atmosphere and all of
it, and if, in the front which does not face the sun, you make a
small round hole, all the illuminated objects will project their
images through that hole and be visible inside the dwelling on the
opposite wall which may be made white; and there, in fact, they will
in the same wall you will have the same result from each. Hence the
and all in each minutest part of it. The reason, as we clearly know,
is that this hole must admit some light to the said dwelling, and
bodies. If these bodies are of various colours and shapes the rays
forming the images are of various colours and shapes, and so will
73
the representations be on the wall.
[Footnote: 70. 15--23. This section has already been published in the
"Saggio delle Opere di Leonardo da Vinci" Milan 1872, pp. 13, 14.
inventor of the Camera obscura, but that he was the first to explain
that this is, in fact, the very discovery which Leonardo ascribes to
71.
74
images on a white paper placed within this dark room and rather near
to the hole and you will see all the objects on the paper in their
proper forms and colours, but much smaller; and they will be upside
from behind. And let the little perforation be made in a very thin
and o r the front of the dark chamber in which is the said hole at
the left becomes f on the right; and the same takes place inside
the pupil.
72.
75
the eye.
73.
The object which is opposite to the pupil of the eye is seen by that
pupil and that which is opposite to the eye is seen by the pupil.
74.
The lines sent forth by the image of an object to the eye do not
75.
If the judgment of the eye is situated within it, the straight lines
of the images are refracted on its surface because they pass through
the rarer to the denser medium. If, when you are under water, you
look at objects in the air you will see them out of their true
place; and the same with objects under water seen from the air.
76.
76
The inversion of the images.
All the images of objects which pass through a window [glass pane]
from the free outer air to the air confined within walls, are seen
on the opposite side; and an object which moves in the outer air
from east to west will seem in its shadow, on the wall which is
77.
objects are made to move. And this happens, as is shown in the 9th
the three reproduced.] the images of any object are all everywhere,
and all in each part of the surrounding air. It follows that if one
of the edges of the hole by which the images are admitted to a dark
chamber is moved it cuts off those rays of the image that were in
77
contact with it and gets nearer to other rays which previously were
LOWER EDGE.
If you move the right side of the opening the image on the left will
move [being that] of the object which entered on the right side of
the opening; and the same result will happen with all the other
sides of the opening. This can be proved by the 2nd of this which
shows: all the rays which convey the images of objects through the
air are straight lines. Hence, if the images of very large bodies
have to pass through very small holes, and beyond these holes
78.
in the pupil, the other in the crystalline lens; and if this were
not the case the eye could not see so great a number of objects as
it does. This can be proved, since all the lines which intersect do
78
so in a point. Because nothing is seen of objects excepting their
the 4th of this which shows: all the smallest parts of the images
smallest object, enters the eye without being turned upside down;
reversed and thus the image is restored to the same position within
79.
Only one line of the image, of all those that reach the visual
of every image that enters by small and narrow openings into a dark
79
chamber shall be turned upside down, together with the images of the
80.
that its right should cross over to its left side, and so, its left
side become its right side. Because such an intersection demands two
lines, one from each side; for there can be no motion from right to
spot c, you will have moved the opposite ends f b towards each
other at the point d. And from the two lines you will have drawn
these two lines at the point n without any intersection. For, you
80
imagine these two lines as having breadth, it is evident that by
this motion the first will entirely cover the other--being equal
81.
POINT.
Just as all lines can meet at a point without interfering with each
images of surfaces can meet there; and as each given point faces the
converging rays of the image can pass through the point and diverge
much less will the images transmitted through this opening intersect
each other. The sides of images which pass through openings into a
81
dark room intersect at a point which is nearer to the opening in
object in light and shade which sends not its shadow but the image
this shaded body; and its sides a b, being straight lines (as has
been proved) must intersect between the shaded object and the
than the object in shade. As is shown, on your right hand and your
half way between the opening and the shaded object at the point c.
But this cannot happen in the left hand figure, the opening o
the objects and the openings through which the images of these
bodies are admitted; and this is plain, because where the atmosphere
When the images are made double by mutually crossing each other they
between the bodies in b and i this will not hinder its being
82
[Footnote: 81. On the original diagram at the beginning of this
stands.]
[Footnote: 15--23. These lines stand between the diagrams I and III.]
[Footnote: 24--53. These lines stand between the diagrams I and II.]
[Footnote: 54--97 are written along the left side of diagram I.]
82.
An experiment showing that though the pupil may not be moved from
its position the objects seen by it may appear to move from their
places.
below the eye, and fix both your eyes upon it and with one hand
firmly hold the upper lid open while with the other you push up the
under lid--still keeping your eyes fixed on the object gazed at--you
will see that object double; one [image] remaining steady, and the
on the lower eyelid. How false the opinion is of those who say that
this happens because the pupil of the eye is displaced from its
83
position.
How the above mentioned facts prove that the pupil acts upside down
in seeing.
here.]
(83-85).
83.
pyramids to the point in the eye, and these pyramids are intersected
84.
84
look of the same size as it appears to the eye. You see that the
is the base of the lines from the objects converging in the eye and
the same plane and measuring on it one and the same object.
85.
PERSPECTIVE.
the central point where the apex of the pyramids converge. And this
would, through which you might see the various objects and draw them
on it. And the objects thus drawn would be smaller than the
eye was smaller than that between the glass and the objects.
PERSPECTIVE.
show, on the plane, the various sizes and remoteness of the objects
85
causing them.
PERSPECTIVE.
the more they rise to the level of eye the less this is seen, and
the more the eye is above them the more will their real width be
seen.
PERSPECTIVE.
The farther a spherical body is from the eye the more you will see
of it.
86.
A simple and natural method; showing how objects appear to the eye
The object that is nearest to the eye always seems larger than
86
quite inconceivable to me why M. RAVAISSON, in a note to his French
clair que c'est par erreur que Leonard a ècrit per esser visino au
lieu de per non esser visino. (See his printed ed. of MS. A. p.
the space o v will be seen at o r, and in the same way the space
where you can walk round, it will look out of proportion by reason
proceeds from the eye being so much below [near] the plane that the
would have [to arrange] to see the perspective through a single hole
at least 3 times the height of the object you see. The plane o p
being always equally remote from the eye will reproduce the objects
87.
How every large mass sends forth its images, which may diminish
through infinity.
infinitely diminished.
88.
87
Objects of equal size, situated in various places, will be seen by
89.
pyramids, one of which has its apex in the eye and the base as
distant as the horizon. The other has the base towards the eye and
the apex on the horizon. Now, the first includes the [visible]
universe, embracing all the mass of the objects that lie in front of
opening; for the more remote the objects are from the eye, the
greater number can be seen through the opening, and thus the pyramid
is constructed with the base on the horizon and the apex in the eye,
90.
SIMPLE PERSPECTIVE.
plane which is equally distant from the eye in every part. Complex
88
perspective is that which is constructed on a ground-plan in which
91.
PERSPECTIVE.
92.
WHY WHEN AN OBJECT IS PLACED CLOSE TO THE EYE ITS EDGES ARE
INDISTINCT.
When an object opposite the eye is brought too close to it, its
in all cases of linear perspective, the eye acts in the same way as
the light. And the reason is that the eye has one leading line (of
are close. But since the eye sends out a multitude of lines which
surround this chief central one and since these which are farthest
from the centre in this cone of lines are less able to discern with
89
accuracy, it follows that an object brought close to the eye is not
at a due distance, but is too near for the central line to be able
to discern the outlines of the object. So the edges fall within the
the eye like dogs in the chase which can put up the game but cannot
take it. Thus these cannot take in the objects, but induce the
central line of sight to turn upon them, when they have put them up.
Hence the objects which are seen with these lines of sight have
confused outlines.
The relative size of objects with regard to their distance from the
eye (93-98).
93.
PERSPECTIVE.
Small objects close at hand and large ones at a distance, being seen
94.
PERSPECTIVE.
90
95.
Among objects of equal size that which is most remote from the eye
96.
Why an object is less distinct when brought near to the eye, and why
with spectacles, or without the naked eye sees badly either close or
97.
PERSPECTIVE.
Among objects of equal size, that which is most remote from the eye
98.
91
PERSPECTIVE.
No second object can be so much lower than the first as that the eye
will not see it higher than the first, if the eye is above the
second.
PERSPECTIVE.
And this second object will never be so much higher than the first
as that the eye, being below them, will not see the second as lower
PERSPECTIVE.
If the eye sees a second square through the centre of a smaller one,
PERSPECTIVE--PROPOSITION.
Objects that are farther off can never be so large but that those in
DEFINITION.
92
This proposition can be proved by experiment. For if you look
enclosed by the outline of the sides of the hole. And if you stop it
up, this small stopping will conceal the view of the largest object.
99.
OF LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.
first, and how much the third is smaller than the second; and so on
the eye, although they are of the same size, the second will seem
half the size of the first and if the third object is of the same
size as the 2nd, and the 3rd is as far beyond the second as the 2nd
from the first, it will appear of half the size of the second; and
the size of the former object. So long as the space does not exceed
size will lose 2/4 and at 40 braccia they will lose 9/10, and 19/20
93
picture plane is distant from you twice your own height. If it is
only as far off as your own height, there will be a great difference
100.
A second object as far distant from the first as the first is from
the eye will appear half the size of the first, though they be of
If you place the vertical plane at one braccio from the eye, the
94
first object, being at a distance of 4 braccia from your eye will
101.
Begin from the line m f with the eye below; then go up and do the
same with the line n f, then with the eye above and close to the 2
will n m be to n s.
d c into o p.
102.
I GIVE THE DEGREES OF THE OBJECTS SEEN BY THE EYE AS THE MUSICIAN
Although the objects seen by the eye do, in fact, touch each other
95
as they recede, I will nevertheless found my rule on spaces of 20
braccia each; as a musician does with notes, which, though they can
be carried on one into the next, he divides into degrees from note
to note calling them 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th; and has affixed a name
103.
PERSPECTIVE.
Let f be the level and distance of the eye; and a the vertical
plane this will be the distance from the plane to the 2nd man.
104.
consequence of their various remoteness from the eye will bear among
Find out how much a man diminishes at a certain distance and what
its length is; and then at twice that distance and at 3 times, and
105.
96
The eye cannot judge where an object high up ought to descend.
106.
PERSPECTIVE.
If two similar and equal objects are placed one beyond the other at
proportion as they are nearer to the eye that sees them. And
themselves; for, if the first of these two objects were as far from
the eye, as the 2nd from the first this would be called the second
proportion: since, if the first is at 1 braccia from the eye and the
2nd at two braccia, two being twice as much as one, the first object
will look twice as large as the second. But if you place the first
at a hundred braccia from you and the second at a hundred and one,
you will find that the first is only so much larger than the second
as 100 is less than 101; and the converse is equally true. And
again, the same thing is proved by the 4th of this book which shows
that among objects that are equal, there is the same proportion in
97
On natural perspective (107--109).
107.
4: in ... parte. The space for the number is left blank in the
any distance; and it shows all these objects just as the eye sees
foreshortening.
partly from art and partly from nature and the work done by its
ones. And this is proved by the first of what has been said above,
that which is devised by art, does the contrary; for objects equal
98
proportion as the eye is more natural and nearer to the plane, and
eye.
And let this plane be d e on which are seen 3 equal circles which
see that the eye h sees on the vertical plane the sections of the
nearest.
108.
Here follows what is wanting in the margin at the foot on the other
the object appears larger. But this said invention requires the
spectator to stand with his eye at a small hole and then, at that
small hole, it will be very plain. But since many (men's) eyes
endeavour at the same time to see one and the same picture produced
by this artifice only one can see clearly the effect of this
99
which the plane intersects the pyramids by which the images are
constant experience, from the curved form of the pupil of the eye on
visual virtue.
diagrams which, in the original MS., are placed in the margin at the
109.
before proceeding any farther I will define what is natural and what
and conversely, the nearer will look the larger and the apparent
distances, the smallest is nearer to the eye than the largest and
the greatest distance looks as though it were the least of all; and
the cause of this is the plane on which the objects are represented;
100
perspective shown upon it is artificial since it nowhere agrees with
the true diminution of the said plane. Whence it follows, that when
perspective that it has been gazing at, all the objects represented
which has been defined above. Let us say then, that the square a b
the original; the meaning and derivation of the word are equally
III.
101
after Linear Perspective.
Light and Shade. Certainly, the Principles of Light and Shade form
by far the larger portion of this MS. which consists of two separate
parts; still, the materials are far from being finally arranged. It
is also evident that he here investigates the subject from the point
adopted by me has been strictly adhered to for the first four Books.
For the three last, however, few materials have come down to us; and
it must be admitted that these three Books would find a far more
and Shade.
102
[Footnote III: This text has already been published with some slight
da Vinci, Milan 1871, pp. 30--31. Dozio did not transcribe it from
the original MS. which seems to have remained unknown to him, but
GENERAL INTRODUCTION.
Prolegomena.
110.
You must first explain the theory and then the practice. First you
must describe the shadows and lights on opaque objects, and then on
transparent bodies.
111.
INTRODUCTION.
103
C.], I will now consider the places on which they fall; and their
surrounded and its whole surface enveloped in shadow and light. And
these I call Primary shadows because they are the first, and
inseparable from the object to which they belong. And on this I will
certain shaded rays which are diffused through the atmosphere and
Derived shadows because they are produced by other shadows; and the
third Book will treat of these. Again these derived shadows, where
as the places where they are cast and of this I will treat in the
fourth Book. And since all round the derived shadows, where the
104
derived shadows are intercepted, there is always a space where the
cause, it meets the original shadow and mingles with it and modifies
Besides this, in the sixth Book I will investigate the many and
colours from the different objects whence these reflected rays are
derived. Again, the seventh Book will treat of the various distances
that may exist between the spot where the reflected rays fall and
that where they originate, and the various shades of colour which
112.
call Restricted [Light] and then I will treat of light in the open
113.
OF PAINTING.
105
The conditions of shadow and light [as seen] by the eye are 3. Of
these the first is when the eye and the light are on the same side
of the object seen; the 2nd is when the eye is in front of the
object and the light is behind it. The 3rd is when the eye is in
front of the object and the light is on one side, in such a way as
that a line drawn from the object to the eye and one from the object
114.
OF PAINTING.
(from) an object placed between the eye and the light under various
aspects.
115.
OF PAINTING.
are the position of the eye which sees: that of the object seen
[with regard] to the light, and the position of the light which
illuminated object.
106
116.
Let a be the light, b the eye, c the object seen by the eye
and in the light. These show, first, the eye between the light and
the body; the 2nd, the light between the eye and the body; the 3rd
the body between the eye and the light, a is the eye, b the
117.
OF PAINTING.
The first kind of Light which may illuminate opaque bodies is called
Direct light--as that of the sun or any other light from a window or
cloudy weather or in mist and the like. The 3rd is Subdued light,
that is when the sun is entirely below the horizon, either in the
evening or morning.
118.
OF LIGHT.
107
The lights which may illuminate opaque bodies are of 4 kinds. These
nothing intervened between the shaded object and the light that
falls upon it; and this we will discuss fully in our discourse.
119.
one conceals and the other reveals. They are always associated and
than light, for it can impede and entirely deprive bodies of their
light, while light can never entirely expel shadow from a body, that
120.
108
Shadow is the diminution of light by the intervention of an opaque
body. Shadow is the counterpart of the luminous rays which are cut
This is proved because the shadow cast is the same in shape and size
121.
absence of darkness.
The beginnings and ends of shadow lie between the light and darkness
shadow.
122.
109
Shadow partakes of the nature of universal matter. All such matters
are more powerful in their beginning and grow weaker towards the
great oak which has a feeble beginning from a small acorn. Yet I may
say that the oak is most powerful at its beginning, that is where it
object that casts it, and make the end of it fading into light,
123.
shadow and pervades the air. A cast transparent shadow is that which
which receives no light from the luminous body which causes it. A
simple shadow begins within the line which starts from the edge of
110
124.
more lights.
125.
the light always has one side in shadow which never leaves it for
may be and may not be produced by the body itself. Suppose the ball
side of it; this light will throw upon the wall exactly as broad a
towards the wall. That portion of the cast shadow will not be
visible when the light is below the ball and the shadow is thrown up
111
126.
HOW THERE ARE 2 KINDS OF LIGHT, ONE SEPARABLE FROM, AND THE
OTHER
Separate light is that which falls upon the body. Inseparable light
called primary, the other derived. And, in the same way there are
two kinds of shadow:--One primary and the other derived. The primary
which proceeds from the body conveying to the surface of the wall
127.
How there are 2 different kinds of light; one being called diffused,
112
General remarks (128. 129).
128.
light. Primary light is that which falls on objects and causes light
and shade. And derived lights are those portions of a body which are
the air without any interference and the spot which intercepts and
And the eye can best distinguish the forms of objects when it is
129.
EXPLANATION OF PERSPECTIVE.
I ask to have this much granted me--to assert that every ray
113
straight line from its cause to the object or place it falls upon.
130.
rays [of the large light] are much more than twice the extent [of
the small body]--always has its shadow cast on the nearest surface
plane. It is clear that it is not the broad light that will cast the
shadow n on the plane, but that the light has within it a centre
shown at m o t r.
after this title-line; but a space is left for it and the text
Why, when you estimate the direction of an object with two sights
114
the nearer appears confused. I say that the eye projects an infinite
it from the object looked at. And it is only the central and
sensible line that can discern and discriminate colours and objects;
all the others are false and illusory. And if you place 2 objects at
half an arm's length apart if the nearer of the two is close to the
eye its form will remain far more confused than that of the second;
Light acts in the same manner, for in the effects of its lines
and its central rays are what cast the true shadow. When the object
broad and disproportionate shadow, ill defined; but when the object
which is to cast the shadow and cuts off the rays near to the place
where the shadow falls, then the shadow is distinct; and the more so
the central ray is less overcome by false rays; because the lines
from the eye and the solar and other luminous rays passing through
moisture they will preserve their direct course, always carrying the
origin. And if this is the eye, the intercepting object will be seen
115
by its colour, as well as by form and size. But if the intercepting
the rays enter through this hole and transmitting to the plane
beyond all the details of the object they proceed from both as to
colour and form; only every thing will be upside down. But the size
on which the lines fall [on one hand] and from their origin [on the
other]. There they intersect and form 2 pyramids with their point
plane. You will find that a falls upon the inner plane below at
itself a core or centre, from which and to which all the lines
radiate which are sent forth by the surface of the luminous body and
reflected back to it; or which, having been thrown out and not
131.
116
Although the points of luminous pyramids may extend into shaded
though among the luminous pyramids one may start from a broader base
will be equal; and the case will be the same with the pyramids of
and light.
132.
Of the difference between light and lustre; and that lustre is not
from the surface of wet bodies; light partakes of the colour of the
object which reflects it (to the eye) as gold or silver or the like.
133.
117
OF THE HIGHEST LIGHTS WHICH TURN AND MOVE AS THE EYE MOVES
WHICH
Suppose the body to be the round object figured here and let the
is every where and complete in each part, if you stand at the point
134.
OF PAINTING.
the middle of an illuminated object, but moves as and where the eye
135.
What is the difference between light and the lustre which is seen on
118
The lights which are produced from the polished surface of opaque
which they strike moves. But reflected lights will, on those same
Opaque bodies which have a hard and rough surface never display any
Those bodies which are opaque and hard with a hard surface reflect
occupy with regard to the eye; but, as the surface mirrors all the
136.
The middle of the light and shade on an object in light and shade is
opposite to the middle of the primary light. All light and shadow
119
expresses itself in pyramidal lines. The middle of the shadow on any
direct line passing through the centre of the body. The middle of
bodies shown in light and shade the middle of each must coincide
with the centre of the body, and a straight line will pass through
(137--140).
137.
nevertheless, if you follow the lines of their shadows you will see
sketched on Pl. XXXII; a square with three balls below it. The first
120
three lines of the text belonging to it are written above the sketch
138.
line starting from the horizon to the east, which, touching the 2
opening and thickness of the window. Again, you can still better
will see the line drawn from the centre of the shadow directed to
the original diagram (the circle of the horizon towards the North);
139.
Every shadow with all its variations, which becomes larger as its
121
distance from the object is greater, has its external lines
intersecting in the middle, between the light and the object. This
(West).]
140.
dark and the other luminous, one is visible the other is not. But
to be the window and r the body in light and shade, the light to
the right hand z will pass the object to the left and go on to
Light and shadow with regard to the position of the eye (141--145).
122
141.
Every shaded body that is larger than the pupil and that interposes
between the luminous body and the eye will be seen dark.
When the eye is placed between the luminous body and the objects
142.
Why the 2 lights one on each side of a body having two pyramidal
143.
A body in shadow situated between the light and the eye can never
display its illuminated portion unless the eye can see the whole of
123
[Footnote: A stands for corpo (body), B for lume (light).]
144.
The eye which looks (at a spot) half way between the shadow and the
light which surrounds the body in shadow will see that the deepest
shadows on that body will meet the eye at equal angles, that is at
145.
PLACED IN THEM.
If the sun is in the East and you look towards the West you will see
every thing in full light and totally without shadow because you see
them from the same side as the sun: and if you look towards the
South or North you will see all objects in light and shade, because
you see both the side towards the sun and the side away from it; and
if you look towards the coming of the sun all objects will show you
their shaded side, because on that side the sun cannot fall upon
124
them.
146.
147.
OF PAINTING.
That part of a body which receives the luminous rays at equal angles
And the part which the luminous rays strike between less equal
125
Gradations of strength in the shadows (148. 149).
148.
149.
126
The light which falls on a shaded body at the acutest angle receives
the highest light, and the darkest portion is that which receives it
at an obtuse angle and both the light and the shadow form pyramids.
angles which divide it are not so unequal as those below, and only
nevertheless not very strong because one angle is smaller than its
fellow. The angles e i will have less light because they do not
see much of the light m s and the light v x and their angles are
very unequal. Yhe angle k and the angle f are each placed
between very unequal angles and therefore have but little light,
all from the sky; and thence come the lines which will reconstruct a
straight line which passes through the centre of the body and goes
to the centre of the light. The several luminous images cast within
the frame of the window at the points a and b make a light which
surrounds the derived shadow cast by the solid body at the points 4
127
[Footnote: The diagram belonging to this chapter is No. 2 on Plate
light (150-152).
150.
The smaller the light that falls upon an object the more shadow it
will display. And the light will illuminate a smaller portion of the
and the converse, as it is farther from it. But when the light is
151.
128
That portion of an illuminated object which is nearest to the source
152.
The derived shadow will be darker than the primary shadow where it
153.
Objects seen in light and shade show in greater relief than those
154.
OF PERSPECTIVE.
129
The shaded and illuminated sides of opaque objects will display the
square.].
155.
OF PAINTING.
The outlines and form of any part of a body in light and shade are
portions between the light and the shadows they are highly
conspicuous.
156.
OF PAINTING.
shadows as in the natural diminution of the light and the same must
157.
130
A single and distinct luminous body causes stronger relief in the
atmosphere.
158.
159.
131
primary shadow, the second is derived shadow. The primary shadow is
elaborately treated by Leonardo. But both text and diagrams (as Pl.
IV, 1-3 and Pl. V) must at once convince the student that the
with smoke the room in which the existence of the ombra dirivativa
simpler, and we must assume this theory as our chief guide through
132
160.
The forms of shadows are three: inasmuch as if the solid body which
casts the shadow is equal (in size) to the light, the shadow
But if the body is smaller than the light, the shadow will resemble
161.
The simple derived shadow is of two kinds: one kind which has its
length defined, and two kinds which are undefined; and the defined
other spreads out; and all three have rectilinear outlines. But the
is smaller than the light, and the columnar from a body equal in
size to the light, and the spreading shadow from a body larger than
133
OF COMPOUND DERIVED SHADOWS.
spreading.
162.
OF SHADOW.
second columnar, the third converging to the point where the two
sides meet and intersect, and beyond this intersection the sides are
must terminate at the angle where the sides meet and extend no
goes beyond its terminating lines. Now here, in this shadow, we see
which meet at their angles. Hence, if, as [my] opponent says, the
the adversary--must be caused by the angle and not from the body in
shadow; and this is disproved with the help of the 2nd of this which
134
made clear that the shadow is not produced by the angle of the
derived shadow but only by the body casting the shadow; &c. If a
shadow produced by the longest portion of this light will have less
same light. And this is proved by what was said before, which is:
[Footnote: The two diagrams to this chapter are on Plate IV, No. 1.]
163.
The derived shadow can never resemble the body from which it
proceeds unless the light is of the same form and size as the body
The derived shadow cannot be of the same form as the primary shadow
164.
135
HOW A CAST SHADOW CAN NEVER BE OF THE SAME SIZE AS THE BODY
THAT
CASTS IT.
point and are diffused in a sphere round this point, radiating and
dispersed through the air, the farther they spread the wider they
must spread; and an object placed between the light and a wall is
always imaged larger in its shadow, because the rays that strike it
logical connection.] would, by the time they have reached the wall,
165.
Any shadow cast by a body in light and shade is of the same nature
and character as that which is inseparable from the body. The centre
come next to the foregoing; sections 172 and 127 are placed between
136
166.
prolonged beyond its apex this gives rise to a second pyramid; this
167.
168.
Both the primary and derived shadow will be larger when caused by
137
[Footnote: In the diagrams A stands for celo (sky), B for
cadela (candle).]
169.
small; and the derivative light will be large, again, because the
shadow because its original shadow will be larger, and its derived
170.
171.
OF PAINTING.
the sky is nowhere visible, it gets no light whatever from the sky,
distance, the wall a d will grow lighter for the reasons here
given, until the darkness of the room overpowers the light from the
window.
139
172.
distant from the centre of the window, that which is most obliquely
173.
are more or less opposite to the window. Among the shadows cast by
which they are illuminated, that shadow will be the longest of the
The reason why those bodies which are placed most in front of the
situated is:--That the window appears in its proper form and to the
middle, the window shows its full size, to the oblique ones it
appears smaller; the one in the middle faces the whole hemisphere
140
faces a b; and m n faces c d; the body in the middle having a
point much below its centre, and thus the shadow is shorter. And the
[Footnote 31: passa per 6 1/2 (passes through 6 1/2). The meaning
shadow, with the centre of the body casting it and of the derivative
light and with the centre of the window and, finally, with the
this drawing is placed between lines 3 and 22; the rest, from line 4
141
174.
You will find that the proportion of the diameter of the derived
between the darkness of the primary shadow and that of the derived
shadow.
No. 177.]
the shadows will run off in two opposite directions as if they were
175.
142
ON PAINTING.
place of origin.
176.
Shadows fade and are lost at long distances because the larger
quantity of illuminated air which lies between the eye and the
177.
than a b.
178.
143
the dark wall in which this window is, be b s, that is, one of the
Then we may say that the line p h is darker than any other part of
lines 27 and 28.] the wall b s. The line o c is lighter than the
luminous space a b.
casts it.
this:
144
the side r c, which faces the dark wall a e must participate of
its darkness and, in the same way that the outer surface which faces
This is divided into four parts. The first the extremes, which
these extremes.
179.
If it were the whole of the light that caused the shadows beyond the
bodies placed in front of it, it would follow that any body much
smaller than the light would cast a pyramidal shadow; but experience
not showing this, it must be the centre of the light that produces
this effect.
and 5 in the original. Comp. the reproduction Pl. IV, No. 4. The
text and drawing of this chapter have already been published with
PROOF.
145
Let a b be the width of the light from a window, which falls on a
space where all the light from the window is visible. At c e that
180.
A body in light and shade placed between two equal lights side by
side will cast shadows in proportion to the [amount of] light. And
the shadows will be one darker than the other in proportion as one
light is nearer to the said body than the other on the opposite
side.
A body placed at an equal distance between two lights will cast two
shadows, one deeper than the other in proportion, as the light which
[Footnote: In the MS. the larger diagram is placed above the first
146
181.
shadows of which the outlines end within [the surface of] the body,
and not much compound shadow; and falls on less than half of it. A
182.
in the direction of the lines of the 2 lights; and if you move this
body placing it nearer to one of the lights the shadow cast towards
the nearer light will be less deep than that which falls towards the
183.
147
The next less deep shadow is the derived shadow e f n; and in this
light, that is c d.
one only of the two luminous bodies [10]. But it varies with the
gather from what follows that q g r here means ombra media (the
[Footnote 20: See Footnote 18]: that is to say the depth of a shadow
The fifth is less deep in shadow than either of the others because
148
it is always entirely exposed to one of the lights and to the whole
a b.
184.
OF SIMPLE SHADOWS.
ANSWER.
Compound shadow are a mixture of light and shade and simple shadows
are simply darkness. Hence, of the two lights n and o, one falls
on the compound shadow from one side, and the other on the compound
shadow from the other side, but where they intersect no light falls,
compound shadow one light or the other falls; and here a difficulty
149
arises for my adversary since he says that, where the compound
shadows intersect, both the lights which produce the shadows must of
inasmuch as the two lights do not fall there, we say that the shadow
is a simple one and where only one of the two lights falls, we say
the shadow is compound, and where both the lights fall the shadow is
shall say that what my adversary said was true: but he only mentions
must conclude that my proposition is true. And that is: That if both
shadows fell in the same spot; because, where a shadow and a light
equal lights fall, the shadow cannot vary in any part of it, the
shadows and the lights both being equal. And this is proved in the
DEFINITION.
150
which causes the shadow s a, and the shadow x a.
But if you uncover both the lights a b, then you get the two
proportion as the lights falling on, and crossing them are less
numerous.
186.
are illuminated by a second light placed between the eye and the
151
throughout the rest. In the 1st and 2nd above, the intersections i
and in quantity.
187.
The derived shadow of the dark walls on each side of the bright
light of the window are what mingle their various degrees of shade
with the light derived from the window; and these various depths of
greater than a part, e which faces the whole base [of the
152
part of the base of the t. And c is the terminal point of the
[Footnote: The diagram on Pl. IV, No. 5 belongs to this passage; but
it must be noted that the text explains only the figure on the
right-hand side.]
188.
The form of the shadow cast by any body of uniform density can never
be the same as that of the body producing it. [Footnote: Comp. the
189.
No cast shadow can produce the true image of the body which casts it
190.
153
magnify the size of the window and diminish the shadow of a man in
such a way as that when the man makes that dim shadow of himself,
approach to that which defines the real size of the window, he will
see the shadows where they come into contact, dim and confused from
the strength of the light, shutting off and not allowing the solar
rays to pass; the effect of the shadow of the man cast by this
very slight original sketch the shadow touches the upper arch of the
191.
from the luminous body. This is proved by the 7th which says:--The
spots equally distant from the luminous body those will always be in
the highest light on which the rays fall at the smallest angles: The
154
will be seen with all the contours similar to those of the body that
casts it, if the eye is placed just where the centre of the light
was.
The shadow will look darkest where it is farthest from the body that
section.]
192.
193.
As the derived shadow gets more distant from the primary shadow, the
194.
155
The greater the difference between a light and the body lighted by
it, the light being the larger, the more vague will be the outlines
The derived shadow will be most confused towards the edges of its
it.
195.
What is the cause which makes the outlines of the shadow vague and
confused?
edges of shadows.
196.
WHY?
156
you will see that it casts a very large shadow on the opposite wall,
and the farther you remove the object from the light the smaller
PROPORTION.
producing it, results from the light being smaller than the body, so
613 and 614 alters this passage as follows: quella parte ch'e piu
agrees with the original MS. in having distante in the former and
to invert the facts. Supposing for instance, that on Pl. XXXI No. 3.
f is the spot where the light is that illuminates the figure there
represented, and that the line behind the figure represents a wall
that case the nearest portion, in this case the under part of the
parts, for instance the head, are more magnified.]; and the portions
which are most remote are made larger than the nearer portions for
157
WHY A SHADOW WHICH IS LARGER THAN THE BODY CAUSING IT HAS
ILL-DEFINED OUTLINES.
for brightness and colour; but the farther off it is the more it
edges.
197.
the primary shadow or, I should say, the body casting the shadow;
[Footnote 14: The lettering refers to the lower diagram, Pl. XLI,
No. 5.] the cause of this is the elongated form of the luminous body
198.
158
OF MODIFIED SHADOWS.
Modified shadows are those which are cast on light walls or other
illuminated objects.
objects opposite to them. And they will appear less dark when they
face lighter objects. And the larger the light object opposite, the
And the larger the surface of the dark object the more it will
A disputed proposition.
199.
SURFACE.
159
Certain mathematicians have maintained that a triangle, of which the
they prove by saying [5] that no spherical body smaller than the
light can reach the middle with the shadow. The lines of radiant
has no shadow; and that which has no shadow can cast none. This, in
are in shadow.
200.
160
fall upon it. The spot which receives the rays at the widest angle
201.
202.
the object and d c the plane surface; the number of times that d
161
Principles of reflection (203. 204).
203.
If the object is the mountain here figured, and the light is at the
no light but from reflected rays. And this results from the fact
that rays of light can only act in straight lines; and the same is
204.
The edges of the derived shadow are defined by the hues of the
shadow.
On reverberation.
205.
OF REVERBERATION.
162
semi opaque surface which, when the light strikes upon them, throw
light and shade. The lights are of two kinds, one called original,
that finally so much shadow is the result that the light counts for
nothing. Hence objects of this kind cannot throw any reflected light
on opposite objects.
206.
PERSPECTIVE.
163
The shadow or object mirrored in water in motion, that is to say in
producing it.
207.
in form to the object mirrored, since the centre of the eye is above
This is made plain in the figure here given, which demonstrates that
has been said above unless the eye itself is situated on the surface
208.
164
THE MIRROR.
light as this second light will bear to the first, if both bodies
209.
but in the eye which sees it in the mirror. For if you look at your
face in the mirror, the part resembles the whole in as much as the
the same mirror; and the same is true of the whole image of any
210.
No man can see the image of another man in a mirror in its proper
place with regard to the objects; because every object falls on [the
surface of] the mirror at equal angles. And if the one man, who sees
the other in the mirror, is not in a direct line with the image he
will not see it in the place where it really falls; and if he gets
into the line, he covers the other man and puts himself in the place
165
friend and d your own eye. Your friend's eye will appear to you at
you touching m will touch the eye of the other man which shall be
open. And if you touch the eye of the other man in the mirror it
211.
When two bodies casting shadows, and one in front of the other, are
between a window and the wall with some space between them, the
shadow of the body which is nearest to the plane of the wall will
212.
166
The motion of a shadow is always more rapid than that of the body
be the luminous body, and b the body casting the shadow, and d
the shadow. Then I say that in the time while the solid body moves
Thus, given the proportion of the space moved over by the body b
to that of the solid body, then the shadow and the body that casts
it will move with equal speed. And if the luminous body moves more
rapidly than the solid body, the motion of the shadow will be slower
But if the luminous body moves more slowly than the solid body, then
213.
167
PERSPECTIVE.
If you transmit the rays of the sun through a hole in the shape of a
parenthesis. Leonardo himself has but rarely worked out the subject
occasionally been made use of for quite different matter. Even the
and numbered, which occur on these pages, are hardly ever explained,
214.
the body causing them, since all the effects produced by a luminous
body are [in fact] the reflection of that body: The moon, shaped
168
blank space is left after this question.] Why the eye sees bodies at
preceding section.]
215.
on the body.
169
n m a, therefore x y is three times as dark as z g; x f, by
must say that the shadow between f x will be four times as dark as
Let a b be the side where the primary shadow is, and b c the
[Footnote: In the original MS. the text of No. 252 precedes the one
given here. In the text of No. 215 there is a blank space of about
four lines between the lines 2 and 3. The diagram given on Pl. VI,
is another space of about three lines and one line left blank
between lines 8 and 9. The reader will find the meaning of the whole
216.
from other bodies placed opposite fall at the largest angle will
170
assume their hue most strongly. In the diagram below, 8 is a larger
makes it twice as dark. And the same thing happens when you put the
plane surfaces placed near to each other, equal in tone and directly
and if the luminous bodies were of equal size you would still
farther find the same proportion in the light cast by the luminous
bodies.
171
[Footnote: The diagram originally placed between lines 3 and 4 is on
Pl. VI, No. 3. In the diagram given above line 14 of the original,
and here printed in the text, the words corpo luminoso [luminous
217.
between two plane surfaces near together, alike in tone and directly
is most light, but where there are fewer there is least light,
218.
172
In all the proportions I lay down it must be understood that the
medium between the bodies is always the same. [2] The smaller the
luminous body the more distinct will the transmission of the shadows
be.
[3] When of two opposite shadows, produced by the same body, one is
twice as dark as the other though similar in form, one of the two
lights causing them must have twice the diameter that the other has
and be at twice the distance from the opaque body. If the object is
lowly moved across the luminous body, and the shadow is intercepted
at some distance from the object, there will be the same relative
proportion between the motion of the derived shadow and the motion
the light, and that from the object to the spot where the shadow is
moves fast.
[Footnote: There are diagrams inserted before lines 2 and 3 but they
are not reproduced here. The diagram above line 6 is written upon as
219.
173
bright background.
[2] I have found that the stars which are nearest to the horizon
look larger than the others because light falls upon them from a
larger proportion of the solar body than when they are above us; and
having more light from the sun they give more light, and the bodies
which are most luminous appear the largest. As may be seen by the
is ever visible from any spot within the pyramid of pure derived
shadow.
220.
A body on which the solar rays fall between the thin branches of
[2] If an opaque body and a luminous one are (both) spherical the
base of the pyramid of rays will bear the same proportion to the
body.
174
placed opposite to it and farther away from the luminous body than
221.
the points. A light which is broader than the apex but narrower than
degrees of depth.
If an opaque body, smaller than the light, casts two shadows and if
pyramidal body, of which part is smaller, part equal to, and part
175
[Footnote: Between lines 2 and 3 there are in the original two large
diagrams.]
IV.
Perspective of Disappearance.
very nature of the case that the farther explanations given in the
235--239, which treat "Of the importance of light and shade in the
the end I have placed, in the order of the original, those sections
176
from the MS. C which treat of the "Perspective of Disappearance"
(251--262).
222.
since it is by its outlines that we are able to know the real form
a whole, much more must we fail to discern its parts and outlines.
223.
distance is greater, the opaque body will appear smaller, and the
less the distance the larger will the object appear. And this is the
177
follows:--[11]every object as it becomes more remote loses first
those parts which are smallest. Thus of a horse, we should lose the
legs before the head, because the legs are thinner than the head;
and the neck before the body for the same reason. Hence it follows
that the last part of the horse which would be discernible by the
cylindrical form and this would lose its apparent thickness before
its length--according to the 2nd rule given above, &c. [Footnote 23:
this line is generated by the motion of the point and our sight;
An illustration by experiment.
224.
attributes; that is to say: mass, form and colour; and the mass is
at a greater distance than form, but this law does not apply to
178
luminous bodies.
because: if you see a man close to you, you discern the exact
appearance of the mass and of the form and also of the colouring; if
he goes to some distance you will not recognise who he is, because
visible but the larger mass. And the reason is this: We know very
well that all the images of objects reach the senses by a small
fraction of this horizon what space can it fill in that minute image
the eye is very dark, as is the nature of all colored cavities, the
images of distant objects are confused and lost in the great light
of the sky; and if they are visible at all, appear dark and black,
as every small body must when seen in the diffused light of the
atmosphere.
179
A guiding rule.
225.
OBJECTS.
less quantity of the air that lies between the eye and the object
makes the outlines of that object more or less indistinct, you must
An experiment.
226.
When I was once in a place on the sea, at an equal distance from the
shore and the mountains, the distance from the shore looked much
180
227.
two eyes it will not interfere with your seeing any thing that may
228.
The eye cannot take in a luminous angle which is too close to it.
229.
falls at the greater angle. And that part, on which the shadow falls
at the greatest angle, will receive from those rays least of the
230.
OF THE EYE.
The edges of an object placed in front of the pupil of the eye will
181
is shown by the edge of the object n placed in front of the pupil
d; in looking at this edge the pupil also sees all the space a c
which is beyond the edge; and the images the eye receives from that
space are mingled with the images of the edge, so that one image
confuses the other, and this confusion hinders the pupil from
231.
The outlines of objects will be least clear when they are nearest to
objects which are smaller than the pupil of the eye those will be
232.
Objects near to the eye will appear larger than those at a distance.
Objects seen with two eyes will appear rounder than if they are seen
Objects seen between light and shadow will show the most relief.
233.
182
OF PAINTING.
234.
PERSPECTIVE.
Why objects seen at a distance appear large to the eye and in the
PERSPECTIVE.
I ask how far away the eye can discern a non-luminous body, as, for
given in lines 4-6, No. 232. Objects seen with both eyes appear
solid since they are seen from two distinct points of sight
separated by the distance between the eyes, but this solidity cannot
183
The importance of light and shade in the perspective of
disappearance (235-239).
235.
An opaque body seen in a line in which the light falls will reveal
the light, that is to say the lines which transmit the light to the
object a. The eye being at the point b, I say that since the
cannot see any light and shade and, not seeing it, every portion
will appear of the same tone, therefore the relief in the prominent
236.
OF PAINTING.
When you represent in your work shadows which you can only discern
that you apprehend them confusedly, you must not make them sharp or
237.
184
OF PAINTING.
You will observe in drawing that among the shadows some are of
238.
You who draw from nature, look (carefully) at the extent, the
degree, and the form of the lights and shadows on each muscle; and
239.
objects (240-250).
185
240.
241.
OF ORDINARY PERSPECTIVE.
will appear of various breadth. And the more the colours of the
242.
than it is.
186
A light object will look larger when it is seen against a background
243.
OF LIGHT.
OF LIGHT.
OF LIGHT.
I find that any luminous body when seen through a dense and thick
is with the sun by day, as well as the moon and the other eternal
lights by night. And when the air is clear, these luminaries appear
244.
187
That portion of a body of uniform breadth which is against a lighter
12: The diagram to which the text, lines 1-11, refers, is placed in
the original between lines 3 and 4, and is given on Pl. XLI, No. 3.
XLI, No. 4. In the original these are placed after line 14.] That
will look largest which is seen against the darkest background; and
245.
WHY BODIES IN LIGHT AND SHADE HAVE THEIR OUTLINES ALTERED BY THE
THEM.
If you look at a body of which the illuminated portion lies and ends
188
against a dark background, that part of the light which will look
than before, and the highest light will appear to be between the
limit of the background m f and the shadow. The same thing is seen
with regard to the dark [side], inasmuch as that edge of the shaded
l, it looks much darker than the rest. But if this shadow lies
against a dark background, the edge of the shaded part will appear
lighter than before, and the deepest shade will appear between the
246.
189
247.
When you are drawing any object, remember, in comparing the grades
by seeing things lighter than they are. And the reason lies in our
less radiant, will look the brighter and the brighter will seem the
darker.
248.
and equal distance, that will look the darkest which is farthest
249.
190
If you place two lighted candles side by side half a braccio apart,
and go from them to a distance 200 braccia you will see that by the
TO PROVE HOW YOU MAY SEE THE REAL SIZE OF LUMINOUS BODIES.
If you wish to see the real size of these luminous bodies, take a
very thin board and make in it a hole no bigger than the tag of a
lace and place it as close to your eye as possible, so that when you
look through this hole, at the said light, you can see a large space
of air round it. Then by rapidly moving this board backwards and
forwards before your eye you will see the light increase [and
diminish].
250.
Of several bodies of equal size and equally distant from the eye,
those will look the smallest which are against the lightest
background.
to have one side larger than the other in proportion as one is more
191
highly lighted than the other.
251.
PERSPECTIVE.
which the edges of the object terminate and by which they are
bounded, and no object will appear [to stand out] separate from that
eclipse, it comes between our eyes and the sun, appears to the eyes
of men to be close to the sun and affixed to it, because the sun is
252.
253.
The straight edges of a body will appear broken when they are
192
[Footnote: Here again the diagrams in the original have no
254.
Of several bodies, all equally large and equally distant, that which
255.
they are really separate they will appear united as one body.
256.
intervals.
257.
193
258.
length that which has the flattest surface will look the largest. A
bar of iron equally thick throughout and of which half is red hot,
affords an example, for the red hot part looks thicker than the
rest.
259.
Of several bodies of equal size and length, and alike in form and in
260.
narrower and darker. That portion of the wall will be the darkest
f g.
Divide the foregoing proposition into two diagrams, one with the
pyramids of light and shadow, the other with the pyramids of light
[only].
261.
Among shadows of equal depth those which are nearest to the eye will
262.
The more brilliant the light given by a luminous body, the deeper
195
V.
Theory of colours.
267, and 276, while others again (Nos. 281, 282) are headed
Prospettiva.
they afford is but meager and the connection between them but
other (263-272).
263.
OF PAINTING.
196
The hue of an illuminated object is affected by that of the luminous
body.
264.
OF SHADOW.
surrounding objects.
265.
is cast.
266.
mirror.
267.
197
[reflected] colour of the object that may be opposite to it.
EXAMPLE.
with [direct] sunlight on one side of it, and on the other a wall
colour, while the surface on which it is placed may be red, and the
two lateral sides are in shadow, you will see that the natural
colour of that body will assume something of the hue reflected from
those objects. The strongest will be [given by] the luminous body;
the second by the illuminated wall, the third by the shadows. There
will still be a portion which will take a tint from the colour of
the edges.
268.
proportion as those objects are more or less remote and more or less
strongly [coloured].
269.
OF PAINTING.
198
The surface of every opaque body assumes the hues reflected from
surrounding objects.
objects more strongly in proportion as the rays that form the images
And the surface of an opaque body assumes a stronger hue from the
270.
OF THE RAYS WHICH CONVEY THROUGH THE AIR THE IMAGES OF OBJECTS.
All the minutest parts of the image intersect each other without
sides of the hole, opposite to which let s be the eye which sees
and it is the same with regard to m at the middle of the line. The
case is the same with the upper extremity n and the eye u. And
if the end n is red the eye u on that side of the holes will not
the 7th of this where it is said: Every form projects images from
199
&c.
[Footnote: 13. This probably refers to the diagram given under No.
66.]
271.
OF PAINTING.
The surface of a body assumes in some degree the hue of those around
body, and they give it a green colour (by the 2nd [proposition] of
this which shows that blue and yellow make a beautiful green &c.)
And the rest will be set forth in the Book on Painting. In that Book
200
Combination of different colours in cast shadows.
272.
That which casts the shadow does not face it, because the shadows
are produced by the light which causes and surrounds the shadows.
tinge, because the shadow of the body a is cast upon the pavement
at b, where the blue light falls; and the shadow produced by the
them. That light which causes the shadow does not face it.
In the second diagram where four circles are placed in a row we find
201
The effect of colours in the camera obscura (273-274).
273.
274.
them; as is evident, since, if the rays of the sun pass through two
panes of glass in close contact, of which one is blue and the other
but a beautiful green. And the same thing would happen in the eye,
if the images which were yellow or green should mingle where they
[meet and] intersect as they enter the pupil. As this does not
202
OF THE NATURE OF THE RAYS COMPOSED OF THE IMAGES OF OBJECTS,
AND OF
THEIR INTERSECTIONS.
The directness of the rays which transmit the forms and colours of
the bodies whence they proceed does not tinge the air nor can they
affect each other by contact where they intersect. They affect only
the spot where they vanish and cease to exist, because that spot
the eye where these rays are cut off and destroyed, leaving there
the spoil they have conveyed to it. And this is proved by the 4th
hence we may conclude that the spot which, by means of the rays
275.
THE LIGHT.
203
Let n be the source of the shadow e f; it will assume its hue.
the highest light, because here the whole light of the window a d
shadow, because it receives only 1/3 of the light from the window,
of the light from the window is visible. The last grade of shadow is
at f.
well as the text given in No. 148. Lines 7-11 (compare lines 8-12 of
No. 148) which are written within the diagram, evidently apply to
276.
204
The colour of derived shadows is always affected by that of the body
towards which they are cast. To prove this: let an opaque body be
placed between the plane s c t d and the blue light d e and the
red light a b, then I say that d e, the blue light, will fall on
shadows only one single light falls; for this reason these shadows
shadow at o p the blue light does not fall, because the body q r
there and tinges the shadow of a red hue and so a ruddy shadow
the red light a b. Hence we say that the blue light in this
instance causes a red derived shadow from the opaque body q' r',
205
while the red light causes the same body to cast a blue derived
shadow; but the primary shadow [on the dark side of the body itself]
277.
278.
OF PAINTING.
206
colore ma e inpotentia ricettiva d'ogni colore (white is not a
bianco e'l nero non sono veri colori, ma sono alteratione delli
seen in the open air and high up, all its shadows are bluish; and
objects. Now this white [body] being deprived of the light of the
sun by the interposition of some body between the sun and itself,
assumes the colour of the sun and atmosphere; the side on which the
sun does not fall remains in shadow and assumes the hue of the
atmosphere. And if this white object did not reflect the green of
the fields all the way to the horizon nor get the brightness of the
the atmosphere.
279.
Since black, when painted next to white, looks no blacker than when
next to black; and white when next to black looks no whiter than
207
280.
OF COLOURS.
Of several colours, all equally white, that will look whitest which
And red will look most vivid against the yellowest background; and
the same is the case with all colours when surrounded by their
strongest contrasts.
281.
PERSPECTIVE.
the colour [of the object] placed opposite. This may be seen by
208
PERSPECTIVE.
Every opaque and colourless body assumes the hue of the colour
282.
PERSPECTIVE.
That side of an object in light and shade which is towards the light
PERSPECTIVE.
PERSPECTIVE.
209
widest sense, as we often find it used in Leonardo's writings. The
No. 94), while the four following sections are headed merely "pro"
283.
INTENSE.
from b which, let us say, is red. Hence the light reflected from
it, will be affected by the hue of the surface causing it and will
tinge the surface c with red. And if c is also red you will see
it much more intense than b; and if it were yellow you would see
284.
210
Since we see that the quality of colour is known [only] by means of
most shadow the colour will be affected by the tone of that. Hence,
lights.
285.
relief than in any other way; hence I would remind you O Painter! to
dress your figures in the lightest colours you can, since, if you
put them in dark colours, they will be in too slight relief and
all objects are dark. And if you make a dress dark there is little
variety in the lights and shadows, while in light colours there are
many grades.
286.
OF PAINTING.
211
But if these same colours are situated in a well-lighted place, they
THE ADVERSARY.
THE ANSWER.
the shadows in which they lie are deeper. And evidence of this is to
be had by looking from an open space into the doorways of dark and
It is the light side of an object in light and shade which shows the
true colour.
287.
212
Treat of the rainbow in the last book on Painting, but first write
288.
The colours of the rainbow are not produced by the sun, for they
though the sun does not fall on it, will produce on one side all the
colours of the rainbow; as you may see by placing the glass between
the day light and your eye in such a way as that it is close to the
eye, while on one side the glass admits the [diffused] light of the
atmosphere, and on the other side the shadow of the wall on one side
turning the glass round you will see these colours all round the
bubbles in the glass &c. And the rest shall be said in its place.
In the experiment just described, the eye would seem to have some
213
share in the colours of the rainbow, since these bubbles in the
glass do not display the colours except through the medium of the
eye. But, if you place the glass full of water on the window sill,
rays, you will see the same colours produced in the spot of light
thrown through the glass and upon the floor, in a dark place, below
the window; and as the eye is not here concerned in it, we may
evidently, and with certainty pronounce that the eye has no share in
producing them.
roots of turnips kept for some time at the bottom of wells or other
stagnant waters [we see] that each root displays colours similar to
those of the real rainbow. They may also be seen when oil has been
placed on the top of water and in the solar rays reflected from the
colours between the atmosphere and the dark body; and in many other
214
circumstances which I will not mention, as these suffice for my
purpose.
VI.
and
that he must have dwelt with particular pleasure on this part of his
215
289.
290.
291.
An exceptional case.
292.
Of the edges [outlines] of shadows. Some have misty and ill defined
216
No opaque body can be devoid of light and shade, except it is in a
darkness.
which have limbs and parts, those sides of limbs which face each
other reflect on each other the accidental [hue and tone] of their
surface.
An experiment.
293.
by the greater. For instance: We, in a house, can see that all the
visible when the windows of the house are open; but if we were to go
out of the house and look in at the windows from a little distance
217
should see an uniform deep and colourless shadow.
294.
PRACTICE.
first tree have a very steady plate of glass and keep your eye very
over the form of that tree. Then move it on one side so far as that
the real tree is close by the side of the tree you have drawn; then
colour your drawing in such a way as that in colour and form the two
may be alike, and that both, if you close one eye, seem to be
painted on the glass and at the same distance. Then, by the same
hundred braccia between each. And these will serve as a standard and
guide whenever you work on your own pictures, wherever they may
apply, and will enable you to give due distance in those works. [14]
But I have found that as a rule the second is 4/5 of the first when
218
[Footnote: This chapter is one of those copied in the Manuscript of
the Vatican library Urbinas 1270, and the original text is rendered
finde aber als Regel, dass der zweite um vier Funftel des ersten
(?)". He adds in his commentary: "Das Ende der Nummer ist wohl
295.
OF AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.
buildings beyond a wall, all of which, as they appear above the top
of the wall, look of the same size, while you wish to represent them
in a picture as more remote one than another and to give the effect
219
consequence of the great quantity of atmosphere between your eye and
itself [Footnote 10: quado il sole e per leuante (when the sun is
copy "wenn namlich die Sonne (dahinter) im Osten steht".] when the
sun is in the East [Footnote 11: See Footnote 10]. Hence you must
make the nearest building above the wall of its real colour, but the
more distant ones make less defined and bluer. Those you wish should
look farthest away you must make proportionately bluer; thus, if one
this rule the buildings which above a [given] line appear of the
296.
The medium lying between the eye and the object seen, tinges that
object with its colour, as the blueness of the atmosphere makes the
distant mountains appear blue and red glass makes objects seen
beyond it, look red. The light shed round them by the stars is
obscured by the darkness of the night which lies between the eye and
297.
220
Take care that the perspective of colour does not disagree with the
size of your objects, hat is to say: that the colours diminish from
298.
PORTION.
Because the atmosphere is dense near the earth, and the higher it is
the rarer it becomes. When the sun is in the East if you look
towards the West and a little way to the South and North, you will
see that this dense atmosphere receives more light from the sun than
the rarer; because the rays meet with greater resistance. And if the
sky, as you see it, ends on a low plain, that lowest portion of the
sky will be seen through a denser and whiter atmosphere, which will
weaken its true colour as seen through that medium, and there the
sky will look whiter than it is above you, where the line of sight
And if you turn to the East, the atmosphere will appear darker as
you look lower down because the luminous rays pass less freely
221
299.
level ground is denser than the rest, and that where it is higher
and lofty objects which are at a distance are not much seen, because
you see them along a line which passes through a denser and thicker
this reason the farther this line extends from your eye, from point
Painter! when you represent mountains, see that from hill to hill
the bases are paler than the summits, and in proportion as they
recede beyond each other make the bases paler than the summits;
while, the higher they are the more you must show of their true form
and colour.
300.
222
OF THE COLOUR OF THE ATMOSPHERE.
lies beyond and includes it. And this may be seen, as I saw it by
M'oboso (compare No. 301 line 20) its identity will be discussed
the Alps which divide France from Italy. The base of this mountain
directions through the whole of Europe. And no mountain has its base
clouds; and snow seldom falls there, but only hail in the summer,
when the clouds are highest. And this hail lies [unmelted] there, so
that if it were not for the absorption of the rising and falling
ice would be piled up there by the hail, and in the middle of July I
found it very considerable. There I saw above me the dark sky, and
the sun as it fell on the mountain was far brighter here than in the
colour of the atmosphere I will mention the smoke of old and dry
blue, when seen between the eye and the dark distance. But as it
223
rises, and comes between the eye and the bright atmosphere, it at
longer has darkness beyond it, but this bright and luminous space.
If the smoke is from young, green wood, it will not appear blue,
lights and shadows like a solid body. The same occurs with the
blue were the natural colour of the atmosphere, it would follow that
wherever a larger mass air intervened between the eye and the
between the eye and the sphere of fire, it is seen much whiter. This
occurs towards the horizon. And the less the extent of atmosphere
between the eye and the sphere of fire, the deeper is the blue
say, that the atmosphere assumes this azure hue by reason of the
particles of moisture which catch the rays of the sun. Again, we may
the sun beams admitted through holes into a dark chamber, when the
former will look ash grey and the thin smoke will appear of a most
224
beautiful blue; and it may be seen again in in the dark shadows of
distant mountains when the air between the eye and those shadows
will look very blue, though the brightest parts of those mountains
will not differ much from their true colour. But if any one wishes
for a final proof let him paint a board with various colours, among
them an intense black; and over all let him lay a very thin and
transparent white will nowhere show a more beautiful blue than over
301.
Experience shows us that the air must have darkness beyond it and
dry wood and the rays of the sun fall on this smoke, and if you then
place behind the smoke a piece of black velvet on which the sun does
not shine, you will see that all the smoke which is between the eye
and the black stuff will appear of a beautiful blue colour. And if
instead of the velvet you place a white cloth smoke, that is too
thick smoke, hinders, and too thin smoke does not produce, the
and in a dark chamber where the sun beams are admitted produces
these blue rays and the more vividly if it is distilled water, and
225
thin smoke looks blue. This I mention in order to show that the
these instances are given for those who cannot confirm my experience
on Monboso.
302.
When the smoke from dry wood is seen between the eye of the
spectator and some dark space [or object], it will look blue. Thus
the sky looks blue by reason of the darkness beyond it. And if you
look towards the horizon of the sky, you will see the atmosphere is
not blue, and this is caused by its density. And thus at each
degree, as you raise your eyes above the horizon up to the sky over
your head, you will see the atmosphere look darker [blue] and this
is because a smaller density of air lies between your eye and the
becomes rarer between you and the [outer] darkness; and this will be
That smoke will look bluest which rises from the driest wood and
303.
226
A dark object will appear bluest in proportion as it has a greater
304.
305.
In the morning the mist is denser above than below, because the sun
also, the sky looks darkest [in colour] overhead, and towards the
horizon it is not blue but rather between smoke and dust colour.
only appears of the colour of clouds, which shine white when the
weather is fine. And the more you turn to the west the darker it
will be, and the brighter as you look to the east. And the verdure
one.
The buildings in the west will only show their illuminated side,
227
where the sun shines, and the mist hides the rest. When the sun
rises and chases away the haze, the hills on the side where it lifts
begin to grow clearer, and look blue, and seem to smoke with the
vanishing mists; and the buildings reveal their lights and shadows;
through the thinner vapour they show only their lights and through
the thicker air nothing at all. This is when the movement of the
mist makes it part horizontally, and then the edges of the mist will
be indistinct against the blue of the sky, and towards the earth it
will look almost like dust blown up. In proportion as the atmosphere
look fewer, because only the tallest and largest will be seen.
Darkness affects every thing with its hue, and the more an object
differs from darkness, the more we see its real and natural colour.
The mountains will look few, because only those will be seen which
of the hills becomes divided and vanishes indeed towards the top.
There is less [mist] between lower and nearer hills and yet little
306.
between the eye and that object, that is of the colour of the
228
transparent medium lying between the object and the eye; and among
colour of the medium lying between the object and the eye.
307. OF PAINTING.
Of various colours which are none of them blue that which at a great
Hence the green of fields will assume a bluer hue than yellow or
white will, and conversely yellow or white will change less than
VII.
figure must have been for the most part completed and written before
229
The selection of Leonardo's axioms contained in the Vatican copy
LOMAZZO, again, in his Idea del Tempio della Pittura Milano 1590,
cap. IV, says: "Lionardo Vinci ... dimostro anco in figura tutte
The Vatican copy includes but very few sections of the "Universale
misura del huomo" and until now nothing has been made known of the
original MSS. on the subject which have supplied the very extensive
the interest which the subject itself must command. Luca Paciolo
would seem to have had these MSS. (which I have distinguished by the
initials W. P.) in his mind when he wrote the passage quoted above.
Still, certain notes of a later date--such as Nos. 360, 362 and 363,
the Human Figure final and complete, as we might suppose from Luca
230
the anatomical studies which he was pursuing zvith so much zeal
Proportion.
308.
Every man, at three years old is half the full height he will grow
to at last.
309.
If a man 2 braccia high is too small, one of four is too tall, the
take a man of 3 braccia in height and measure him by the rule I will
give you. If you tell me that I may be mistaken, and judge a man to
that you must look at many men of 3 braccia, and out of the larger
number who are alike in their limbs choose one of those who are most
graceful and take your measurements. The length of the hand is 1/3
section are illustrated in part on Pl. XI.] is the same, and from
231
the pit of the throat to the shoulder, and from the shoulder to the
nipple, and from one nipple to the other, and from each nipple to
310.
The space between the parting of the lips [the mouth] and the base
The space from the mouth to the bottom of the chin c d is the
fourth part of the face and equal to the width of the mouth.
The space from the chin to the base of the nose e f is the third
part of the face and equal to the length of the nose and to the
forehead.
The distance from the middle of the nose to the bottom of the chin
The distance from the top of the nose, where the eyebrows begin, to
The space from the parting of the lips to the top of the chin l m,
that is where the chin ends and passes into the lower lip of the
232
mouth, is the third of the distance from the parting of the lips to
the bottom of the chin and is the twelfth part of the face. From the
top to the bottom of the chin m n is the sixth part of the face
equal to the space between the mouth and the bottom of the chin, and
The distance from the top of the throat to the pit of the throat
below q r is half the length of the face and the eighteenth part
of a man's height.
From the chin to the back of the neck s t, is the same distance as
between the mouth and the roots of the hair, that is three quarters
of the head.
From the chin to the jaw bone v x is half the head and equal to
The thickness of the head from the brow to the nape is once and 3/4
[Footnote: The drawings to this text, lines 1-10 are on Pl. VII, No.
I. The two upper sketches of heads, Pl. VII, No. 2, belong to lines
11-14, and in the original are placed immediately below the sketches
233
reproduced on Pl. VII, No. 1.]
311.
The distance from the attachment of one ear to the other is equal to
that from the meeting of the eyebrows to the chin, and in a fine
face the width of the mouth is equal to the length from the parting
312.
The cut or depression below the lower lip of the mouth is half way
between the bottom of the nose and the bottom of the chin.
The face forms a square in itself; that is its width is from the
outer corner of one eye to the other, and its height is from the
very top of the nose to the bottom of the lower lip of the mouth;
then what remains above and below this square amounts to the height
the chin. The ear is exactly as long as the nose. It is as far from
seen in profile slopes to the angle of the jaw. The ear should be as
234
high as from the bottom of the nose to the top of the eye-lid. The
space between the eyes is equal to the width of an eye. The ear is
over the middle of the neck, when seen in profile. The distance from
[Footnote: See Pl. VIII, No. I, where the text of lines 3-13 is also
given in facsimile.]
313.
(a b) is equal to (c d).
[Footnote: See Pl. VII, No. 3. Reference may also be made here to
given on Pl. XVII, No. 2.--A head, to the left, with part of the
torso [W. P. 5a], No. 1 on the same plate is from MS. A 2b and in
has reproduced this head and discussed it fully [note on page 12];
in no way justified. The sketch, as we see it, can hardly have been
235
human head. At the same time we see that the proportions of this
315.
From the eyebrow to the junction of the lip with the chin, and the
angle of the jaw and the upper angle where the ear joins the temple
will be a perfect square. And each side by itself is half the head.
The hollow of the cheek bone occurs half way between the tip of the
nose and the top of the jaw bone, which is the lower angle of the
From the angle of the eye-socket to the ear is as far as the length
[Footnote: See Pl. IX. The text, in the original is written behind
the head. The handwriting would seem to indicate a date earlier than
236
316.
the bottom of the nose to the meeting of the lips in the middle of
the mouth. From the inner corner of the eye m to the top of the
X--which belongs to this chapter has been partly drawn over in ink
by Leonardo himself.]
317.
From the top of the head to the bottom of the chin is 1/9, and from
the roots of the hair to the chin is 1/9 of the distance from the
roots of the hair to the ground. The greatest width of the face is
equal to the space between the mouth and the roots of the hair and
is 1/12 of the whole height. From the top of the ear to the top of
the head is equal to the distance from the bottom of the chin to the
lachrymatory duct of the eye; and also equal to the distance from
the angle of the chin to that of the jaw; that is the 1/16 of the
whole. The small cartilage which projects over the opening of the
ear towards the nose is half-way between the nape and the eyebrow;
237
the chin and the eyes, and to the space between the chin and the
318.
319.
a c and a f are equal to the space between one eye and the
other.
from the inner [lachrymatory] corner of the eye to its outer corner;
and in like manner the division between the chin and the mouth; and
in the same way the narrowest part of the nose between the eyes. And
equal to the length of the eye or of the space between the eyes.
238
m c is 1/3 of n m measuring from the outer corner of the eyelids
320.
The distance between the centres of the pupils of the eyes is 1/3 of
the face. The space between the outer corners of the eyes, that is
where the eye ends in the eye socket which contains it, thus the
The greatest width of the face at the line of the eyes is equal to
the distance from the roots of the hair in front to the parting of
the lips.
[Footnote: There are, with this section, two sketches of eyes, not
reproduced here.]
321.
The nose will make a double square; that is the width of the nose at
the nostrils goes twice into the length from the tip of the nose to
the eyebrows. And, in the same way, in profile the distance from the
extreme side of the nostril where it joins the cheek to the tip of
the nose is equal to the width of the nose in front from one nostril
239
to the other. If you divide the whole length of the nose--that is
from the tip to the insertion of the eyebrows, into 4 equal parts,
you will find that one of these parts extends from the tip of the
nostrils to the base of the nose, and the upper division lies
between the inner corner of the eye and the insertion of the
eyebrows; and the two middle parts [together] are equal to the
[Footnote: The two bottom sketches on Pl. VII, No. 4 face the six
322.
The great toe is the sixth part of the foot, taking the measure in
profile, on the inside of the foot, from where this toe springs from
the ball of the sole of the foot to its tip a b; and it is equal
to the distance from the mouth to the bottom of the chin. If you
draw the foot in profile from the outside, make the little toe begin
at three quarters of the length of the foot, and you will find the
323.
240
d.
324.
The foot is as much longer than the hand as the thickness of the arm
Again, you will find that the foot is as much longer than the hand
as the space between the inner angle of the little toe to the last
projection of the big toe, if you measure along the length of the
foot.
The palm of the hand without the fingers goes twice into the length
If you hold your hand with the fingers straight out and close
together you will find it to be of the same width as the widest part
And if you measure from the prominence of the inner ancle to the end
of the great toe you will find this measure to be as long as the
whole hand.
From the top angle of the foot to the insertion of the toes is equal
241
to the hand from wrist joint to the tip of the thumb.
The smallest width of the hand is equal to the smallest width of the
foot between its joint into the leg and the insertion of the toes.
The width of the heel at the lower part is equal to that of the arm
where it joins the hand; and also to the leg where it is thinnest
The length of the longest toe, from its first division from the
great toe to its tip is the fourth of the foot from the centre of
the ancle bone to the tip, and it is equal to the width of the
mouth. The distance between the mouth and the chin is equal to that
of the knuckles and of the three middle fingers and to the length of
their first joints if the hand is spread, and equal to the distance
from the joint of the thumb to the outset of the nails, that is the
The space between the extreme poles inside and outside the foot
325.
The foot, from where it is attached to the leg, to the tip of the
great toe is as long as the space between the upper part of the chin
242
and the roots of the hair a b; and equal to five sixths of the
face.
326.
toes are all equally thick from the nail at the top to the bottom,
[Footnote: See Pl. XIV, No. 1, a drawing of a foot with the text in
327.
The whole length of the foot will lie between the elbow and the
wrist and between the elbow and the inner angle of the arm towards
the breast when the arm is folded. The foot is as long as the whole
head of a man, that is from under the chin to the topmost part of
the head[Footnote 2: nel modo che qui i figurato. See Pl. VII, No.
4, the upper figure. The text breaks off at the end of line 2 and
the text given under No. 321 follows below. It may be here remarked
243
328.
here and later on measured on the right side of the foot as seen by
than that inside a. The half of the whole height of the leg from
the foot r, is half way between the prominence s and the ground
2/3 of the length from the chin to the top of the head; z r is 5/6
No. 2.]
244
measurement however obliges us to read 7 for 6.] a b goes six
[Footnote: 22-27. Compare with this lines 18-24 of No. 331, and the
between the genitals and the sole of the foot; [Footnote 35: 2 is
not to be found in the sketch which renders the passage obscure. The
section should be compared with the text No. 331, lines 1-13, and
245
329.
The length of the foot from the end of the toes to the heel goes
twice into that from the heel to the knee, that is where the leg
330.
makes 2 feet.
331.
m n o are equal. The narrowest width of the leg seen in front goes
8 times from the sole of the foot to the joint of the knee, and is
the same width as the arm, seen in front at the wrist, and as the
longest measure of the ear, and as the three chief divisions into
which we divide the face; and this measurement goes 4 times from the
wrist joint of the hand to the point of the elbow. [14] The foot is
as long as the space from the knee between a and b; and the
[18] The least thickness of the leg in profile goes 6 times from the
sole of the foot to the knee joint and is the same width as the
246
space between the outer corner of the eye and the opening of the
ear, and as the thickest part of the arm seen in profile and between
the inner corner of the eye and the insertion of the hair.
from the sole of the foot to the centre of the knee and the same
[Footnote: See Pl. XV. The text of lines 2-17 is to the left of the
front view of the leg, to which it refers. Lines 18-27 are in the
middle column and refer to the leg seen in profile and turned to the
left, on the right hand side of the writing. Lines 20-30 are above,
332.
In kneeling down a man will lose the fourth part of his height.
247
When a man kneels down with his hands folded on his breast the navel
will mark half his height and likewise the points of the elbows.
Half the height of a man who sits--that is from the seat to the top
of the head--will be where the arms fold below the breast, and
the top of the head--will be more than half the man's [whole height]
333.
The cubit is one fourth of the height of a man and is equal to the
the other is two faces and is equal to the distance from the top of
seem more accurate to read here dal detto ombilico.] From this
[Footnote: Compare with this the sketches on the other page of the
248
334.
From the roots of the hair to the top of the breast a b is the
From the outside part of one shoulder to the other is the same
distance as from the top of the breast to the navel and this measure
goes four times from the sole of the foot to the lower end of the
nose.
The [thickness of] the arm where it springs from the shoulder in
front goes 6 times into the space between the two outside edges of
the shoulders and 3 times into the face, and four times into the
length of the foot and three into the hand, inside or outside.
[Footnote: The three sketches Pl. XIV, No. 2 belong to this text.]
The relative proportions of the torso and of the leg (335. 336).
335.
a b c are equal to each other and to the space from the armpit of
the shoulder to the genitals and to the distance from the tip of the
fingers of the hand to the joint of the arm, and to the half of the
breast; and you must know that c b is the third part of the height
249
of a man from the shoulders to the ground; d e f are equal to each
336.
of the calf of the leg on the inside of the thigh.--The end of the
swelling of the shin bone of the leg. [6] The smallest thickness of
337.
250
338.
339.
The opening of the ear, the joint of the shoulder, that of the hip
340.
From the chin to the roots of the hair is 1/10 of the whole figure.
From the joint of the palm of the hand to the tip of the longest
finger is 1/10. From the chin to the top of the head 1/8; and from
the pit of the stomach to the top of the breast is 1/6, and from the
pit below the breast bone to the top of the head 1/4. From the chin
to the nostrils 1/3 Part of the face, the same from the nostrils to
the brow and from the brow to the roots of the hair, and the foot is
341.
The width of the shoulders is 1/4 of the whole. From the joint of
the shoulder to the hand is 1/3, from the parting of the lips to
251
below the shoulder-blade is one foot.
The greatest thickness of a man from the breast to the spine is one
8th of his height and is equal to the space between the bottom of
342.
The width of a man under the arms is the same as at the hips.
A man's width across the hips is equal to the distance from the top
of the hip to the bottom of the buttock, when a man stands equally
balanced on both feet; and there is the same distance from the top
of the hip to the armpit. The waist, or narrower part above the hips
will be half way between the arm pits and the bottom of the buttock.
[Footnote: The lower sketch Pl. XVI, No. 2, is drawn by the side of
line 1.]
343.
252
Vitruvius, the architect, says in his work on architecture that the
that is that 4 fingers make 1 palm, and 4 palms make 1 foot, 6 palms
make 1 cubit; 4 cubits make a man's height. And 4 cubits make one
pace and 24 palms make a man; and these measures he used in his
1/14 and spread and raise your arms till your middle fingers touch
the level of the top of your head you must know that the centre of
the outspread limbs will be in the navel and the space between the
From the roots of the hair to the bottom of the chin is the tenth of
a man's height; from the bottom of the chin to the top of his head
is one eighth of his height; from the top of the breast to the top
of his head will be one sixth of a man. From the top of the breast
to the roots of the hair will be the seventh part of the whole man.
From the nipples to the top of the head will be the fourth part of a
fourth part of the man. From the elbow to the tip of the hand will
be the fifth part of a man; and from the elbow to the angle of the
armpit will be the eighth part of the man. The whole hand will be
the tenth part of the man; the beginning of the genitals marks the
middle of the man. The foot is the seventh part of the man. From the
253
sole of the foot to below the knee will be the fourth part of the
man. From below the knee to the beginning of the genitals will be
the fourth part of the man. The distance from the bottom of the chin
to the nose and from the roots of the hair to the eyebrows is, in
each case the same, and like the ear, a third of the face.
and 33 1/2 long. At the ends of the scale below the figure are
written the words diti (fingers) and palmi (palms). The passage
344.
345.
254
From the tip of the longest finger of the hand to the shoulder joint
[Footnote: Lines 1-3 are given on Pl. XV below the front view of the
leg; lines 4 and 5 are below again, on the left side. The lettering
346.
The hand from the longest finger to the wrist joint goes 4 times
347.
a b c are equal to each other and to the foot and to the space
between the nipple and the navel d e will be the third part of the
whole man.
a cubit.
255
348.
thickness of the arm between the elbow and the hand goes 6 times
between the shoulder and the elbow goes 4 times into c m, and is
h 3 which is found between the inner joint of the arm and the
wrist joint.
[11]The width of the wrist goes 12 times into the whole arm; that is
from the tip of the fingers to the shoulder joint; that is 3 times
length, that is in the length from the shoulder to the elbow, and
this increase is equal to the thickness of the arm at the wrist when
seen in profile. And the space between the bottom of the chin and
fingers, and to the width of the mouth and to the space between the
roots of the hair on the forehead and the top of the head [Footnote:
256
accompanying sketch of the bones of the arm.]. All these distances
are equal to each other, but they are not equal to the
The arm between the elbow and wrist never increases by being bent or
extended.
The arm, from the shoulder to the inner joint when extended.
bent n a diminishes 1/6 of its length and p n does the same. The
outer elbow joint increases 1/7 when bent; and thus by being bent it
bending, it is found that whereas the arm from where it joins the
side to the wrist, was 2 heads and a half, in bending it loses the
half head and measures only two: one from the [shoulder] joint to
the end [by the elbow], and the other to the hand.
The arm when folded will measure 2 faces up to the shoulder from the
elbow and 2 from the elbow to the insertion of the four fingers on
the palm of the hand. The length from the base of the fingers to the
257
however drawn to different proportions.] The length from the
shoulder to the elbow is the same as from the base of the thumb,
goes 6 times between the knuckles of the hand and the dimple of the
elbow when extended and 14 times in the whole arm and 42 in the
equal to the greatest thickness of the arm in front; but the first
is placed at a third of the arm from the shoulder joint to the elbow
and the other at a third from the elbow towards the hand.
[Footnote: Compare Pl. XVII. Lines 1-10 and 11-15 are written in two
columns below the extended arm, and at the tips of the fingers we
find the words: fine d'unghie (ends of the nails). Part of the
349.
From the top of the shoulder to the point of the elbow is as far as
from that point to the joints of the four fingers with the palm of
258
[5]a e is equal to the palm of the hand, r f and o g are equal
between a and s.
y l is the fleshy part of the arm and measures one head; and when
between the shoulder and the elbow and it is 1/8 of the whole arm r
[Footnote: See Pl. XX where the text is also seen from lines 5-23.]
350.
In the innermost bend of the joints of every limb the reliefs are
259
utmost. And in this very great mistakes are often made by those who
occur more in the middle of the sides than in front, and more at the
351.
When the arm is bent at an angle at the elbow, it will produce some
angle; the more acute the angle is, the more will the muscles within
352.
OF PAINTING.
The arm, as it turns, thrusts back its shoulder towards the middle
of the back.
353.
260
backwards, to right and to left, in a circular motion, up or down,
together.
354.
bending them. This extension and bending vary in manner; that is,
bend, or extend, half way, at the 2nd joint; and sometimes they bend
in their whole length and in all the three joints at once. If the 2
first joints are hindered from bending, then the 3rd joint can be
bent with greater ease than before; it can never bend of itself, if
the other joints are free, unless all three joints are bent. Besides
are up and down, the two others from side to side; and each of these
ceasing to act, the other takes up the movement. The tendons are
made thick inside the fingers and thin outside; and the tendons
inside are attached to every joint but outside they are not.
261
fingers at the 3 joints.
355.
the arm, going up and down, inwards and outwards, to the back and to
And do the same with reference to the neck, hands and feet and the
356.
and two are the lateral muscles which move it forward and backward,
downwards.
The muscle d acts with the muscle c when the arm moves forward;
[Footnote: See Pl. XXI. In the original the lettering has been
262
written in ink upon the red chalk drawing and the outlines of the
357.
The loins or backbone being bent. The breasts are are always lower
If the breast bone is arched the breasts are higher than the
shoulderblades.
If the loins are upright the breast will always be found at the same
358.
a b the tendon and ankle in raising the heel approach each other
breadth.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXII, No. 2. Compare this facsimile and text with
Pl. III, No. 2, and p. 152 of MANZI'S edition. Also with No. 274 of
263
LUDWIG'S edition of the Vatican Copy.]
359.
size so does the opposite upper part increase beyond its [normal]
size. The navel does not change its position to the male organ; and
this shrinking arises because when a figure stands on one foot, that
This being so, the middle between the shoulders is thrust above it
out of it perpendicular line, and this line, which forms the central
line of the external parts of the body, becomes bent at its upper
extremity [so as to be] above the foot which supports the body; and
the transverse lines are forced into such angles that their ends are
360.
OF PAINTING.
Note in the motions and attitudes of figures how the limbs vary, and
their feeling, for the shoulderblades in the motions of the arms and
264
shoulders vary the [line of the] back bone very much. And you will
361.
The pit of the throat is over the feet, and by throwing one arm
forward the pit of the throat is thrown off that foot. And if the
leg is thrown forward the pit of the throat is thrown forward; and.
362.
OF PAINTING.
Indicate which are the muscles, and which the tendons, which become
And in each express the alterations in the limbs and joints, which
265
swell and which grow thinner.
363.
your painting by your wish to make your nude figures display all
what manner the muscles clothe or cover their bones in old or lean
persons; and besides this, observe the rule as to how these same
muscles fill up the spaces of the surface that extend between them,
which are the muscles which never lose their prominence in any
amount of fatness; and which too are the muscles of which the
many cases several muscles look like one single muscle in the
Again, do not fail [to observe] the variations in the forms of the
above mentioned muscles, round and about the joints of the limbs of
266
[Footnote: DE ROSSI remarks on this chapter, in the Roman edition of
Note, that Leonardo wrote this passage in Rome, probably under the
364.
and boys for, in man, from the top of the shoulder [by the neck] to
the elbow, and from the elbow to the tip of the thumb and from one
home of the intellect, before forming that which contains the vital
elements.
365.
OF PAINTING.
Which are the muscles which subdivide in old age or in youth, when
267
becoming lean? Which are the parts of the limbs of the human frame
where no amount of fat makes the flesh thicker, nor any degree of
The thing sought for in this question will be found in all the
finger-joints, hips, knees, ankle-bone and toes and the like; all of
any limb is at the part of the muscles which is farthest from its
attachments.
Flesh never increases on those portions of the limb where the bones
all those parts which feel most pain under a blow; and these are the
shin of the leg, the forehead, and the nose. And this was done for
the preservation of man, since, if such pain were not felt in these
Describe why the bones of the arm and leg are double near the hand
268
limbs.
366.
OF PAINTING.
parts: that is with short and thick arms, wide thick hands, with
with the rest. I would have the same thing understood as applying to
367.
that they must appear to agree with the size of the body and
likewise to the age. Thus a youth has limbs that are not very
muscular not strongly veined, and the surface is delicate and round,
and tender in colour. In man the limbs are sinewy and muscular,
while in old men the surface is wrinkled, rugged and knotty, and the
269
HOW YOUNG BOYS HAVE THEIR JOINTS JUST THE REVERSE OF THOSE OF
MEN,
AS TO SIZE.
Little children have all the joints slender and the portions between
them are thick; and this happens because nothing but the skin covers
the joints without any other flesh and has the character of sinew,
connecting the bones like a ligature. And the fat fleshiness is laid
on between one joint and the next, and between the skin and the
bones. But, since the bones are thicker at the joints than between
which it had, between the skin and the bones; whence the skin clings
more closely to the bone and the limbs grow more slender. But since
there is nothing over the joints but the cartilaginous and sinewy
skin this cannot dry up, and, not drying up, cannot shrink. Thus,
and for this reason, children are slender at the joints and fat
arms, and shoulders, which are slender and dimpled, while in man on
the contrary all the joints of the fingers, arms, and legs are
368.
270
movement, running, standing, supported, sitting, leaning, kneeling,
[As to how a figure should stand with a weight in its hand [Footnote
369.
A sitting man cannot raise himself if that part of his body which is
front of his axis [centre of gravity] does not weigh more than that
which is behind that axis [or centre] without using his arms.
throw the most weight forward, on the higher foot, rather than
behind--that is in front of the axis and not behind it. Hence a man
The faster a man runs, the more he leans forward towards the point
he runs to and throws more weight in front of his axis than behind.
A man who runs down hill throws the axis onto his heels, and one who
runs up hill throws it into the points of his feet; and a man
running on level ground throws it first on his heels and then on the
271
This man cannot carry his own weight unless, by drawing his body
back he balances the weight in front, in such a way as that the foot
370.
on level ground.
371.
A man when walking across a long level plain first leans [rather]
[Footnote 3-6: He strides forward with the air of a man going down
hill.]
372.
A man when running throws less weight on his legs than when standing
still. And in the same way a horse which is running feels less the
272
weight of the man he carries. Hence many persons think it wonderful
that, in running, the horse can rest on one single foot. From this
centre.
373.
If a man, in taking a jump from firm ground, can leap 3 braccia, and
when he was taking his leap it were to recede 1/3 of a braccio, that
would be taken off his former leap; and so if it were thrust forward
374.
OF DRAWING.
carries a moving body with a momentum equal to 4 and the moving body
wants to turn and fall back with a momentum of 4, then one momentum
273
375.
When a man wants to stop running and check the impetus he is forced
to hang back and take short quick steps. [Footnote: Lines 5-31 refer
to the two upper figures, and the lower figure to the right is
a man who lifts one of his feet from the ground always rests on the
the lower leg, so that the labour of this lower leg is limited to
moving itself.
The first thing a man does in mounting steps is to relieve the leg
that leg; and besides this, he gives to the opposite leg all the
rest of the bulk of the whole man, including [the weight of] the
other leg; he then raises the other leg and sets the foot upon the
restores to the upper foot all the weight of the body and of the leg
itself, and places his hand on his thigh and throws his head forward
and repeats the movement towards the point of the upper foot,
quickly lifting the heel of the lower one; and with this impetus he
lifts himself up and at the same time extends the arm which rested
on his knee; and this extension of the arm carries up the body and
274
the head, and so straightens the spine which was curved.
[32] The higher the step is which a man has to mount, the farther
[Footnote: See Pl. XXIII, No. 1. The lower sketch to the left
376.
man.
377.
In going up stairs if you place your hands on your knees all the
labour taken by the arms is removed from the sinews at the back of
the knees.
275
[Footnote: See Pl. XXIII, No. 3.]
378.
The sinew which guides the leg, and which is connected with the
upwards, in proportion as the leg is more bent; and the muscle which
acts upon the angle made by the thigh where it joins the body has
less difficulty and has a less weight to lift, because it has not
the [additional] weight of the thigh itself. And besides this it has
379.
A man coming down hill takes little steps, because the weight rests
upon the hinder foot, while a man mounting takes wide steps, because
380.
276
When you want to represent a man as moving some weight consider what
a man does who stoops forward to take up a weight which he will lift
with ropes passed through pullies [Footnote 10: Compare the sketch
on page 198 and on 201 (S. K. M. II.1 86b).]. And here remember that
distant from his fulcrum, and to this is added the force given by
381.
Again, a man has even a greater store of strength in his legs than
he needs for his own weight; and to see if this is true, make a man
stand on the shore-sand and then put another man on his back, and
you will see how much he will sink in. Then take the man from off
his back and make him jump straight up as high as he can, and you
will find that the print of his feet will be made deeper by the jump
than from having the man on his back. Hence, here, by 2 methods it
382.
277
OF PAINTING.
or carrying a weight equal to his own, in what way must you set on
383.
more than his own weight. And if he has to raise it he will [be able
to] raise as much more than his weight as his strength may be more
than that of other men. [Footnote 7: The stroke at the end of this
apply, with equal velocity and impetus, will be when he sets his
feet on one end of the balance [or lever] and then presses his
shoulders against some stable body. This will raise a weight at the
278
other end of the balance [lever], equal to his own weight and [added
384.
No animal can simply move [by its dead weight] a greater weight than
the sum of its own weight outside the centre of his fulcrum.
385.
A man who wants to send an arrow very far from the bow must be
standing entirely on one foot and raising the other so far from the
body which is thrown on the front foot. And he must not hold his arm
fully extended, and in order that he may be more able to bear the
extending from the hand to the breast, and when he wishes to shoot
he suddenly leaps forward at the same instant and extends his arm
with the bow and releases the string. And if he dexterously does
386.
When two men are at the opposite ends of a plank that is balanced,
and if they are of equal weight, and if one of them wants to make a
leap into the air, then his leap will be made down from his end of
279
the plank and the man will never go up again but must remain in his
place till the man at the other end dashes up the board.
387.
miscellaneous nature.]
388.
some one direction? [Footnote 1: The paper has been damaged at the
in the line d e but not so completely but that some of its force
e with the force of the motive power, and it must follow than the
between lines 7 and 8. Compare also the sketches on Pl. LIV.] A man
280
who has to deal a great blow with his weapon prepares himself with
all his force on the opposite side to that where the spot is which
389.
Observe the motion of the surface of the water which resembles that
of hair, and has two motions, of which one goes on with the flow of
the surface, the other forms the lines of the eddies; thus the water
forms eddying whirlpools one part of which are due to the impetus of
the principal current and the other to the incidental motion and
return flow.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXV. Where also the text of this passage is given
in facsimile.]
On draperies (390--392).
390.
281
confined will fall most nearly in its natural form.
equal density and thickness on its wrong side and on its right, has
constraint in the part where it is most confined; and the part which
is farthest from this constraint you will see relapses most into the
EXAMPLE.
drapery is held fast. I maintain that the part of the drapery which
is farthest from the plaited ends will revert most to its natural
form.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXVIII, No. 6, and compare the drawing from
391.
282
OF SMALL FOLDS IN DRAPERIES.
How figures dressed in a cloak should not show the shape so much as
that the cloak looks as if it were next the flesh; since you surely
cannot wish the cloak to be next the flesh, for you must suppose
that between the flesh and the cloak there are other garments which
cloak. And those limbs which you allow to be seen you must make
thicker so that the other garments may appear to be under the cloak.
392.
but rather only introduce them where they are held by the hands or
the arms; the rest you may let fall simply where it is its nature to
flow; and do not let the nude forms be broken by too many details
283
dresses, as many do, from models covered with paper or thin leather
[Footnote: The little pen and ink drawing from Windsor (W. 102),
not.]
VIII.
284
There can be no doubt that Leonardo, in laying down these rules,
character and contents from those which are here collected and
arranged under the title 'Botany for painters'. In some cases where
latest; when it was written, the great painter was already more than
wrote as his final views on the subject. And the same remark applies
between 1513--15.
as written, though it was with much reluctance and only after long
285
notes, as they occurred to Leonardo and were written down from time
account of the order of the chapters in the original MS. and from
the data there given can restore them at will. As the materials are
the branches comes first (394-411) and then the insertion of the
leaves on the stems (412-419). Then follow the laws of Light and
the whole tree and to groups of trees (435-457). After the remarks
comparisons with the effect of Light and Shade on Trees (e. g.: in
No. 476, 4. 5; and No. 477, 9. 12). The chapters given in the
Appendix Nos. 478 and 481 have hardly any connection with the
Classification of trees.
393.
TREES.
286
Small, lofty, straggling, thick, that is as to foliage, dark, light,
russet, branched at the top; some directed towards the eye, some
downwards; with white stems; this transparent in the air, that not;
394.
All the branches of a tree at every stage of its height when put
if they are of equal rapidity, are equal to the body of the main
stream.
395.
Every year when the boughs of a plant [or tree] have made an end of
maturing their growth, they will have made, when put together, a
thickness equal to that of the main stem; and at every stage of its
ramification you will find the thickness of the said main stem; as:
other; unless the tree is pollard--if so the rule does not hold
good.
287
All the branches have a direction which tends to the centre of the
tree m.
the left hand side of Pl. XXVII, No. 1, belong to this passage.]
396.
is given off; and this giving off the branch forms a fork; this said
fork occurs between two angles of which the largest will be that
[Footnote: The sketches illustrating this are on the right hand side
of PI. XXVII, No. I, and the text is also given there in facsimile.]
397.
288
The lower shoots on the branches of trees grow more than the upper
ones and this occurs only because the sap that nourishes them, being
heavy, tends downwards more than upwards; and again, because those
[branches] which grow downwards turn away from the shade which
exists towards the centre of the plant. The older the branches are,
the greater is the difference between their upper and their lower
398.
399.
The plant which gives out the smallest ramifications will preserve
sketches. One of these closely resembles the lower one given under
No. 408, the other also represents short closely set boughs on an
289
upright trunk.]
400.
OF THE RAMIFICATION.
The beginning of the ramification [the shoot] always has the central
401.
In starting from the main stem the branches always form a base with
a prominence as is shown at a b c d.
402.
WHY, VERY FREQUENTLY, TIMBER HAS VEINS THAT ARE NOT STRAIGHT.
When the branches which grow the second year above the branch of the
branches, but are on one side, then the vigour of the lower branch
on one side.
But if the ramifications are equal in their growth, the veins of the
290
main stem will be straight [parallel] and equidistant at every
escape the blame of those who understand them, it will be well that
you should represent every thing from nature, and not despise such
403.
The plants which spread very much have the angles of the spaces
404.
The tips of the boughs of plants [and trees], unless they are borne
down by the weight of their fruits, turn towards the sky as much as
possible.
291
The upper side of their leaves is turned towards the sky that it may
The sun gives spirit and life to plants and the earth nourishes them
leaving only one small root on a gourd and this I kept nourished
with water, and the gourd brought to perfection all the fruits it
could produce, which were about 60 gourds of the long kind, andi set
the plant and its offspring--or the seeds which its offspring had
to produce--[21].
The rule of the leaves produced on the last shoot of the year will
that is, that the insertion of the leaves turns round each branch in
such a way, as that the sixth leaf above is produced over the sixth
leaf below, and the way they turn is that if one turns towards its
companion to the right, the other turns to the left, the leaf
serving as the nourishing breast for the shoot or fruit which grows
RAVAISSON in the Gazette des Beaux Arts, Oct. 1877; his paper also
292
contains some valuable information as to botanical science in the
405.
The lowest branches of those trees which have large leaves and heavy
The branches always originate above [in the axis of] the leaves.
406.
The upper shoots of the lateral branches of plants lie closer to the
407.
The lowest branches, after they have formed the angle of their
crowd against the other branches which follow them on the same stem
293
The main branch always goes below, as is shown by the branch f n
408.
The elm always gives a greater length to the last branches of the
year's growth than to the lower ones; and Nature does this because
the highest branches are those which have to add to the size of the
tree; and those at the bottom must get dry because they grow in the
solar rays and the air among the main branches of the tree.
The main branches of the lower part bend down more than those above,
409.
turning the convexity towards the South; and their branches are
longer and thicker and more abundant towards the South than towards
the North. And this occurs because the sun draws the sap towards
294
And this may be observed if the sun is not screened off by other
plants.
410.
ramification placed in stages round its main stem; and its branches
of the topmost shoots form a pyramid from the middle upwards; and
the walnut and oak form a hemisphere from the middle upwards.
411.
The bough of the walnut which is only hit and beaten when it has
brought to perfection...
[Footnote: The end of the text and the sketch in red chalk belonging
412.
295
principal branches, so is that of the leaves on the shoots of the
modes). Only three are described in the text, the fourth is only
suggested by a sketch.
The whole passage has been commented on, from MANZI'S version, in
as No. 833; and there also the drawings are wanting. The space for
them has been left vacant, but in the Vatican copy 'niente' has
above another. The first, which is the most general, is that the
above are over the two third ones below [Footnote 10: terze di
296
third way is that the third above is over the third below [Footnote
[Footnote: See the four sketches on the upper portion of the page
413.
The ramification of the elm has the largest branch at the top. The
first and the last but one are smaller, when the main trunk is
straight.
The space between the insertion of one leaf to the rest is half the
extreme length of the leaf or somewhat less, for the leaves are at
The elm has more leaves near the top of the boughs than at the base;
and] aspect.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXVII, No. 3. Above the sketch and close under
414.
297
In the walnut tree the leaves which are distributed on the shoots of
this year are further apart from each other and more numerous in
one. And they are inserted more closely and less in number when the
shoot that bears them springs from an old branch. Its fruits are
borne at the ends of the shoots. And its largest boughs are the
lowest on the boughs they spring from. And this arises from the
weight of its sap which is more apt to descend than to rise, and
consequently the branches which spring from them and rise towards
the sky are small and slender [20]; and when the shoot turns towards
the sky its leaves spread out from it [at an angle] with an equal
the leaves lie flat; and this arises from the fact that leaves
415.
298
The thickness of a branch never diminishes within the space between
one leaf and the next excepting by so much as the thickness of the
bud which is above the leaf and this thickness is taken off from the
Nature has so placed the leaves of the latest shoots of many plants
this occurs for two useful ends in the plant: First that as the
shoot and the fruit of the following year spring from the bud or eye
which lies above and in close contact with the insertion of the leaf
[in the axil], the water which falls upon the shoot can run down to
nourish the bud, by the drop being caught in the hollow [axil] at
the insertion of the leaf. And the second advantage is, that as
these shoots develop in the following year one will not cover the
next below, since the 5 come forth on five different sides; and the
416.
The ramifications of any tree, such as the elm, are wide and slender
these are seen in the distribution [thus]: the lower portions are
seen from above; and those that are above are seen from below; and
299
those in the middle, some from below and some from above. The upper
turned with their tips towards you. And of those parts of the middle
of the height of the tree, the longest will be towards the top of
the tree and will produce a ramification like the foliage of the
forth their shoots and leaves in the order of the sixth being placed
above the first. Others are thin and light like the willow and
others.
417.
You will see in the lower branches of the elder, which puts forth
leaves two and two placed crosswise [at right angles] one above
another, that if the stem rises straight up towards the sky this
order never fails; and its largest leaves are on the thickest part
of the stem and the smallest on the slenderest part, that is towards
the top. But, to return to the lower branches, I say that the leaves
on these are placed on them crosswise like [those on] the upper
branches; and as, by the law of all leaves, they are compelled to
turn their upper surface towards the sky to catch the dew at night,
300
[Footnote: See Pl. XXVII, No. 5.]
418.
A leaf always turns its upper side towards the sky so that it may
the better receive, on all its surface, the dew which drops gently
plant as that one shall cover the other as little as possible, but
shall lie alternately one above another as may be seen in the ivy
which covers the walls. And this alternation serves two ends; that
is, to leave intervals by which the air and sun may penetrate
between them. The 2nd reason is that the drops which fall from the
first leaf may fall onto the fourth or--in other trees--onto the
sixth.
419.
Every shoot and every fruit is produced above the insertion [in the
the rain and moisture from the dew which falls at night from above,
and often it protects them against the too great heat of the rays of
the sun.
301
420.
That part of the body will be most illuminated which is hit by the
421.
Young plants have more transparent leaves and a more lustrous bark
422.
a great distance and that which has most breadth [whether light or
302
The proportions of light and shade in a leaf (423-426).
423.
Sometimes a leaf has three accidents [of light] that is: shade,
transparent.
424.
A leaf with a concave surface seen from the under side and
eye n, this will see o in shadow because the light does not fall
upon it between equal angles, neither on the upper nor the under
transmitted to its under side. [Footnote: See Pl. XXVIII, No. 2, the
upper sketch on the page. In the original they are drawn in red
chalk.]
425.
303
Although those leaves which have a polished surface are to a great
extent of the same colour on the right side and on the reverse, it
may happen that the side which is turned towards the atmosphere will
exception the shadows show as darker on the upper side than on the
lower, from the contrast offered by the high lights which limit the
shadows.
The under side of the leaf, although its colour may be in itself the
same as that of the upper side, shows a still finer colour--a colour
placed between
426.
the eye and the light which falls upon it from the opposite side.
And its shadows are in the same positions as those were of the
hand, remember that if the eye is almost under the tree you will see
its leaves [some] on the upper and [some] on the under side, and the
foreshortened, and the same leaf sometimes shows part of the right
side and part of the under side, whence you must make it of two
304
colours.
427.
The shadows in transparent leaves seen from the under side are the
same shadows as there are on the right side of this leaf, they will
show through to the underside together with lights, but the lustre
428.
When one green has another [green] behind it, the lustre on the
And if the sun illuminates the leaves without their coming between
it and the eye and without the eye facing the sun, then the
It is very effective to show some branches which are low down and
dark and so set off the illuminated greens which are at some
distance from the dark greens seen below. That part is darkest which
atmosphere.
305
429.
be seen the shadow of another leaf which is above it. This shadow
[as much as] half or a third of the leaf which is shaded; and
of it should be avoided.
acute angle.
430.
The shadows of plants are never black, for where the atmosphere
431.
If the light comes from m and the eye is at n the eye will see
306
side as transparent, with a beautiful green colour verging on
yellow.
that see the under side of this leaf will see it of a beautiful
shadow [or in full light], and their under side will be transparent
432.
The willow and other similar trees, which have their boughs lopped
shadow is about the middle where these boughs spring; and towards
the extreme ends they cast but little shade from having small leaves
and few and slender branches. Hence the boughs which rise towards
the sky will have but little shade and little relief; and the
from the dark part of the shadow and grow thinner by degrees up to
That tree will have the least shadow which has the fewest branches
307
433.
When the leaves are interposed between the light and the eye, then
that which is nearest to the eye will be the darkest, and the most
distant will be the lightest, not being seen against the atmosphere;
and this is seen in the leaves which are away from the centre of the
434.
The lights on such leaves which are darkest, will be most near to
with the dark hue to compose a blue colour; and this light is
smooth surface of these leaves and adds to the blue hue which this
308
But leaves of a green verging on yellow when they reflect the
every thing which appears in a mirror takes some colour from that
yellow of the leaf appears green, because blue and yellow mixed
435.
box and the like. Some tend to yellow such as walnuts, and pears,
vines and verdure. Some are both yellowish and dark as chesnuts,
vine, and cherry; and some are whitish as the willow, olive, reeds
436.
309
That part of the trees will be seen to lie in the least dark shadow
hemisphere [the sky], the under portion of the tree faces the earth
although a does not face the earth, it faces the dark [green] of
onto the under sides of the leaves immediately above. Thus these
trees have their darkest shadows nearest to the middle of the tree.
437.
shadow of every object; and they assume this hue more in proportion
as they are remote from the eye, and less in proportion as they are
nearer. The leaves which reflect the blue of the atmosphere always
310
OF THE ILLUMINATED PART OF VERDURE AND OF MOUNTAINS.
nearly of its natural colour where the strongest light falls upon
it.
438.
In trees that are illuminated [both] by the sun and the atmosphere
and that have leaves of a dark colour, one side will be illuminated
atmosphere and the sun; and the side which the eye sees illuminated
439.
The trees and plants which are most thickly branched with slender
branches ought to have less dark shadow than those trees and plants
311
440.
ON PAINTING.
illuminated which turns towards the light, one tree will never be
the eye be c which sees the two trees b d which are illuminated
by the sun a; I say that this eye c will not see the light in
Because, the tree which is nearest to the sun will display so much
the stronger shadow than the more distant one, in proportion as one
tree is nearer to the rays of the sun that converge to the eye than
You see that the eye c sees nothing of the tree d but shadow,
while the same eye c sees thè tree b half in light and half in
shade.
When a tree is seen from below, the eye sees the top of it as placed
of their branches.
312
[Footnote: The two lower sketches on the left of Pl XXVIII, No. 3,
refer to lines 21-23. The upper sketch has apparently been effaced
by Leonardo himself.]
441.
in the same position in the trees on the right hand and those on the
by the 4th which says: Opaque bodies placed between the light and
the eye display themselves entirely in shadow; and by the 5th: The
eye when placed between the opaque body and the light sees the
opaque body entirely illuminated. And by the 6th: When the eye and
the opaque body are placed between darkness and light, it will be
[Footnote: See the figure on the right hand side of Pl. XXVIII, No.
3. The first five lines of the text are written below the diagram
and above it are the last eight lines of the text, given as No.
461.]
442.
313
OF THE HERBS OF THE FIELD.
Of the plants which take a shadow from the plants which spring among
them, those which are on this side [in front] of the shadow have the
the shadows fall have their stems dark on a light background; that
Of the trees which are between the eye and the light the part in
side--and lustrous leaves--being seen from the upper side; and the
background below and behind will be dark green, being in shadow from
the front portion of the said tree. This occurs in trees placed
443.
light and half in shadow; but it is better to do them when the sun
is covered with clouds, for then the trees are lighted by the
general light of the sky, and the general darkness of the earth. And
314
then they are darkest in certain parts in proportion as those parts
444.
When the sun is in the east the trees to the South and to the North
OF MEADOWS.
If the sun is in the East the verdure of the meadows and of other
the sun; this does not occur in the meadows to the West, and in
green.
445.
315
When the sun is in the East all the portions of plants lighted by it
are of a most lively verdure, and this happens because the leaves
lighted by the sun within the half of the horizon that is the
Eastern half, are transparent; and within the Western semicircle the
verdure is of a dull hue and the moist air is turbid and of the
colour of grey ashes, not being transparent like that in the East,
moister.
The shadows of the trees to the East cover a large portion of them
446.
When the sun is in the East the trees seen towards the East will
have the light which surrounds them all round their shadows,
excepting on the side towards the earth; unless the tree has been
pruned [below] in the past year. And the trees to the South and
North will be half in shade and half in light, and more or less in
or to the West.
The [position of] the eye above or below varies the shadows and
lights in trees, inasmuch as the eye placed above sees the tree with
316
the little shadow, and the eye placed below with a great deal of
shadow.
447.
The sun being in the East [to the right], the trees to the West [or
left] of the eye will show in small relief and almost imperceptible
gradations, because the atmosphere which lies between the eye and
note book marked G. Unfortunately it has been cut out and lost.],
see the 7th of this--and they have no shade; for though a shadow
images of the shade and light that reach the eye are confused and
minuteness. And the principal lights are in the middle of the trees,
and the shadows to wards the edges; and their separation is shown by
the shadows of the intervals between the trees; but when the forests
are thick with trees the thin edges are but little seen.
448.
317
OF TREES TO THE EAST.
When the sun is in the East the trees are darker towards the middle
449.
OBJECTS IN HIGH LIGHT SHOW BUT LITTLE, BUT BETWEEN LIGHT AND
SHADOW
look towards the West or East and then draw. And if you turn towards
the North, every object placed on that side will have no shadow,
shadow of your head. And if you turn towards the South every object
on that side will be wholly in shadow. All the trees which are
towards the sun and have the atmosphere for their background are
dark, and the other trees which lie against that darkness will be
black [very dark] in the middle and lighter towards the edges.
450.
318
OF THE SPACES [SHOWING THE SKY] IN TREES THEMSELVES.
The spaces between the parts in the mass of trees, and the spaces
which are very much smaller than the tree and are lost sight of
sooner than the tree; but it does not therefore follow that they are
the sky and of the shadows of the tree in shade, which both together
That part of a tree will show the fewest spaces, behind which a
large number of trees are standing between the tree and the air
[sky]; thus in the tree a the spaces are not concealed nor in b,
the tree e and a little farther on all the spaces in the mass of
the trees are lost, and only that at the side remains.
451.
319
OF TREES.
What outlines are seen in trees at a distance against the sky which
the illuminated sky, display a form which more nearly approaches the
spherical on proportion as they are remote, and the nearer they are
the less they appear in this spherical form; as in the first tree
a which, being near to the eye, displays the true form of its
c, where not merely the branches of the tree cannot be seen but
very short distance it loses its angles, and a little farther off it
loses still more of its smaller sides which remain. And thus before
the whole is lost [to sight] the parts are lost, being smaller than
the whole; as a man, who in such a distant position loses his legs,
arms and head before [the mass of] his body, then the outlines of
length are lost before those of breadth, and where they have become
lost it is round.
320
The cast shadow of trees (452. 453).
452.
The image of the shadow of any object of uniform breadth can never
453.
All trees seen against the sun are dark towards the middle and this
shadow will be of the shape of the tree when apart from others.
The shadows cast by trees on which the sun shines are as dark as
The shadow cast by a tree is never less than the mass of the tree
The shadow will be densest in the middle of the tree when the tree
321
[Footnote: The three diagrams which accompany this text are placed,
light which falls from the side whence the light comes; and this
illumination gives the shape of the shadow, and this may be of the
hill the [shadow of the] trees there will change less than in the
plains; for these trees on the hills have their branches thicker,
because they grow less high each year than in the plains. Therefore
as these branches are dark by nature and being so full of shade, the
shadow of the clouds cannot darken them any more; but the open
spaces between the trees, which have no strong shadow change very
much in tone and particularly those which vary from green; that is
the trees are against the atmosphere they appear all the same
colour--if indeed they are not very close together or very thickly
covered with leaves like the fir and similar trees. When you see the
322
trees from the side from which the sun lights them, you will see
them almost all of the same tone, and the shadows in them will be
hidden by the leaves in the light, which come between your eye and
those shadows.
the trees are situated between the sun and the eye, beyond the
shadow which spreads from their centre, the green of their leaves
many places by the leaves and boughs in shadow which will come
between you and them, or, in their upper portions, they will be
454.
The trees of the landscape stand out but little from each other;
portions of those beyond and differ little from them in light and
shade.
455.
Of trees seen from below and against the light, one beyond the other
323
and near together. The topmost part of the first will be in great
part transparent and light, and will stand out against the dark
c the second. Then I say that r, the eye, will see the portion c
falls upon it from the opposite side, and it will see it, on a dark
ground b c because that is the dark part and shadow of the tree a
b c.
background n g.
456.
That part of a tree which has shadow for background, is all of one
tone, and wherever the trees or branches are thickest they will be
darkest, because there are no little intervals of air. But where the
are seen lightest and the leaves lustrous from the sunlight falling
on them.
324
457.
the same colour of one tree against the same colour of another
green.
458.
The landscape has a finer azure [tone] when, in fine weather the sun
is at noon than at any other time of the day, because the air is
see the trees of a beautiful green at the outside and the shadows
dark towards the middle; and in the remoter distance the atmosphere
which comes between you and them looks more beautiful when there is
something dark beyond. And still the azure is most beautiful. The
objects seen from the side on which the sun shines will not show you
their shadows. But, if you are lower than the sun, you can see what
is not seen by the sun and that will be all in shade. The leaves of
the trees, which come between you and the sun are of two principal
the sun, and the shaded portions which only face the earth, and the
325
darkest which are surrounded by something that is not dark. The
trees in the landscape which are between you and the sun are far
more beautiful than those you see when you are between the sun and
them; and this is so because those which face the sun show their
and the shadows are dark because they are not concealed by any
thing.
The trees, when you place yourself between them and the sun, will
itself, is not very strong, and besides this some reflected lights
which, being against a background which does not differ very much
from themselves in tone, are not conspicuous; and if you are lower
down than they are situated, they may also show those portions on
which the light of the sun does not fall and these will be dark.
In the Wind.
But, if you are on the side whence the wind blows, you will see the
trees look very much lighter than on the other sides, and this
happens because the wind turns up the under side of the leaves,
which, in all trees, is much whiter than the upper sides; and, more
especially, will they be very light indeed if the wind blows from
the quarter where the sun is, and if you have your back turned to
it.
326
[Footnote: At S, in the original is the word Sole (sun) and at
459.
of the atmosphere which surrounds the objects in such a way that the
shadows are few, and these few fade away so that their outline is
lost in haze.
460.
universal light and not the direct light of the sun, which makes the
461.
OF PAINTING.
327
In landscapes which represent [a scene in] winter. The mountains
certainly does not mean the MS. in hand, nor any other now known to
us. The same remark applies to the phrase in line 15: per la 2a
from a great distance those will look of the bluest colour which are
their leaves, they will show a bluer tinge which will be in itself
darker; therefore, when the trees have lost their leaves they will
look of a gray colour, while, with their leaves, they are green, and
in proportion as the green is darker than the grey hue the green
will be of a bluer tinge than the gray. Also by the 2nd of this: The
shadows of trees covered with leaves are darker than the shadows of
those trees which have lost their leaves in proportion as the trees
covered with leaves are denser than those without leaves--and thus
my meaning is proved.
The definition of the blue colour of the atmosphere explains why the
462.
OF PAINTING IN A LANDSCAPE.
328
If the slope of a hill comes between the eye and the horizon,
sloping towards the eye, while the eye is opposite the middle of the
throughout its length. This is proved by the 7th of this which says
show all its trees as much from the side which is lighted by the
light of the sky, as from that which is in shade from the darkness
of the earth; whence it must result that these trees are of a medium
darkness. And from this [middle] spot towards the base of the hill,
and by the said 7th: For trees so placed, the nearer they are to the
summit of the hill the darker they necessarily become. But this
463.
OF LANDSCAPES.
329
most lovely blue, much purer than their illuminated portions. And
from this it follows that when the rock of a mountain is reddish the
illuminated portions are violet (?) and the more they are lighted
464.
465.
When the sun is in the East and the eye is above the centre of a
town, the eye will see the Southern part of the town with its roofs
half in shade and half in light, and the same towards the North; the
Eastern side will be all in shadow and the Western will be all in
light.
466.
bottom. If the eye is above the houses the light seen in the space
330
that is between one house and the next sinks by degrees into thicker
mist; and yet, being less transparent, it appears whiter; and if the
houses are some higher than the others, since the true [colour] is
a being the eye, the house b c will look lightest at the bottom,
mist, but this is only because the line of the eye which starts from
467.
horizon; and those portions which are not lighted up by the sun
331
remain almost of the same colour and medium tone as the mist.
WHY OBJECTS WHICH ARE HIGH UP AND AT A DISTANCE ARE DARKER THAN
THE
are the highest. And among objects of equal height that will be the
darkest [strongest] which has for background the deepest mist. Thus
of depth in the mist; and sees the height of the middle tower b
through one single degree of mist. Therefore the top of the tower
468.
Smoke is seen better and more distinctly on the Eastern side than on
the Western when the sun is in the East; and this arises from two
causes; the first is that the sun, with its rays, shines through the
particles of the smoke and lights them up and makes them visible.
The second is that the roofs of the houses seen in the East at this
time are in shadow, because their obliquity does not allow of their
332
being illuminated by the sun. And the same thing occurs with dust;
and both one and the other look the lighter in proportion as they
469.
If the sun is in the East the smoke of cities will not be visible in
solar rays, nor on a dark background; since the roofs of the houses
turn the same side to the eye as they turn towards the sun, and on
But dust, under the same aspect, will look darker than smoke being
470.
OF REPRESENTING WIND.
reversing of their leaves towards the quarter whence the wind comes,
you should also represent them amid clouds of fine dust mingled with
333
the troubled air.
471.
Describe landscapes with the wind, and the water, and the setting
THE WIND.
All the leaves which hung towards the earth by the bending of the
shoots with their branches, are turned up side down by the gusts of
between you and the quarter of the wind, the leaves which are
you.
472.
Trees struck by the force of the wind bend to the side towards which
the wind is blowing; and the wind being past they bend in the
473.
334
That portion of a tree which is farthest from the force which
that part where they can be most hurt; and most in such trees as
grow to great heights, as pines and the like. [Footnote: Compare the
sketch drawn with a pen and washed with Indian ink on Pl. XL, No. 1.
et uiua (Ed. MANZI, p. 235. Ed. LUDWIG, Vol. I, 460). This appears
to refer to the left hand portion of the drawing here given from the
Windsor collection, and from this it must be inferred, that the leaf
separated from the original MS. at the time when the Vatican copy
was made.]
474.
Describe how the clouds are formed and how they dissolve, and what
475.
335
The shadows in clouds are lighter in proportion as they are nearer
to the horizon.
totally effaced.]
476.
When clouds come between the sun and the eye all the upper edges of
their round forms are light, and towards the middle they are dark,
and this happens because towards the top these edges have the sun
above them while you are below them; and the same thing happens with
the position of the branches of trees; and again the clouds, like
But, when the eye is between the cloud and the sun, the cloud has
the contrary effect to the former, for the edges of its mass are
dark and it is light towards the middle; and this happens because
you see the same side as faces the sun, and because the edges have
some transparency and reveal to the eye that portion which is hidden
beyond them, and which, as it does not catch the sunlight like that
may be that you see the details of these rounded masses from the
lower side, while the sun shines on the upper side and as they are
336
instance they remain dark.
The black clouds which are often seen higher up than those which are
Again, the rounded forms of the clouds that face the sun, show their
edges dark because they lie against the light background; and to see
that this is true, you may look at the top of any cloud that is
477.
BURNING KILN.
The clouds do not show their rounded forms excepting on the sides
because they are in the shade. [Footnote: The text of this chapter
the leaf form but one in the original. On the margin close to lines
337
4 and 5 is the note: rossore d'aria inverso l'orizonte--(of the
If the sun is in the East and the clouds in the West, the eye placed
between the sun and the clouds sees the edges of the rounded forms
surrounded by this dark [edge] are light. And this occurs because
the edges of the rounded forms of these clouds are turned towards
Both the cloud and the tree display no roundness at all on their
shaded side.
478.
they make the water reflect the objects seen by the man. But the
water reflects the object from one side and the man sees it from the
other; and it often happens that the painter sees an object from
below, and thus one and the same object is seen from hind part
before and upside down, because the water shows the image of the
338
Of rainbows and rain (479. 480).
479.
The bow in itself is not in the rain nor in the eye that sees it;
though it is generated by the rain, the sun, and the eye. The
rainbow is always seen by the eye that is between the rain and the
body of the sun; hence if the sun is in the East and the rain is in
480.
When the air is condensed into rain it would produce a vacuum if the
rest of the air did not prevent this by filling its place, as it
does with a violent rush; and this is the wind which rises in the
Of flower seeds.
481.
All the flowers which turn towards the sun perfect their seeds; but
not the others; that is to say those which get only the reflection
of the sun.
339
IX.
(for instance No 110). The fact that this arrangement was never
carried out either in the old MS. copies or in any edition since, is
easily accounted for by the general disorder which results from the
calling and life of the painter--and which are here brought together
Leonardo may have formed the project of completing his Libro della
which his interest in the subject had fallen somewhat into the
background.
340
In the second section, which treats first of the artist's studio,
carried out in the Theory of Painting, thus the suggestions for the
theory of light and shade for the practical method of optics (Nos.
first, since the advice to figure painters must have some connection
are followed.
But this arrangement of the text made it seem advisable not to pick
341
out the practical precepts as to the representation of trees and
quanto piu un'arte porta seco fatica di corpo, e sudore, tanto piu e
342
vile, e men pregiata". But the existence of any book specially
Painting as compared not merely with Sculpture but with Poetry, are
I.
482.
Many are they who have a taste and love for drawing, but no talent;
and this will be discernible in boys who are not diligent and never
343
483.
objects. Then he may copy from some good master, to accustom himself
has learnt. Then see for a time the works of various masters. Then
get the habit of putting his art into practice and work.
[Footnote: The Vatican copy and numerous abridgements all place this
DUFRESNE and all subsequent editors have done the same. In the
484.
First draw from drawings by good masters done from works of art and
from nature, and not from memory; then from plastic work, with the
guidance of the drawing done from it; and then from good natural
485.
344
The artist ought first to exercise his hand by copying drawings from
the hand of a good master. And having acquired that practice, under
be given.
486.
OF DRAWING.
Which is best, to draw from nature or from the antique? and which is
487.
[Footnote 486, 487: These are the only two passages in which
345
require us to limit its application to a single special case. At any
rate we may suspect that when Leonardo put the question, he felt
have not been able to find a single study from the antique, though a
footnote.]
488.
OF PAINTING.
with the limbs in all the positions and actions of which they are
346
capable, in the nude, to know the anatomy of the sinews, bones,
movement and show those only as prominent and thickened, and not the
grace; so that you would think you were looking at a sack of walnuts
rather than the human form, or a bundle of radishes rather than the
muscles of figures.
489.
The painter who is familiar with the nature of the sinews, muscles,
and tendons, will know very well, in giving movement to a limb, how
many and which sinews cause it; and which muscle, by swelling,
into the thinnest cartilage, surround and support the said muscle.
very same things [modelling] in the arms, back, breast and legs. And
347
How to acquire practice.
490.
I say that first you ought to learn the limbs and their mechanism,
and having this knowledge, their actions should come next, according
compose subjects, the studies for which should be taken from natural
actions and made from time to time, as circumstances allow; and pay
attention to them in the streets and piazze and fields, and note
5-7 explained by the lower portion of the sketch No. 1 on Pl. XXXI.]
thus for a head make an o, and for an arm a straight or a bent line,
and the same for the legs and the body, [Footnote 7: Lines 5-7
explained by the lower portion of the sketch No. 1 on Pl. XXXI.] and
when you return home work out these notes in a complete form. The
masters, and that in this way practice is rapidly gained, and good
such masters are so rare that there are but few of them to be found,
348
it is a surer way to go to natural objects, than to those which are
water-jar.
491.
We know for certain that sight is one of the most rapid actions we
letters; but you could not, in the time, recognise what the letters
were, nor what they were meant to tell. Hence you would need to see
reach the top. Thus I say to you, whom nature prompts to pursue this
349
art, if you wish to have a sound knowledge of the forms of objects
[step] till you have the first well fixed in memory and in practice.
And if you do otherwise you will throw away your time, or certainly
492.
RAPID EXECUTION.
If you, who draw, desire to study well and to good purpose, always
which have the highest degree of brightness, and to what extent and
likewise in the shadows, which are those that are darker than the
others and in what way they intermingle; then their masses and the
outlines, which way they tend; and which part of the lines is curved
to one side or the other, and where they are more or less
light and shade blend without strokes and borders [but] looking like
smoke. And when you have thus schooled your hand and your judgment
by such diligence, you will acquire rapidity before you are aware.
350
The artist's private life and choice of company (493-494).
493.
absence of all companions who are alienated from his studies; his
successively come before him, and also free from other cares
must decide which of these cases is the more difficult to work out,
and follow that up until it becomes quite clear, and then work out
speaking of his own method of work as displayed in his MSS. and this
arrangement.]. And above all he must keep his mind as clear as the
351
[Footnote: In the title line Leonardo had originally written del
494.
To the end that well-being of the body may not injure that of the
stored in the memory. While you are alone you are entirely your own
[master] and if you have one companion you are but half your own,
And if you have many companions you will fall deeper into the same
trouble. If you should say: "I will go my own way and withdraw
you, you will not be able to help often listening to their chatter.
And so, since one cannot serve two masters, you will badly fill the
part of a companion, and carry out your studies of art even worse.
And if you say: "I will withdraw so far that their words cannot
reach me and they cannot disturb me", I can tell you that you will
be thought mad. But, you see, you will at any rate be alone. And if
352
you must have companions ship find it in your studio. This may
495.
I say and insist that drawing in company is much better than alone,
for many reasons. The first is that you would be ashamed to be seen
behindhand among the students, and such shame will lead you to
be among those who are more praised than yourself, and this praise
of others will spur you on. Another is that you can learn from the
better than they, you can profit by your contempt for their defects,
work with others than to work alone, that the studies of pupils only
353
496.
SLEEP.
497.
over the things prepared during the summer; that is, all the
drawings from the nude done in the summer should be brought together
and a choice made of the best [studies of] limbs and bodies among
OF POSITIONS.
After this in the following summer you should select some one who is
well grown and who has not been brought up in doublets, and so may
354
not be of stiff carriage, and make him go through a number of agile
and graceful actions; and if his muscles do not show plainly within
the outlines of his limbs that does not matter at all. It is enough
that you can see good attitudes and you can correct [the drawing of]
524.]
498.
499.
Nor is the painter praiseworthy who does but one thing well, as the
inept, that after devoting itself to one single thing and doing it
355
capace di abbracciare tutte le cose, di cui era egli dotato" And he
then mentions the case of CLAUDE LORRAIN. But he overlooks the fact
lines 3, 4).]
500.
Some may distinctly assert that those persons are under a delusion
who call that painter a good master who can do nothing well but a
studying one single thing for a life-time who would not have
resulting from the fortuitous actions of men, in short, all that the
eye can see, he seems to me but a poor master who can only do a
figure well. For do you not perceive how many and various actions
are performed by men only; how many different animals there are, as
356
501.
little, must need take as their standard of beauty mere gold and
azure, and these, with supreme conceit, declare that they will not
give good work for miserable payment, and that they could do as well
as any other if they were well paid. But, ye foolish folks! cannot
such artists keep some good work, and then say: this is a costly
work and this more moderate and this is average work and show that
502.
Any master who should venture to boast that he could remember all
357
infinite and our memory is not extensive enough to retain them.
greater thing than the glory of riches. Hence, for these and other
putting in, until you have satisfied yourself. Then have living men,
draped or nude, as you may have purposed in your work, and take care
is left in the work which is not in harmony with reason and the
effects in nature. And this will be the way to win honour in your
art.
503.
many do who study only the [rules of] measure and proportion in the
nude figure and do not seek after variety; for a man may be well
358
makes his figures on one pattern so that they might all be taken for
504.
Nature has beneficently provided that throughout the world you may
505.
in their muscles, sinews and bones; and they do not vary excepting
there are aquatic animals which are of great variety; I will not try
to convince the painter that there is any rule for them for they are
506.
PAINTING.
359
The mind of the painter must resemble a mirror, which always takes
must know, Oh Painter! that you cannot be a good one if you are not
produced by nature. And this you will not know how to do if you do
not see them, and retain them in your mind. Hence as you go through
look now at this thing and now at that, collecting a store of divers
facts selected and chosen from those of less value. But do not do
like some painters who, when they are wearied with exercising their
fancy dismiss their work from their thoughts and take exercise in
walking for relaxation, but still keep fatigue in their mind which,
though they see various objects [around them], does not apprehend
them; but, even when they meet friends or relations and are saluted
by them, although they see and hear them, take no more cognisance of
507.
360
profession, by giving your eye good practice in judging accurately
hand, try to cut it to the length that the line drawn appears to him
to the line to measure the length he has judged it to be. And he who
has come nearest with his measure to the length of the pattern is
the best man, and the winner, and shall receive the prize you have
that is take a spear, or any other cane or reed, and fix on a point
at a certain distance; and let each one estimate how many times he
judges that its length will go into that distance. Again, who will
thread. And such games give occasion to good practice for the eye,
508.
study which, although it may seem but trivial and almost ludicrous,
inventions. And this is, when you look at a wall spotted with
361
scene, you may discover a resemblance to various landscapes,
well drawn forms. And these appear on such walls confusedly, like
the sound of bells in whose jangle you may find any name or word you
choose to imagine.
II.
509.
Small rooms or dwellings discipline the mind, large ones weaken it.
510.
The larger the wall the less the light will be.
362
511.
windows. The least useful and the coldest is the window at a. The
most useful, the lightest and warmest and most open to the sky is
there shown.]
512.
The painter who works from nature should have a window, which he can
raise and lower. The reason is that sometimes you will want to
lowered, so that the work moves up and down and not the painter. And
every evening you can let down the work and shut it up above so that
363
in the evening it may be in the fashion of a chest which, when shut
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXI, No. 2. In this plate the lines have
side.]
513.
Which light is best for drawing from nature; whether high or low, or
514.
364
A broad light high up and not too strong will render the details of
515.
THAT THE LIGHT FOR DRAWING FROM NATURE SHOULD BE HIGH UP.
The light for drawing from nature should come from the North in
order that it may not vary. And if you have it from the South, keep
the window screened with cloth, so that with the sun shining the
whole day the light may not vary. The height of the light should be
516.
night, by the light of a fire. But this should not be much used in
light and shade; and this is the case towards evening or when the
day is cloudy, and works then painted are tender and every kind of
365
face becomes graceful. Thus, in every thing extremes are to be
avoided: Too much light gives crudeness; too little prevents our
OF SMALL LIGHTS.
light and shade, all the more if the room lighted by it be large,
517.
PAINTING.
into dark rooms will render the place less dark in proportion as the
opening cuts into the walls which surround and cover in the
pavement.
518.
366
this light is useful for carvers of delicate work. [Footnote 5: For
as I can see the text is not imperfect, nor is the sense obscure. It
519.
That the light should fall upon a picture from one window only. This
appears round.
520.
367
OF SELECTING THE LIGHT WHICH GIVES MOST GRACE TO FACES.
If you should have a court yard that you can at pleasure cover with
a linen awning that light will be good. Or when you want to take a
sitter stand with his back to one of the walls of the court yard.
Note in the streets, as evening falls, the faces of the men and
women, and when the weather is dull, what softness and delicacy you
the walls tinted black and a narrow roof projecting within the
braccia high and covered with a linen awning; or else paint a work
light.
521.
To draw a nude figure from nature, or any thing else, hold in your
of objects.
522.
OF DRAWING AN OBJECT.
368
When you draw take care to set up a principal line which you must
observe all throughout the object you are drawing; every thing
523.
and set thus firmly in front of your eyes that is, between your eye
and the thing you want to draw; then place yourself at a distance of
2/3 of a braccia from the glass fixing your head with a machine in
such a way that you cannot move it at all. Then shut or entirely
cover one eye and with a brush or red chalk draw upon the glass that
which you see beyond it; then trace it on paper from the glass,
your figures, make a square frame or net, and square it out with
thread; place this between your eye and the nude model you are
drawing, and draw these same squares on the paper on which you mean
to draw the figure, but very delicately. Then place a pellet of wax
369
on a spot of the net which will serve as a fixed point, which,
whenever you look at your model, must cover the pit of the throat;
or, if his back is turned, it may cover one of the vertebrae of the
neck. Thus these threads will guide you as to each part of the body
which, in any given attitude will be found below the pit of the
other parts of the body; and the transverse lines of the net will
show you how much the figure is higher over the leg on which it is
posed than over the other, and the same with the hips, and the knees
and the feet. But always fix the net perpendicularly so that all the
divisions that you see the model divided into by the net work
correspond with your drawing of the model on the net work you have
sketched. The squares you draw may be as much smaller than those of
the net as you wish that your figure should be smaller than nature.
the frame and net. This should be 3 braccia and a half high and 3
braccia wide; 7 braccia distant from you and 1 braccio from the
model.
370
Bildflache."]
524.
Place a sheet of not too transparent paper between the relievo and
525.
as standing free from the wall, you must proceed thus: have a thin
plate of iron and make a small hole in the centre; this hole must be
through the central hole, then place any object or figure you please
so close to the wall that it touches it and draw the outline of the
shadow on the wall; then fill in the shade and add the lights; place
the person who is to see it so that he looks through that same hole
where at first the light was; and you will never be able to persuade
371
[Footnote: uno piccolo spiracelo nel mezzo. M. RAVAISSON, in his
the text.]
526.
BRACCIA HIGH.
half the man you wish to represent; then the other half; then put on
the vault m n [the rest of] the figure spoken of above; first set
out the vertical plane on the floor of a room of the same shape as
the wall with the coved part on which you are to paint your figure.
Then, behind it, draw a figure set out in profile of whatever size
you please, and draw lines from it to the point f and, as these
372
the wall, of which the vertical plane gives a likeness, and you will
have all the [relative] heights and prominences of the figure. And
be drawn in their proper form, since, as the wall recedes the figure
will be foreshortened by itself; but [that part of] the figure which
upright; this diminution you must set out on a flat floor and there
letters refer to the larger sketch, No. 3 on Pl. XXXI.] in its real
size and reduce it once more on a vertical plane; and this will be a
good method [Footnote 18: Leonardo here says nothing as to how the
Nos. 525 and 523 we may conclude that he was familiar with the
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXI. 3. The second sketch, which in the plate is
373
1. 2. C. A. 157a; 463a has the similar heading: 'del cressciere
della figura', and the text begins: "Se voli fare 1a figura
grande b c" but here it breaks off. The translation here given
simple and clear; difficulties can only arise from the very fullness
527.
object in its own proper shape and raise it onto a vertical plane
represented.
528.
Why are paintings seen more correctly in a mirror than out of it?
529.
When you want to see if your picture corresponds throughout with the
objects you have drawn from nature, take a mirror and look in that
374
at the reflection of the real things, and compare the reflected
image with your picture, and consider whether the subject of the two
You should take the mirror for your guide--that is to say a flat
flat surface--they look the same. The picture has one plane surface
and the same with the mirror. The picture is intangible, in so far
hands; and it is the same with the mirror. And since you can see
objects appear in relief, you, who have in your colours far stronger
lights and shades than those in the mirror, can certainly, if you
compose your picture well, make that also look like a natural scene
paper laid out on the floor of a room (sala be piana) to the same
scale (con le sue vere grosseze) as the lower half, already drawn
upon the wall (lines 10, 11)you must then reduce them on a 'pariete
530.
375
OF JUDGING YOUR OWN PICTURES.
We know very well that errors are better recognised in the works of
others than in our own; and that often, while reproving little
men and other animals, and also, study good architecture, that is so
far as concerns the forms of buildings and other objects which are
on the face of the earth; these forms are infinite, and the better
you know them the more admirable will your work be. And in cases
where you lack experience do not shrink from drawing them from
nature. But, to carry out my promise above [in the title]--I say
that when you paint you should have a flat mirror and often look at
your work as reflected in it, when you will see it reversed, and it
will appear to you like some other painter's work, so you will be
better able to judge of its faults than in any other way. Again, it
is well that you should often leave off work and take a little
judge; for sitting too close at work may greatly deceive you. Again,
and your eye takes in more of it at a glance and sees more easily
objects.
376
On the management of works (531. 532).
531.
When you want to know a thing you have studied in your memory
proceed in this way: When you have drawn the same thing so many
without the model; but have the model traced on flat thin glass and
lay this on the drawing you have made without the model, and note
carefully where the tracing does not coincide with your drawing, and
where you find you have gone wrong; and bear in mind not to repeat
the same mistakes. Then return to the model, and draw the part in
which you were wrong again and again till you have it well in your
mind. If you have no flat glass for tracing on, take some very thin
kidts-kin parchment, well oiled and dried. And when you have used it
for one drawing you can wash it clean with a sponge and make a
second.
532.
ON HIS WORK.
377
Certainly while a man is painting he ought not to shrink from
hearing every opinion. For we know very well that a man, though he
may not be a painter, is familiar with the forms of other men and
very capable of judging whether they are hump backed, or have one
shoulder higher or lower than the other, or too big a mouth or nose,
and other defects; and, as we know that men are competent to judge
of the works of nature, how much more ought we to admit that they
can judge of our errors; since you know how much a man may be
deceived in his own work. And if you are not conscious of this in
weigh well whether those who find fault have ground or not for
blame, and, if so amend; but, if not make as though you had not
533.
HOW IN SMALL OBJECTS ERRORS ARE LESS EVIDENT THAN IN LARGE ONES.
diminution the details cannot be worked out by the artist with the
378
finish that is requisite. Hence it is not actually complete; and,
appearance. You will find that with the utmost effort you cannot
details cannot be determined. And if you wish to see how much this
distance from your eye, and raise or lower it till the top joint
touches the feet of the figure you are looking at, and you will see
534.
Painters often fall into despair of imitating nature when they see
their pictures fail in that relief and vividness which objects have
that are seen in a mirror; while they allege that they have colours
which for brightness or depth far exceed the strength of light and
ignorance rather than the real cause, because they do not know it.
379
on a flat surface, unless they are seen with only one eye; and the
reason is that two eyes see one object behind another as a and b
because the base of the visual lines is so broad that the second
body is seen beyond the first. But if you close one eye, as at s
from a single point and makes its base in the first body, whence the
ein noch so gut gemaltes Bild nie den vollen Eindruck der
erklart dies auch in Kap. LIII und Kap. CCCXLI (ed. DU FRESNE)
Augen."
work.]
535.
380
WHY OF TWO OBJECTS OF EQUAL SIZE A PAINTED ONE WILL LOOK LARGER
THAN
A SOLID ONE.
objects diminish in proportion as they are farther from the eye, and
that extend between the object and the eye, when they are directed
lines which are longest extend to a more remote limb than the others
and therefore that limb looks smaller. As there are numerous lines
each longer than the others--since there are numerous parts, each
more remote than the others and these, being farther off,
their diminution makes the whole mass of the object look smaller.
But this does not occur in painting; since the lines of sight all
end at the same distance there can be no diminution, hence the parts
not being diminished the whole object is undiminished, and for this
381
536.
man, and the farthest limit of the plain where it touches the sky
must be placed at the level of that line where the earth and sky
537.
figures; and when drawing his studies for them from nature he must
place himself with his eye as much below the object he is drawing
538.
382
You must make the foremost figure in the picture less than the size
it from the front line, and make the others in proportion by the
above rule.
539.
PERSPECTIVE.
You are asked, O Painter, why the figures you draw on a small scale
spectator (540-547)
540.
OF PAINTING.
When you draw from nature stand at a distance of 3 times the height
383
541.
that the eye of the figure he is drawing is on a level with his own.
This should be done with any head he may have to represent from
in the streets have their eyes on the same level as your own; and if
you place them higher or lower you will see that your drawing will
not be true.
542.
point [of sight], and then a third and a fourth, in such a way as
that on one wall there are 4 points of sight, which is supreme folly
eye of the spectator of the scene; and if you would [have me] tell
384
pictures on one and the same wall, I answer that you must set out
the foreground with its point of sight on a level with the eye of
the spectator of the scene, and upon this plane represent the more
the figures, and the buildings on various hills and open spaces, you
can represent all the events of the history. And on the remainder of
the wall up to the top put trees, large as compared with the
543.
SEEN FROM THE POINT FROM WHICH THE OBJECTS WERE DRAWN.
he looks at it, has his eye at the very distance and height and
direction where the eye or the point of sight was placed in doing
rather a hole, of the size of your face through which you can look
at the work; and if you do this, beyond all doubt your work, if it
385
nay you will hardly persuade yourself that those objects are
you make your view at least 20 times as far off as the greatest
If you want the proof briefly shown, take a piece of wood in the
column without any plinth or capital; then mark off on a flat wall
40 equal spaces, equal to its width so that between them they make
opposite the centre space, and at 4 braccia from the wall, a thin
strip of iron with a small round hole in the middle about as large
as a big pearl. Close to this hole place a light touching it. Then
place your column against each mark on the wall and draw the outline
of its shadow; afterwards shade it and look through the hole in the
iron plate.
544.
386
A diminished object should be seen from the same distance, height
The lesser fault you can fall into then, will be that of
and on whichever side you are standing the objects thus seen will
line you will see, beyond a few columns separated by intervals, that
the columns touch; and beyond where they touch they cover each
other, till the last column projects but very little beyond the last
but one. Thus the spaces between the columns are by degrees entirely
same effect; this effect results from standing near the line in
which the columns are placed. This method is not satisfactory unless
the objects seen are viewed from a small hole, in the middle of
which is your point of sight; but if you proceed thus your work will
387
be perfect and will deceive the beholder, who will see the columns
Here the eye is in the middle, at the point a and near to the
columns.
is the proof) has obviously no connection with the text. The second
22 and 23.]
545.
If you cannot arrange that those who look at your work should stand
height and width of your work. This will make so little difference
relation to the point t. But consider the diagram given below and
you will see that this is wrong, and why I shall make b smaller
388
the original between lines 8 and 9.].
placed side by side the one at 3 braccia distance looks smaller than
drawn of their proper size, and if you see them from a distance they
will appear just as they ought, and if you see them close they will
diminish of themselves.
[Footnote 15: Compare No. 526 line 18.] Take care that the vertical
plan on which you work out the perspective of the objects seen is of
546.
OF PAINTING.
The size of the figures represented ought to show you the distance
they are seen from. If you see a figure as large as nature you know
389
547.
somewhat of the nature of a mirror. And for this reason the nearer
you go towards the point c, the less you will see, because the
rays of light falling from the window on the picture are reflected
will get a good view of it, and the more so as you approach the
rays of light.
III.
548.
390
Although practical painters attribute to all shaded objects--trees,
which are more conspicuous than other parts of the figure; still to
illuminates it; I say--by the 4th [proposition] which says that that
between the light and the illuminated object are infinite, and the
the lines between them; extending from the centre of the luminous
391
549.
HOW THE PAINTER MUST PLACE HIMSELF WITH REFERENCE TO THE LIGHT,
TO
only his eye is between the shaded and the illuminated portions of
the object he is drawing; and this place you will find by putting
yourself between the point m and the division between the shadow
550.
The shadows cast by the sun or any other particular light have not a
pleasing effect on the body to which they belong, because the parts
shade. And the shadows are of equal strength at the end and at the
beginning.
551.
392
HOW LIGHT SHOULD BE THROWN UPON FIGURES.
under which you wish to represent your figures: that is, if you
represent them in the sunshine make the shadows dark with large
spaces of light, and mark their shadows and those of all the
doors, make a strong difference between the lights and shadows, with
firelight make the high lights ruddy and strong, and the shadows
dark, and those cast on the walls and on the floor will be clearly
defined and the farther they are from the body the broader and
longer will they be. If the light is partly from the fire and partly
from the outer day, that of day will be the stronger and that of the
fire almost as red as fire itself. Above all see that the figures
you paint are broadly lighted and from above, that is to say all
living persons that you paint; for you will see that all the people
you meet out in the street are lighted from above, and you must know
that if you saw your most intimate friend with a light [on his face]
552.
393
OF HELPING THE APPARENT RELIEF OF A PICTURE BY GIVING IT ARTIFICIAL
and the solid object on which its shadow falls, a line of bright
light, dividing the figure from the object in shadow. And on the
same object you shall represent two light parts which will surround
the shadow cast upon the wall by the figure placed opposite [6]; and
do this frequently with the limbs which you wish should stand out
somewhat from the body they belong to; particularly when the arms
cross the front of the breast show, between the shadow cast by the
arms on the breast and the shadow on the arms themselves, a little
light seeming to fall through a space between the breast and the
arms; and the more you wish the arm to look detached from the breast
the broader you must make the light; always contrive also to arrange
the figures against the background in such a way as that the parts
553.
OF SITUATION.
Remember [to note] the situation of your figures; for the light and
394
shade will be one thing if the object is in a dark place with a
554.
First you must consider whether the figures have the relief required
by their situation and the light which illuminates them; for the
are surrounded by shadows and another when they have shadows only on
one side. Those which are in the middle of the picture are
stand between them and the light. And those are lighted on one side
only which stand between the principal group and the light, because
where they do not look towards the light they face the group and the
darkness of the group is thrown on them: and where they do not face
the group they face the brilliant light and it is their own darkness
395
circumstances of the story. Thirdly, whether the figures are
555.
First give a general shadow to the whole of that extended part which
is away from the light. Then put in the half shadows and the strong
shadows, comparing them with each other and, in the same way give
the extended light in half tint, afterwards adding the half lights
556.
OF SHADOWS ON BODIES.
When you represent the dark shadows in bodies in light and shade,
always show the cause of the shadow, and the same with reflections;
because the dark shadows are produced by dark objects and the
as between the origin of the lights on the body and the origin of
396
the reflections.
557.
I must remind you to take care that every portion of a body, and
558.
When you draw a figure and you wish to see whether the shadow is the
proper complement to the light, and neither redder nor yellower than
thus. Cast a shadow with your finger on the illuminated portion, and
if the accidental shadow that you have made is like the natural
shadow cast by your finger on your work, well and good; and by
putting your finger nearer or farther off, you can make darker or
559.
397
OF SURROUNDING BODIES BY VARIOUS FORMS OF SHADOW.
Take care that the shadows cast upon the surface of the bodies by
the limbs which cast the shadows, and of the objects on which they
are cast.
560.
ON PAINTING.
to imitate and copy the objects he sees. The reason is this: If you
see a white drapery side by side with a black one, that part of the
white drapery which lies against the black one will certainly look
much whiter than the part which lies against something whiter than
is said in No. 280.] And the reason of this is shown in my [book on]
perspective.
398
561.
OF SHADOWS.
make the shadow end like a stone, because flesh has a certain
eye and the sun, which shines through it ruddy and bright. Place the
most highly coloured part between the light and shadow. And to see
hold your finger nearer to or farther from your picture, and copy
that [shadow].
562.
The ground which surrounds the forms of any object you paint should
be darker than the high lights of those figures, and lighter than
399
563.
that the side which is in light shall terminate against a dark body
and likewise that the shadow side shall terminate against a light
body. And by [following] this rule you will add greatly to the
564.
those natural objects which are convex are always visible, and also
the forms of these bodies against the background, even though the
illuminated in the same way as, by the same light, the background is
400
detached from the background; while in the case here described the
themselves.
565.
That you ought, when representing objects above the eye and on one
side--if you wish them to look detached from the wall--to show,
between the shadow on the object and the shadow it casts a middle
light, so that the body will appear to stand away from the wall.
566.
that in some portions it will dazzle the eyes like the sun itself;
the atmosphere itself is blue, that side of the woman's figure will
401
appear steeped in blue. If the surface of the ground about her be
and the sun itself, you will see every portion of those folds which
are towards the meadow tinged by the reflected rays with the colour
of that meadow. Thus the white is transmuted into the colours of the
567.
We see quite plainly that all the images of visible objects that lie
before us, whether large or small, reach our sense by the minute
aperture of the eye; and if, through so small a passage the image
can pass of the vast extent of sky and earth, the face of a
that is to say the crystalline lens which looks dark, this image,
402
like a perforation in a board; on looking into it it appears dark
and the objects seen through the bright air and a dark one become
from you of an arrow's flight, and hold the eye of a small needle
close to your own eye, you can see through it several men whose
images are transmitted to the eye and will all be comprised within
the size of the needle's eye; hence, if the man who is at the
distance of an arrow's flight can send his whole image to your eye,
occupying only a small space in the needle's eye how can you
mouth or any detail of his person? and, not seeing these you cannot
recognise the man, since these features, which he does not show, are
568.
because they are remote from the eye; this being the case it is
403
eye and the objects, and this air interferes with the distinctness
Painter, make your smaller figures merely indicated and not highly
distance between it and the eye, this great distance is filled with
air, that mass of air forms a dense body which intervenes and
569.
first the distinctness of the smallest parts; while the larger parts
are left to the last, losing all distinctness of detail and outline;
570.
OF PAINTING.
The density of a body of smoke looks white below the horizon while
404
IV.
571.
PICTURES.
When you have well learnt perspective and have by heart the parts
and forms of objects, you must go about, and constantly, as you go,
the men themselves and the actions of the bystanders, who separate
them or who look on. And take a note of them with slight strokes
thus, in a little book which you should always carry with you. And
change the old [when full] for a new one; since these things should
not be rubbed out but preserved with great care; for the forms, and
masters.
405
one has coloured paper, so no sketches answering to this description
can be pointed out. The fact that most of the notes are written in
ink, militates against the supposition that they were made in the
open air.]
572.
several heads, eyes, noses, mouths, chins and cheeks and necks and
full face they are of 11 types; these are equal thick in the middle,
thin in the middle, with the tip thick and the root narrow, or
narrow at the tip and wide at the root; with the nostrils wide or
narrow, high or low, and the openings wide or hidden by the point;
and you will find an equal variety in the other details; which
things you must draw from nature and fix them in your mind. Or else,
when you have to draw a face by heart, carry with you a little book
in which you have noted such features; and when you have cast a
glance at the face of the person you wish to draw, you can look, in
406
nothing, because they are kept in mind without difficulty.
573.
HOW YOU SHOULD SET TO WORK TO DRAW A HEAD OF WHICH ALL THE
PARTS
To draw a head in which the features shall agree with the turn and
bend of the head, pursue this method. You know that the eyes,
eyebrows, nostrils, corners of the mouth, and sides of the chin, the
jaws, cheeks, ears and all the parts of a face are squarely and
Pl. IX. (No. 315), Pl. X (No. 316), Pl. XL (No. 318) and Pl. XII.
(No. 319).]
Therefore when you have sketched the face draw lines passing from
one corner of the eye to the other; and so for the placing of each
feature; and after having drawn the ends of the lines beyond the two
sides of the face, look if the spaces inside the same parallel lines
on the right and on the left are equal [12]. But be sure to remember
407
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXI, No. 4, the slight sketch on the left hand
side. The text of this passage is written by the side of it. In this
574.
and that side of the head on which the rays fall most directly will
be the most highly lighted, and those parts on which the rays fall
most aslant will be less lighted. The light falls as a blow might,
you throw a ball at a wall of which the extremities are equally far
from you the blow will fall straight, and if you throw the ball at
the wall when standing at one end of it the ball will hit it
408
obliquely and the blow will not tell.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXI. No. 4; the sketch on the right hand side.]
575.
THE PROOF AND REASON WHY AMONG THE ILLUMINATED PARTS CERTAIN
derived from one single point the side illuminated by it will have
its highest light on the portion where the line of radiance falls
Where the angles made by the lines of incidence are most equal there
will be the highest light, and where they are most unequal it will
be darkest.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXII. The text, here given complete, is on the
right hand side. The small circles above the beginning of lines 5
409
and 11 as well as the circle above the text on Pl. XXXI, are in a
Prolegomena. No. 12, p. 3). The text on the left hand side of this
576.
577.
When you compose a historical picture take two points, one the point
of sight, and the other the source of light; and make this as
distant as possible.
578.
many figures.
579.
PRECEPTS IN PAINTING.
410
Let you sketches of historical pictures be swift and the working out
of the limbs not be carried too far, but limited to the position of
the limbs, which you can afterwards finish as you please and at your
leisure.
[Footnote: See Pl. XXXVIII, No. 2. The pen and ink drawing given
580.
work.
581.
you place one figure behind another take care to draw the whole of
it so that the limbs which come in front of the nearer figures may
411
582.
How the ages of man should be depicted: that is, Infancy, Childhood,
MS.]
583.
Old men ought to be represented with slow and heavy movements, their
legs bent at the knees, when they stand still, and their feet placed
parallel and apart; bending low with the head leaning forward, and
412
[Footnote: bracci raccolte. Compare Pl. XXXIII. This drawing, in
from the head across the bosom. This drawing evidently dates from
preparatory study for some picture. The type of hand with its
slender thin forms is more like the style of the Vierge aux
Rochers in the Louvre than any later works--as the Mona Lisa for
instance.]
584.
You must make an angry person holding someone by the hair, wrenching
his head against the ground, and with one knee on his ribs; his
413
right arm and fist raised on high. His hair must be thrown up, his
brow downcast and knit, his teeth clenched and the two corners of
his mouth grimly set; his neck swelled and bent forward as he leans
You must show a man in despair with a knife, having already torn
open his garments, and with one hand tearing open the wound. And
make him standing on his feet and his legs somewhat bent and his
whole person leaning towards the earth; his hair flying in disorder.
585.
You know that you cannot invent animals without limbs, each of
say a Dragon, take for its head that of a mastiff or hound, with the
tortoise.
414
[Footnote: The sketch here inserted of two men on horseback fighting
586.
A painter who has clumsy hands will paint similar hands in his
works, and the same will occur with any limb, unless long study has
figures will seem the same and devoid of charm; and it is the same
with any part that may be good or poor in yourself; it will be shown
587.
he may acquire by incidental study in this way: Look about you and
415
take the best parts of many beautiful faces, of which the beauty is
confirmed rather by public fame than by your own judgment; for you
your own. For it would seem that such resemblances often please us;
and if you should be ugly, you would select faces that were not
beautiful and you would then make ugly faces, as many painters do.
588.
589.
When selecting figures you should choose slender ones rather than
590.
The hollow spaces interposed between the muscles must not be of such
a character as that the skin should seem to cover two sticks laid
side by side like c, nor should they seem like two sticks somewhat
416
remote from such contact so that the skin hangs in an empty loose
by the contact of the ends of the muscles and as the skin cannot
fold down into such an angle, nature has filled up such angles with
591.
those you want to represent as strong you must not make so,
592.
417
OF GRACE IN THE LIMBS.
The limbs should be adapted to the body with grace and with
reference to the effect that you wish the figure to produce. And if
you wish to produce a figure that shall of itself look light and
graceful you must make the limbs elegant and extended, and without
too much display of the muscles; and those few that are needed for
your purpose you must indicate softly, that is, not very prominent
and without strong shadows; the limbs, and particularly the arms
easy; that is, none of the limbs should be in a straight line with
the adjoining parts. And if the hips, which are the pole of a man,
are by reason of his position, placed so, that the right is higher
perpendicular line above the highest prominence of the hip, and let
this right shoulder be lower than the left. Let the pit of the
throat always be over the centre of the joint of the foot on which
the man is leaning. The leg which is free should have the knee lower
than the other, and near the other leg. The positions of the head
and arms are endless and I shall therefore not enlarge on any rules
for them. Still, let them be easy and pleasing, with various turns
and twists, and the joints gracefully bent, that they may not look
593.
418
A picture or representation of human figures, ought to be done in
way, if you wish to depict a man of a brutal nature, give him fierce
movements; as with his arms flung out towards the listener, and his
head and breast thrust forward beyond his feet, as if following the
speaker's hands. Thus it is with a deaf and dumb person who, when he
in Florence a man who had become deaf who, when you spoke very loud
did not understand you, but if you spoke gently and without making
any sound, understood merely from the movement of the lips. Now
perhaps you will say that the lips of a man who speaks loudly do not
move like those of one speaking softly, and that if they were to
[Footnote: The first ten lines of this text have already been
419
594.
consider the matter of which he has to treat and adapt his action to
argument, let the speaker, with the fingers of the right hand hold
one finger of the left hand, having the two smaller ones closed; and
his face alert, and turned towards the people with mouth a little
represent him standing make him leaning slightly forward with body
and head towards the people. These you must represent as silent and
admiration; and make some old men in astonishment at the things they
hear, with the corners of their mouths pulled down and drawn in,
wrinkling the forehead where they meet. Again, some sitting with
their fingers clasped holding their weary knees. Again, some bent
old man, with one knee crossed over the other; on which let him hold
his hand with his other elbow resting in it and the hand supporting
420
ink drawing in the Louvre which Herr CARL BRUN considers as studies
for the Last Supper in the church of Santa Maria delle Grazie (see
introducing the drawing in this place, I may point out that some of
595.
consider that when you wish to represent a man who, by some chance,
has to turn backwards or to one side, you must not make him move his
feet and all his limbs towards the side to which he turns his head.
Rather must you make the action proceed by degrees and through the
different joints; that is, those of the foot, the knee and the hip
and the neck. And if you set him on the right leg, you must make the
421
left knee bend inwards, and let his foot be slightly raised on the
outside, and the left shoulder be somewhat lower than the right,
while the nape of the neck is in a line directly over the outer
perpendicular line above the toes of the right foot. And always set
your figures so that the side to which the head turns is not the
side to which the breast faces, since nature for our convenience has
made us with a neck which bends with ease in many directions, the
at any time you make a man sitting with his arms at work on
something which is sideways to him, make the upper part of his body
596.
When you draw the nude always sketch the whole figure and then
finish those limbs which seem to you the best, but make them act
with the other limbs; otherwise you will get a habit of never
Never make the head turn the same way as the torso, nor the arm and
leg move together on the same side. And if the face is turned to the
right shoulder, make all the parts lower on the left side than on
422
the right; and when you turn the body with the breast outwards, if
the head turns to the left side make the parts on the right side
by the side of the second part of this chapter; its faded condition
the outlines of the head have probably been touched up. This passage
597.
OF PAINTING.
[Footnote: See Pl. V, where part of the text is also reproduced. The
598.
baseness.
423
599.
OF PAINTING.
Make your work carry out your purpose and meaning. That is when you
doing.
OF PAINTING.
With regard to any action which you give in a picture to an old man
or to a young one, you must make it more energetic in the young man
600.
The limbs which are used for labour must be muscular and those which
are not much used you must make without muscles and softly rounded.
424
what purpose is in the mind of each; otherwise your art will not be
admirable.
V.
601.
First you must represent the smoke of artillery mingling in the air
with the dust and tossed up by the movement of horses and the
combatants. And this mixture you must express thus: The dust, being
falls again. It is the finest part that rises highest; hence that
part will be least seen and will look almost of the same colour as
the air. The higher the smoke mixed with the dust-laden air rises
towards a certain level, the more it will look like a dark cloud;
and it will be seen that at the top, where the smoke is more
separate from the dust, the smoke will assume a bluish tinge and the
dust will tend to its colour. This mixture of air, smoke and dust
will look much lighter on the side whence the light comes than on
425
the opposite side. The more the combatants are in this turmoil the
less will they be seen, and the less contrast will there be in their
lights and shadows. Their faces and figures and their appearance,
and the musketeers as well as those near them you must make of a
The figures which are between you and the light, if they be at a
distance, will appear dark on a light background, and the lower part
of their legs near the ground will be least visible, because there
the dust is coarsest and densest [19]. And if you introduce horses
galloping outside the crowd, make the little clouds of dust distant
from each other in proportion to the strides made by the horses; and
the clouds which are furthest removed from the horses, should be
least visible; make them high and spreading and thin, and the nearer
ones will be more conspicuous and smaller and denser [23]. The air
some falling, some flying level. The balls from the guns must have a
you must make with dust on the hair and eyebrows and on other flat
places likely to retain it. The conquerors you will make rushing
onwards with their hair and other light things flying on the wind,
426
602.
and with the opposite limbs thrust forward; that is where a man puts
forward the right foot the left arm must be advanced. And if you
make any one fallen, you must show the place where he has slipped
and been dragged along the dust into blood stained mire; and in the
half-liquid earth arround show the print of the tramping of men and
horses who have passed that way. Make also a horse dragging the dead
body of his master, and leaving behind him, in the dust and mud, the
track where the body was dragged along. You must make the conquered
and beaten pale, their brows raised and knit, and the skin above
their brows furrowed with pain, the sides of the nose with wrinkles
going in an arch from the nostrils to the eyes, and make the
speak--, and the lips arched upwards and discovering the upper
teeth; and the teeth apart as with crying out and lamentation. And
make some one shielding his terrified eyes with one hand, the palm
towards the enemy, while the other rests on the ground to support
his half raised body. Others represent shouting with their mouths
open, and running away. You must scatter arms of all sorts among the
other such objects. And you must make the dead partly or entirely
covered with dust, which is changed into crimson mire where it has
427
their fists clenched against their bodies and their legs contorted.
Some might be shown disarmed and beaten down by the enemy, turning
upon the foe, with teeth and nails, to take an inhuman and bitter
revenge. You might see some riderless horse rushing among the enemy,
with his mane flying in the wind, and doing no little mischief with
his heels. Some maimed warrior may be seen fallen to the earth,
covering himself with his shield, while the enemy, bending over him,
of men fallen in a heap over a dead horse. You would see some of the
victors leaving the fight and issuing from the crowd, rubbing their
eyes and cheeks with both hands to clean them of the dirt made by
their watering eyes smarting from the dust and smoke. The reserves
shading them with their hands and gazing through the dense and murky
pointing to the spot where they are most needed. And there may be a
river into which horses are galloping, churning up the water all
round them into turbulent waves of foam and water, tossed into the
air and among the legs and bodies of the horses. And there must not
603.
428
BATTLE.
they stand. And this is proved by the sides of wells which grow
deepest part of the well sees and receives a smaller amount of the
said men and horses, will always be more lighted and at a more
604.
night under these conditions and that you want to represent a night
which are nearest to this fire will be most tinged with its colour;
most in its nature; as therefore you give the fire a red colour, you
must make all the objects illuminated by it ruddy; while those which
are farther from the fire are more tinted by the black hue of night.
The figures which are seen against the fire look dark in the glare
429
of the firelight because that side of the objects which you see is
tinged by the darkness of the night and not by the fire; and those
who stand at the side are half dark and half red; while those who
are visible beyond the edges of the flame will be fully lighted by
make those which are near it screen themselves with their hands and
cloaks as a defence against the intense heat, and with their faces
intolerable glare.
605.
606.
effects as seen, when the wind, blowing over the face of the sea and
earth, removes and carries with it such things as are not fixed to
the general mass. And to represent the storm accurately you must
first show the clouds scattered and torn, and flying with the wind,
430
accompanied by clouds of sand blown up from the sea shore, and
boughs and leaves swept along by the strength and fury of the blast
and scattered with other light objects through the air. Trees and
the course of the gale, with their branches twisted out of their
natural growth and their leaves tossed and turned about [Footnote
11: See Pl. XL, No. 2.]. Of the men who are there some must have
to be recognized for the dust, while those who remain standing may
be behind some tree, with their arms round it that the wind may not
tear them away; others with their hands over their eyes for the
dust, bending to the ground with their clothes and hair streaming in
the wind. [Footnote 15: See Pl. XXXIV, the right hand lower sketch.]
Let the sea be rough and tempestuous and full of foam whirled among
the lofty waves, while the wind flings the lighter spray through the
ships that are therein some should be shown with rent sails and the
tatters fluttering through the air, with ropes broken and masts
split and fallen. And the ship itself lying in the trough of the sea
and wrecked by the fury of the waves with the men shrieking and
the impetuosity of the wind and flung against the lofty mountain
tops, and wreathed and torn like waves beating upon rocks; the air
itself terrible from the deep darkness caused by the dust and fog
431
Of representing the deluge (607-609).
607.
The air was darkened by the heavy rain whose oblique descent driven
aslant by the rush of the winds, flew in drifts through the air not
the heavy drops of falling water. But it was tinged with the colour
rent and shattered; and whose flashes revealed the broad waters of
the inundated valleys, above which was seen the verdure of the
bending tree tops. Neptune will be seen in the midst of the water
with his trident, and [15] let AEolus with his winds be shown
waves. The horizon and the whole hemisphere were obscure, but lurid
from the flashes of the incessant lightning. Men and birds might be
608.
432
Let the dark and gloomy air be seen buffeted by the rush of contrary
winds and dense from the continued rain mingled with hail and
the trees and mixed with numberless leaves. All round may be seen
venerable trees, uprooted and stripped by the fury of the winds; and
falling into those torrents and choking their valleys till the
swollen rivers overflow and submerge the wide lowlands and their
to tameness, in company with men and women who had fled there with
their children. The waters which covered the fields, with their
waves were in great part strewn with tables, bedsteads, boats and
death, on which were men and women with their children amid sounds
with their tempestuous violence rolled the waters under and over and
about the bodies of the drowned. Nor was there any object lighter
than the water which was not covered with a variety of animals
battling them with the blows of drowned bodies, blows which killed
those in whom any life remained [19]. You might have seen
small spots that remained to them against lions, wolves and beasts
433
of prey who sought safety there. Ah! what dreadful noises were heard
in the air rent by the fury of the thunder and the lightnings it
flashed forth, which darted from the clouds dealing ruin and
striking all that opposed its course. Ah! how many you might have
seen closing their ears with their hands to shut out the tremendous
sounds made in the darkened air by the raging of the winds mingling
with the rain, the thunders of heaven and the fury of the
thunder-bolts. Others were not content with shutting their eyes, but
laid their hands one over the other to cover them the closer that
they might not see the cruel slaughter of the human race by the
wrath of God. Ah! how many laments! and how many in their terror
flung themselves from the rocks! Huge branches of great oaks loaded
with men were seen borne through the air by the impetuous fury of
the winds. How many were the boats upset, some entire, and some
with desperate act, took their own lives, hopeless of being able to
lofty rocks, others strangled themselves with their own hands, other
seized their own children and violently slew them at a blow; some
mothers wept over their drowned sons, holding them upon their knees,
with arms raised spread out towards heaven and with words and
Others with clasped hands and fingers clenched gnawed them and
434
devoured them till they bled, crouching with their breast down on
already environed by the waters and left isolated on the high peaks
themselves; and many would die for lack of food. Already had the
uncovered which was not occupied by living beings, and already had
famine, the minister of death, taken the lives of the greater number
of the animals, when the dead bodies, now fermented, where leaving
the depth of the waters and were rising to the top. Among the
buffeting waves, where they were beating one against the other, and,
these found a resting place on the bodies of the dead. And above
these judgements, the air was seen covered with dark clouds, riven
The motion of the air is seen by the motion of the dust thrown up by
the vacuum left in the air which enclosed the horse, as he is rapid
Perhaps it will seem to you that you may reproach me with having
represented the currents made through the air by the motion of the
435
wind notwithstanding that the wind itself is not visible in the air.
To this I must answer that it is not the motion of the wind but only
air.
436
Ships broken to pieces, beaten on rocks.
rocks, towers and hills covered with people, boats, tables, troughs,
and other means of floating. Hills covered with men, women and
of the Vatican copy alluded when he wrote on the margin of fol. 36:
are among those which have never before been published. The
XXXVI and XXXVII, since they obviously belong to this text. The
drawings No. 2 on Pl. XXXV are, in the original, side by side with
the drawing in Indian ink given on Pl. XXXIV we see Wind-gods in the
15.-Plates XXXVI and XXXVII form one sheet in the original. The
437
sketches, excepting the sketches of clouds on the right hand side.
These texts are given as No. 477. The group of small figures on Pl.
609.
valleys surrounding its base, and on its sides let the surface of
the soil be seen to slide, together with the small roots of the
let it dash along and lay bare the twisted and gnarled roots of
large trees overthrowing their roots upwards; and let the mountains,
great part clothed and covered with ruins of shrubs, hurled down
from the sides of their lofty peaks, which will be mixed with mud,
roots, boughs of trees, with all sorts of leaves thrust in with the
mud and earth and stones. And into the depth of some valley may have
waters of its river; which, having already burst its banks, will
rush on in monstrous waves; and the greatest will strike upon and
destroy the walls of the cities and farmhouses in the valley [14].
438
Then the ruins of the high buildings in these cities will throw up a
the falling rain; But the swollen waters will sweep round the pool
different obstacles, and leaping into the air in muddy foam; then,
falling back, the beaten water will again be dashed into the air.
And the whirling waves which fly from the place of concussion, and
direction, after their recoil will be tossed up into the air but
without dashing off from the surface. Where the water issues from
the pool the spent waves will be seen spreading out towards the
outlet; and there falling or pouring through the air and gaining
weight and impetus they will strike on the water below piercing it
and rushing furiously to reach its depth; from which being thrown
back it returns to the surface of the lake, carrying up the air that
was submerged with it; and this remains at the outlet in foam
mingled with logs of wood and other matters lighter than water.
Round these again are formed the beginnings of waves which increase
base and thus they are less conspicuous as they die away. But if
these waves rebound from various objects they then return in direct
movement they started with. The rain, as it falls from the clouds is
439
unless indeed the sun's rays should break through them; in that case
the rain will appear less dark than the clouds. And if the heavy
into the vast pools of water, a great quantity will be flung into
the object which struck the water; that is to say: The angle of
largest in mass will keep farthest from the two opposite shores. The
nearer to their centre. The crests of the waves of the sea tumble to
their bases falling with friction on the bubbles of their sides; and
this friction grinds the falling water into minute particles and
this being converted into a dense mist, mingles with the gale in the
manner of curling smoke and wreathing clouds, and at last it, rises
into the air and is converted into clouds. But the rain which falls
through the atmosphere being driven and tossed by the winds becomes
eye of the spectator. The waves of the sea which break on the slope
of the mountains which bound it, will foam from the velocity with
which they fall against these hills; in rushing back they will meet
the next wave as it comes and and after a loud noise return in a
great flood to the sea whence they came. Let great numbers of
440
the rising of the deluge to the peaks of the mountains in the midst
The wave of the sea at Piombino is all foaming water. [Footnote 55.
56: These two lines are written below the bottom sketch on Pl. XXXV,
3. The MS. Leic. being written about the year 1510 or later, it does
not seem to me to follow that the sketches must have been made at
Piombino, where Leonardo was in the year 1502 and possibly returned
Of the water which leaps up from the spot where great masses fall on
and rain with boughs and shrubs mixed in the air. Emptying the boats
to 54.]
610.
hills on the caves within--by the falling of the hills which served
441
A stone flung through the air leaves on the eye which sees it the
drops of water which fall from the clouds when it [16] rains.
clouds; but the colour of this dust will differ from that of the
clouds. Where the rain is thickest let the colour of the dust be
less conspicuous and where the dust is thickest let the rain be less
conspicuous. And where the rain is mingled with the wind and with
the dust the clouds created by the rain must be more transparent
than those of dust [alone]. And when flames of fire are mingled with
clouds of smoke and water very opaque and dark clouds will be formed
[Footnote 26-28: Compare Pl. XL, 1--the drawing in Indian ink on the
of an eruption (see his remarks on Mount Etna in Vol II).]. And the
painting.
[Footnote: See the sketches and text on Pl. XXXVIII, No. 1. Lines
1-16 are there given on the left hand side, 17-30 on the right. The
four lines at the bottom on the right are given as No. 472. Above
these texts, which are written backwards, there are in the original
sixteen lines in a larger writing from left to right, but only half
of air and water. It does not seem to me that there is any reason
442
Compare with it the facsimile of the rough copy of Leonardo's letter
611.
of hastily made barks. But little of the waves were visible in those
But where the flashes caused by the bolts of heaven were reflected,
there were seen as many bright spots, caused by the image of the
spectator.
they were nearer the eye which saw them [Footnote 22. 23: Com'e
provato. See Vol. II, Nos. 874-878 and 892-901], as it has been
marine horizon when the sun's rays are reflected in it and the eye
VI.
443
THE ARTIST'S MATERIALS.
612.
To make points [crayons] for colouring dry. Temper with a little wax
and do not dry it; which wax you must dissolve with water: so that
when the white lead is thus tempered, the water being distilled, may
go off in vapour and the wax may remain; you will thus make good
crayons; but you must know that the colours must be ground with a
hot stone.
613.
614.
Take powdered gall nuts and vitriol, powder them and spread them on
444
615.
drawing frame and then draw your letters and cut them out, and make
616.
This paper should be painted over with candle soot tempered with
thin glue, then smear the leaf thinly with white lead in oil as is
done to the letters in printing, and then print in the ordinary way.
Thus the leaf will appear shaded in the hollows and lighted on the
parts in relief; which however comes out here just the contrary.
leaf of sage, has already been published in the Saggio delle Opere
445
Erano i primi tentativi di quella riproduzione immediata delle parti
altri."]
617.
mixture and filtered milk of an herb called calves foot; and when
this paper is prepared and damped and folded and wrapped up it may
be mixed with the mixture and thus left to dry; but if you break it
called lasagne and you may then damp it and wrap it up and put it
covered with stiff transparent white and sardonio and then damped
so that it may not form angles and then covered up with strong
and dry it and then place it between two sheets of papyrus and break
it inside with a wooden mallet with a handle and then open it with
care holding the lower sheet of paper flat and firm so that the
with hot glue and apply it on the top of all these pieces and let
them stick fast; then turn it upside down and apply transparent size
several times in the spaces between the pieces, each time pouring in
446
first some black and then some stiff white and each time leaving it
618.
To make a fine green take green and mix it with bitumen and you will
make the shadows darker. Then, for lighter [shades] green with
yellow ochre, and for still lighter green with yellow, and for the
high lights pure yellow; then mix green and turmeric together and
glaze every thing with it. To make a fine red take cinnabar or red
chalk or burnt ochre for the dark shadows and for the lighter ones
red chalk and vermilion and for the lights pure vermilion and then
glaze with fine lake. To make good oil for painting. One part of
619.
Use black in the shadow, and in the lights white, yellow, green,
vermilion and lake. Medium shadows; take the shadow as above and mix
yellow and a little green and occasionally some lake; for the
[Footnote 618 and 619: If we may judge from the flourishes with
447
which the writing is ornamented these passages must have been
620.
You can make a fine ochre by the same method as you use to make
white.
621.
A FINE YELLOW.
WHITE.
Put the white into an earthen pot, and lay it no thicker than a
string, and let it stand in the sun undisturbed for 2 days; and in
the morning when the sun has dried off the night dews.
622.
To make reddish black for flesh tints take red rock crystals from
Rocca Nova or garnets and mix them a little; again armenian bole is
good in part.
448
623.
624.
If one ounce of black mixed with one ounce of white gives a certain
625.
626.
short time they will not turn black. Ultramarine blue and glass
wall-painting. Lac and verdigris make a good shadow for blue in oil
painting.
627.
449
Grind verdigris many times coloured with lemon juice and keep it
628.
must coat it over with mastic and turpentine twice distilled and
white or, if you like, lime, and put it in a frame so that it may
expand and shrink according to its moisture and dryness. Then give
cold rub it well with a cloth to dry it. Over this apply liquid
varnish and white with a stick, then wash it with urine when it is
dry, and dry it again. Then pounce and outline your drawing finely
passages:
450
1.opero allor [?] bo [alloro?] = "ou bien de [laurier]."
qu'il" etc.
629.
OIL.
Make some oil of mustard seed; and if you wish to make it with
greater ease mix the ground seeds with linseed oil and put it all
630.
Take the rank oil and put ten pints into a jar and make a mark on
the jar at the height of the oil; then add to it a pint of vinegar
and make it boil till the oil has sunk to the level of the mark and
451
thus you will be certain that the oil is returned to its original
quantity and the vinegar will have gone off in vapour, carrying with
it the evil smell; and I believe you may do the same with nut oil or
631.
nature of ..., if you do not remove it when you make the oil from
them, this skin tinges the oil, and when you work with it this skin
separates from the oil and rises to the surface of the painting, and
632.
If you want to restore oil colours that have become dry keep them
soaking in soft soap for a night and, with your finger, mix them up
with the soft soap; then pour them into a cup and wash them with
water, and in this way you can restore colours that have got dry.
But take care that each colour has its own vessel to itself adding
the colour by degrees as you restore it and mind that they are
thoroughly softened, and when you wish to use them for tempera wash
them five and six times with spring water, and leave them to settle;
if the soft soap should be thick with any of the colours pass it
452
through a filter. [Footnote: The same remark applies to these
633.
OIL.
634.
... outside the bowl 2 fingers lower than the level of the oil, and
pass it into the neck of a bottle and let it stand and thus all the
oil will separate from this milky liquid; it will enter the bottle
and be as clear as crystal; and grind your colours with this, and
every coarse or viscid part will remain in the liquid. You must know
that all the oils that have been created in seads or fruits are
quite clear by nature, and the yellow colour you see in them only
comes of your not knowing how to draw it out. Fire or heat by its
nature has the power to make them acquire colour. See for example
in a short time they harden because there is more heat in them than
in oil; and after some time they acquire a certain yellow hue
tending to black. But oil, not having so much heat does not do so;
453
fungus of the nature of a husk which exists in the skin which covers
the nut, and this being crushed along with the nuts and being of a
nature that it combines with all colours and then comes to the
surface, and this it is which makes them change. And if you want the
melted over a slow fire and mix it well with the oil and it will
never harden.
and 619.]
635.
Take cypress [oil] and distil it and have a large pitcher, and put
in the extract with so much water as may make it appear like amber,
dissolved you may add in your pitcher as much of the said solution,
as shall make it liquid to your taste. And you must know that amber
454
And since varnish [powder] is the resin of juniper, if you distil
juniper you can dissolve the said varnish [powder] in the essence,
as explained above.
636.
Notch a juniper tree and give it water at the roots, mix the liquor
which exudes with nut-oil and you will have a perfect varnish
[powder], made like amber varnish [powder], fine and of the best
637.
itself entirely from Jupiter and Venus. [Footnote: Here, and in No.
455
638.
Note how aqua vitae absorbs into itself all the colours and smells
of flowers. If you want to make blue put iris flowers into it and
639.
Salt may be made from human excrement burnt and calcined and made
into lees, and dried by a slow fire, and all dung in like manner
yields salt, and these salts when distilled are very pungent.
640.
Sea water filtered through mud or clay, leaves all its saltness in
it. Woollen stuffs placed on board ship absorb fresh water. If sea
and any one who has a little stove in his kitchen can, with the same
641.
MOULD(?).
The mould (?) may be of Venus, or of Jupiter and Saturn and placed
456
frequently in the fire. And it should be worked with fine emery and
the mould (?) should be of Venus and Jupiter impasted over (?)
Venus. But first you will test Venus and Mercury mixed with Jove,
and take means to cause Mercury to disperse; and then fold them well
possible.
642.
rock salt, alcali salt, common salt, rock alum, alum schist (?),
643.
Pitch four ounces virgin wax, four ounces incense, two ounces oil of
644.
Four ounces virgin wax, four ounces Greek pitch, two ounces incense,
one ounce oil of roses, first melt the wax and oil then the Greek
457
645.
Very thin glass may be cut with scissors and when placed over inlaid
through together with the bone and then put it together and it will
retain a lustre that will not be scratched nor worn away by rubbing
646.
Powder gall nuts and let this stand 8 days in the white wine; and in
the same way dissolve vitriol in water, and let the water stand and
settle very clear, and the wine likewise, each by itself, and strain
them well; and when you dilute the white wine with the water the
647.
Put marcasite into aqua fortis and if it turns green, know that it
has copper in it. Take it out with saltpetre and soft soap.
648.
A white horse may have the spots removed with the Spanish haematite
458
or with aqua fortis or with ... Removes the black hair on a white
649.
FIRE.
If you want to make a fire which will set a hall in a blaze without
injury do this: first perfume the hall with a dense smoke of incense
boil ten pounds of brandy to evaporate, but see that the hall is
completely closed and throw up some powdered varnish among the fumes
and this powder will be supported by the smoke; then go into the
blaze.
650.
FIRE.
Take away that yellow surface which covers oranges and distill them
FIRE.
Close a room tightly and have a brasier of brass or iron with fire
459
in it and sprinkle on it two pints of aqua vitae, a little at a
time, so that it may be converted into smoke. Then make some one
come in with a light and suddenly you will see the room in a blaze
VII.
651.
652.
460
grandchild of nature; for all visible things are produced by nature,
and these her children have given birth to painting. Hence we may
653.
BELONGING TO IT.
The eye, which is called the window of the soul, is the principal
means by which the central sense can most completely and abundantly
appreciate the infinite works of nature; and the ear is the second,
which acquires dignity by hearing of the things the eye has seen. If
with your eyes you could not report of them in writing. And if you,
0 poet, tell a story with your pen, the painter with his brush can
be understood. And if you call painting dumb poetry, the painter may
places in words, the painter deals with the actual similitude of the
461
forms, in order to represent them. Now tell me which is the nearer
to the actual man: the name of man or the image of the man. The name
but by death.
654.
And if the poet gratifies the sense by means of the ear, the painter
and if a poet describes one, and they are both together put before
the public, you will see where most of the spectators will stop, to
which they will pay most attention, on which they will bestow most
praise, and which will satisfy them best. Undoubtedly painting being
by a long way the more intelligible and beautiful, will please most.
Write up the name of God [Christ] in some spot and setup His image
opposite and you will see which will be most reverenced. Painting
nothing but words, which are not universal as form is, and if you
her lover and a painter who represents her and you will see to which
462
not lie under the stigma of so base a name. If you call it
too writers, who set down manually with the pen what is devised in
pays you most? Do you do any work without pay? Still, I do not say
this as blaming such views, for every form of labour looks for its
reward. And if a poet should say: "I will invent a fiction with a
Calumny. If you were to say that poetry is more eternal, I say the
them longer than your works or ours; nevertheless they have not much
colours may be yet more permanent. We, by our arts may be called the
mind, painting considers what the mind may effect by the motions [of
in his ways bring forth a variety of forms; but will the painter not
satisfy more? are there not pictures to be seen, so like the actual
463
Painting is superior to sculpture (655. 656).
655.
CHARACTERISTICS OF NATURE.
painting and doing both one and the other in the same degree, it
light and shade. Thus sculpture owes its importance to light and
the spots where nature must necessarily produce them. The sculptor
uses perspective cannot make it in any way appear true; that of the
painter can appear like a hundred miles beyond the picture itself.
nor reflected lights, nor lustrous bodies--as mirrors and the like
464
polished surfaces, nor mists, nor dark skies, nor an infinite number
of things which need not be told for fear of tedium. As regards the
evident that Leonardo was not acquainted with the method of painting
much later date (see Zeitschrift fur bildende Kunst. Vol. X pg.
Dresden und Berlin. Leipzig 1880, pg. 158 and 159.)--Compare No.
enamel on which it is painted with enamel colours and then put into
will be more difficult to improve the mind of the master who makes
656.
We know very well that a really experienced and good painter will
not make such mistakes; on the contrary, with sound rules he will
465
remove so little at a time that he will bring his work to a good
bronze, and this is the last operation and is the most permanent
sculpture in bronze, which, having first been made in wax could then
dark and rough after all, but this latter is covered with various
beautiful and the more imaginative and the more copious, while
Aphorisms (657-659).
657.
OF PAINTING.
466
Men and words are ready made, and you, O Painter, if you do not know
how to make your figures move, are like an orator who knows not how
658.
enter the lists against the painter, if with words he could satisfy
659.
forms, the painter can so depict them that they will appear alive,
with the shadow and light which show the expression of a face; which
you cannot accomplish with the pen though it can be achieved by the
brush.
467
On the history of painting (660. 661).
660.
for his standard the pictures of others. But if he will study from
natural objects he will bear good fruit; as was seen in the painters
after the Romans who always imitated each other and so their art
constantly declined from age to age. After these came Giotto the
by goats and such beasts, and being guided by nature to his art,
was keeper. And thus he began to draw all the animals which were to
be found in the country, and in such wise that after much study he
excelled not only all the masters of his time but all those of many
imitated the pictures that were already done; thus it went on from
showed by his perfect works how those who take for their standard
vain. And, I would say about these mathematical studies that those
who only study the authorities and not the works of nature are
468
descendants but not sons of nature the mistress of all good authors.
Oh! how great is the folly of those who blame those who learn from
nature.
661.
That the first drawing was a simple line drawn round the shadow of a
662.
X.
469
thing more than incidental references to those masterpieces of his
other hand, the sketches and studies prepared by Leonardo for the
complete, are so much more numerous than the manuscript notes, that
The notes for the composition of the Last Supper, which are given
under nos. 665 and 666 occur in a MS. at South Kensington, II2,
written in the years 1494-1495. This MS. sketch was noted down not
more than three or four years before the painting was executed,
which justifies the inference that at the time when it was written
the painter had not made up his mind definitely even as to the
general scheme of the work; and from this we may also conclude that
ascribed to a later date. They are studies for the head of St.
the sketch (in black chalk) for the head of St. Philip, the third
figure on the left hand--see Pl. XL VIII, for St. Peter's right
470
arm--see Pl. XLIX, and for the expressive head of Judas which has
for the head of Judas. The Windsor collection contains two old
copies of the head of St. Simon, the figure to the extreme left of
Christ, both of about equal merit (they are marked as Nos. 21 and
black chalk of folded hands (marked with the old No. 212; No. LXI
pointing out that the difference in style does not allow of our
the face of it, incredible that so great a master should thus have
471
The drawing of Christ's head, in the Brera palace at Milan was
Venice; it was probably made before the text, Nos. 664 and 665,
was written.
The two pen and ink sketches on Pl. XLV seem to belong to an even
earlier date; the more finished drawing of the two, on the right
hand, represents Christ with only St. John and Judas and a third
on this page and the lines of text below the circle (containing the
similar pen and ink drawing reproduced on page 297 below on the
left hand; the original is in the Louvre. On this page again the
the Last Supper, not even, as it seems to me, the group of four men
their midst addressing them. Moreover the writing on this page (an
472
1489.
portrait of "Mona Lisa", nor do the MS. notes ever allude to it,
though according to Vasari the master had it in hand for fully four
years.
I cannot here enter into the remarkable history of this work; I can
scheme and preparations for executing it. The extent of the material
publication here may give some adequate idea of the grandeur of this
the particulars of the battle, but for the reasons given in the note
to this text, I must abandon the idea of taking this passage as the
I may here remind the reader that Leonardo prepared the cartoon in
the Sala del Papa of Santa Maria Novella at Florence and worked
there from the end of October 1503 till February 1504, and then was
busied with the painting in the Sala del Consiglio in the Palazzo
della Signoria, till the work was interrupted at the end of May
473
1506. (See Milanesi's note to Vasari pp. 43--45 Vol. IV ed. 1880.)
must surely have worked from a Flemish copy of the picture. There is
earlier Flemish drawing, such as may have served as the model for
half of the XVIth century, a time when both the picture and the
painter, and probably executed within the first ten years of the
XVIth century. At the same time, it would seem to be a copy not from
474
Signoria; at any rate this little picture, and the small Flemish
visit to Florence lasted from the middle of October 1504 till July
page 337 also represents the Battle of the Standard and seems to
have been made during his first stay, and therefore not from the
fresco but from the cartoon; for, on the same sheet we also find,
for the figure of St. John the Martyr which Raphael used in 1505 in
LVI--we find studies for the episode of the Standard. The standard
475
LIII, and Pl. LIV--where we also find some studies of foot soldiers
horseman is thrown and protects himself with his buckler against the
they ride past. The same action is repeated, with some variation, in
of these three dissimilar sketches may have been the nearest to the
seen from behind, going at a slower pace, with his tail flying out
to the right and the same horse may be seen in the very same
476
attitude carrying a dimly sketched rider, in the foreground of
the whole of the lost cartoon from the mass of materials we now have
way in which foot-soldiers may have been introduced into the cartoon
as fighting among the groups of horsemen; and I may here take the
reproduced on pages 338 and 339 are preliminary studies for the
477
heads of fighting warriors. The two heads drawn in black chalk (pg.
338) and the one seen in profile, turned to the left, drawn in red
the scene of the fight round the standard as we see them in Madame
561b (See Saggio, Tav. XXII). Leonardo used to make such finished
studies for the fresco of the Last Supper, given on Pl. XLVII and
be seen at Windsor (No. 44) and at the Accademia at Venice (IV, 13);
Karoly). These drawings may have been made for other portions of the
478
unsuccessful but perfectly unfounded, is to be seen in the
such as the pen and ink sketches on Pl. XXI and on Pl. XXXVIII, No.
ascertained fact.
With regard to the colours and other materials used by Leonardo the
reader may be referred to the quotations from the accounts for the
No. 636).
Milan, we learn not only from the writings of his contemporaries but
from his own incidental allusions; for instance in MS. C. l5b (1),
lately found at Oxford have been included, Nos. 676 and 677. They
479
are particularly interesting because they are accompanied by large
On Madonna pictures.
663.
480
[In the autumn of] 1478 I began the two Madonna [pictures].
that he had begun two Madonnas at the same time, the word
supposing that they were only planned and never executed. I may here
which the details have almost disappeared in the original but have
pen and ink sketch in, the Codex VALLARDI, in the Louvre, fol. 64,
No. 2316; again a silver point drawing of a Virgin and child drawn
over again with the pen in the His de la Salle collection also in
the Louvre, No. 101. (See Vicomte BOTH DE TAUZIA, Notice des
points out its great resemblance with the sketches for Madonnas in
481
have been published by Mr. HENRY WALLIS in the Art Journal, New Ser.
No. 14, Feb. 1882. If the non-existence of the two pictures here
pictures are meant by the text, it may also be supposed that the
VASARI, Sansoni's ed. Florence 1880. Vol. IV, p. 564): "E perche a
bene imitare, che niuno fu che nella pulitezza e nel finir l'opere
described here, nor would any discussion about the picture in the
they were not made in Florence but later in Milan, must have been
the injuries to which the picture has been exposed than of the
482
original work itself. The wood-cut given on p. 344, is only intended
that the outline and expression of the heads, which in the picture
2. A study of drapery for the left leg of the same figure, done with
the brush, Indian ink on greenish paper, the lights heightened with
white.
defective in the shadow on the upper part of the thigh, which is not
folds of the drapery near the hips are somewhat altered in the
finished work in the Louvre, while the London copy shows a greater
drawing on pale green paper, in the Louvre, of a boy's head (No. 363
483
a slightly altered copy, either from the original picture or from
Vallardi and is now exhibited among the drawings in the Louvre. The
pupil. The action occurs in the kneeling angel of the Paris picture
picture.]
664.
lined A blue coat lined, with fur of foxes' breasts, and the collar
484
of the jerkin covered with black and white stippled velvet Bernardo
[Footnote: These eleven lines of text are by the side of the pen and
name as follows: "Un pendu, vetu d'une longue robe, les mains liées
anciens exposes a l'Ecole des Beaux Arts, Paris 1879; No. 83, pp.
Bernardo was descended from an ancient family and the son of the man
who, under King Ferrante, was President of the High Court of Justice
the Pazzi; he and Francesco Pazzi were entrusted with the task of
appearing in the cathedral at the hour when they expected him, the
two conspirators ran to the palace of the Medici and induced him to
accompany them. Giuliano then took his place in the chancel of the
breast with a short sword; Giuliano stepped backwards and fell dead.
485
The attempt on Lorenzo's life however, by the other conspirators at
rushed upon him, and struck down Francesco Nori who endeavoured to
protect Lorenzo. How Lorenzo then took refuge behind the brazen
doors of the sacristy, and how, as soon as Giuliano's death was made
486
stette." It may however be mentioned with reference to the mode of
Andrea del Castagno (Vol. II, 680; ed. Milanesi 1878), tells us
degli Albizzi, when declared a rebel and exiled in 1434, and his
As has been told, Giuliano de' Medici was murdered on the 26th April
1478, and we see by this that only three months later Botticelli was
suppose that all the members of the conspiracy were depicted by him
487
had been condemned to death. We have no means of knowing whether,
whether the assassin who had escaped may at first not have been
conspirator's dress and its colour on the same sheet, there seems to
committed the murder. A long furred coat might very well be worn at
suppose that this sketch was actually made from nature with the
having been made for this purpose. Be this as it may, the sketch
his MSS. that can be proved to have been written between 1470 and
1480.]
488
Notes on the Last Supper (665-668).
665.
One who was drinking and has left the glass in its position and
Another, twisting the fingers of his hands together turns with stern
brows to his companion [6]. Another with his hands spread open shows
the palms, and shrugs his shoulders up his ears making a mouth of
astonishment [8].
[9] Another speaks into his neighbour's ear and he, as he listens to
him, turns towards him to lend an ear [10], while he holds a knife
in one hand, and in the other the loaf half cut through by the
knife. [13] Another who has turned, holding a knife in his hand,
picture--Pl. XLV, XLVI--, (compare also Pl. LII, 1 and the drawings
passages with the finished picture (see p. 334) we shall see that in
489
many places they coincide. For instance, compare No. 665, 1. 6--8,
with the fourth figure on the right hand of Christ. The various
666.
Another lays his hand on the table and is looking. Another blows his
mouthful. [3] Another leans forward to see the speaker shading his
eyes with his hand. [5] Another draws back behind the one who leans
forward, and sees the speaker between the wall and the man who is
the left; 3, 5 and 6 describe actions which are given to the group
667.
CHRIST.
490
Count Giovanni, the one with the Cardinal of Mortaro.
assuming that Leonardo meant to use the features of the person here
XLVII, XLVIII and L, to admit that not a single line of the Milan
668.
Andrew, Bartholomew.
[Footnote: See PI. XLVI. The names of the disciples are given in the
order in which they are written in the original, from right to left,
669.
491
On the battle of Anghiari.
Florentine
Micheletto,
Niccolo da Pisa
Conte Francesco
Guelfo Orsino,
Albizzi
Begin with the address of Niccolo Piccinino to the soldiers and the
banished Florentines among whom are Messer Rinaldo degli Albizzi and
horseback in armour; and the whole army came after him--40 squadrons
of cavalry, and 2000 foot soldiers went with him. Very early in the
that is the hills, fields and the valley watered by a river; and
Sepolcro with his people, and with a great dust; and perceiving them
he returned to the camp of his own people and addressed them. Having
492
Niccolo Piccinino [24] was the first to attack the bridge which was
held by the Patriarch and the Florentines. Beyond the bridge to his
left he sent forward some infantry to engage ours, who drove them
back, among whom was their captain Micheletto [29] whose lot it was
to be that day at the head of the army. Here, at this bridge there
Here Guido and Astorre, his brother, the Lord of Faenza with a great
number of men, re-formed and renewed the fight, and rushed upon the
Florentines with such force that they recovered the bridge and
pushed forward as far as the tents. But Simonetto advanced with 600
horse, and fell upon the enemy and drove them back once more from
the place, and recaptured the bridge; and behind him came more men
with 2000 horse soldiers. And thus for a long time they fought with
done another great feat of arms. At the same time Niccolo Piccinino
urged forward the remnant of his men, who once more made ours give
way; and if it had not been that the Patriarch set himself at their
head and, by his words and deeds controlled the captains, our
artillery placed on the hill and with these he dispersed the enemy's
call back his son and all his men, and they took to flight towards
Borgo. And then began a great slaughter of men; none escaped but the
foremost of those who had fled or who hid themselves. The battle
493
continued until sunset, when the Patriarch gave his mind to
recalling his men and burying the dead, and afterwards a trophy was
erected.
only is the writing unlike his, but the spelling also is quite
(670-673).
670.
representation of a tempest.
494
picture.]
671.
Il Moro with spectacles, and Envy depicted with False Report and
672.
Il Moro as representing Good Fortune, with hair, and robes, and his
hands in front, and Messer Gualtieri taking him by the robes with a
respectful air from below, having come in from the front [5].
covers him with the skirt of his robe, and with his gilt sceptre he
A plant with its roots in the air to represent one who is at his
starlings].
Those who trust themselves to live near him, and who will be a large
495
crowd, these shall all die cruel deaths; and fathers and mothers
creatures.
673.
He was blacker than a hornet, his eyes were as red as a burning fire
and he rode on a tall horse six spans across and more than 20 long
with six giants tied up to his saddle-bow and one in his hand which
he gnawed with his teeth. And behind him came boars with tusks
496
674.
richly decorated, and with his tail spread over the group; and every
gold ground, to signify the beauty which comes of the grace bestowed
in her place with her pillar in her hand, robed in white, to signify
... And all crowned; and Prudence with 3 eyes. The housing of the
peacock's eyes, and this holds good for all the housings of the
horse, and the man's dress. And the man's crest and his neck-chain
attached to the centre of the horse's hinder thigh piece, and in the
chariot and with a branch of laurel in her hand, to signify the hope
497
[21] Messer Antonio Grimani of Venice companion of Antonio Maria
[23].
[Footnote: Messer Antonio Gri. His name thus abbreviated is, there
can be no doubt, Grimani. Antonio Grimani was the famous Doge who in
1499 commanded the Venetian fleet in battle against the Turks. But
ally of the Turks who took possession of Friuli--, Grimani was driven
into exile; he went to live at Rome with his son Cardinal Domenico
675.
676.
without the other; and as if they were united back to back, since
498
[Footnote: 7. oro. fango: gold, clay. These words stand below the
allegorical figure.]
If you take Pleasure know that he has behind him one who will deal
[9] This represents Pleasure together with Pain, and show them as
twins because one is never apart from the other. They are back to
back because they are opposed to each other; and they exist as
contraries in the same body, because they have the same basis,
that vain dreams come, and here a great part of life is consumed. It
is here that much precious time is wasted, that is, in the morning,
when the mind is composed and rested, and the body is made fit to
begin new labours; there again many vain pleasures are enjoyed; both
taking those pleasures that are often the cause of the failing of
life. And for these reasons the reed is held as their support.
[Footnote: 676. The pen and ink drawing on PI. LIX belongs to this
passage.]
499
[Footnote: 8. tribolatione. In the drawing caltrops may be seen
lying in the old man's right hand, others are falling and others
again are shewn on the ground. Similar caltrops are drawn in MS.
"Archivio Storico Lombardo", Anno VIII part IV (Dec. 31, 1881) has
left side of the page and refer to the figure shown on PI. LXI. Next
Lines 21 and 22, which are written under it, are the only
explanation given.]
500
Evil-thinking is either Envy or Ingratitude.
677.
towards heaven, because if she could she would use her strength
against God; make her with her face covered by a mask of fair
signify that victory and truth are odious to her. Many thunderbolts
should proceed from her to signify her evil speaking. Let her be
lean and haggard because she is in perpetual torment. Make her heart
tongues serving as arrows, because she often offends with it. Give
her a leopard's skin, because this creature kills the lion out of
envy and by deceit. Give her too a vase in her hand full of flowers
and scorpions and toads and other venomous creatures; make her ride
upon death, because Envy, never dying, never tires of ruling. Make
her bridle, and load her with divers kinds of arms because all her
Toleration.
Intolerable.
501
No sooner is Virtue born than Envy comes into the world to attack
it; and sooner will there be a body without a shadow than Virtue
without Envy.
the first 21 lines of this passage. L. 22 and 23, which are written
above the space between the two drawings, do not seem to have any
678.
twelve pots like openings into hell. Here will be Death, the Furies,
colours....
679.
Saint Augustin
Saint Peter
Paul
Elisabeth
Saint Clara.
Bernardino
502
Our Lady Louis
Bonaventura
Anthony of Padua.
Saint Francis.
Francis,
[Footnote: 679. The text of the first six lines is written within a
square space of the same size as the copy here given. The names are
written in the margin following the order in which they are here
List of drawings.
680.
503
A head, full face, with curly hair,
Drawings of furnaces.
A chalcedony,
face;
A Madonna, finished,
504
Head of Our Lady ascending into Heaven,
storiche cap. XVI. His reading varies somewhat from that here
Leonardo (IV, 21, ed. MILANESI 1880) says: "Oltreché perse tempo
capo seguissi tutto il resto fino all' altro, tanto che s'empiessi
expression for those twisted ornaments which are well known through
505
centimetres by 26 1/4. The centre portion of another is given on p.
Dürer who copied them, omitting the inscription, added to the second
[Footnote: 680, 17. The meaning in which the word coppi, literally
681.
Stubborn rigour.
Doomed rigour.
506
[Footnote: See PI. LXII, No. 2, the two upper pen and ink drawings.
colour. The background is blue sky; the plough and the instrument
with the compass are reddish brown, the sun is tinted yellow].
682.
his mind.
No. 2.]
683.
684.
507
falsehood a mask.
innocence,
malignity.
darkness.
[Footnote: See PI. LXIII. L. 1-8 are in the middle of the page; 1.
9-14 to the right below; 1. 15-22 below in the middle column. The
rest of the text is below the sketches on the left. There are some
TRUTH.
508
Truth at last cannot be hidden.
to no purpose before
so great a judge.
685.
weary
of being useful.
No labour is
509
Hands into which
Naturally
686.
hand of Ingratitude.
consumes it.
687.
TO REPRESENT INGRATITUDE.
510
light which dispelled it
688.
[Footnote: See PI. LXIV. The figures of Adam and Eve in the clouds
earthly needs.]
689.
690.
which perseveres.
511
[Footnote: A drawing in red chalk, also rubbed, which stands in the
691.
692.
Prudence Strength.
693.
694.
Short liberty.
512
695.
Report.
696.
Not to disobey.
697.
again.
I am still hopeful.
A falcon,
Time.
the Carnival at Florence in 1513. See VASARI VI, 251, ed. MILANESI
698.
513
lying tongues.
699.
[Footnote: See PI. LX, No. 2. Compare this sketch with that on PI.
LXII, No. 2. Below the two lines of the text there are two more
700.
701.
Ingratitude.
[Footnote: See PI. LX, No. 4. Below the bottom sketches are the
514
702.
703.
[Footnote: The biographies say so much, and the author's notes say
artificial birds fly through the air, that the text here given is of
704.
515
odoriferous varnish, made of oil of turpentine and of varnish in
grain, with a pierced stencil, which must be wetted, that it may not
knots which afterwards may be filled up with black and the ground
251.)]
705.
Snow taken from the high peaks of mountains might be carried to hot
516
The Notebooks of Leonardo Da Vinci
Volume 2
1888
XI.
years, it is not in the nature of the case that it could have given
517
rise to much writing. We may therefore regard it as particularly
Leonardo were acquainted only with the passages numbered 712, 719,
those which treat of the casting of the monument, not merely because
A good deal of the first two passages, Nos. 710 and 711, which refer
metallo," &c. Among the drawings of models of the moulds for casting
we find only one which seems to represent the horse in the act of
galloping--No. 713. All the other designs show the horse as pacing
518
notes as to the method of casting, the question as to the position
studies for the equestrian statue, only those which represent the
Galeazza Maria Sforza was assassinated in 1476 before his scheme for
519
erecting a monument to his father Francesco Sforza could be carried
in 1480 after the minister Cecco Simonetta had been murdered. It may
that Antonio del Pollajuolo took part in it, from this passage in
the left, we see a warrior thrown and lying on the ground; precisely
monument, as on Pl. LXVI, LXVII, LXVIII, LXIX and LXXII No. 1; and,
supposing that either artist borrowed it from the other, we can only
was the Duke on a horse in full gallop, with a fallen foe under its
520
hoofs.
Leonardo may have been in the competition there and then, but the
means for executing the monument do not seem to have been at once
forthcoming. It was not perhaps until some years later that Leonardo
in a letter to the Duke (No. 719) reminded him of the project for
the monument. Then, after he had obeyed a summons to Milan, the plan
substituted for one galloping, and it may have been at the same time
that the colossal dimensions of the statue were first decided on.
The designs given on Pl. LXX, LXXI, LXXII, 2 and 3, LXXIII and LXXIV
and on pp. 4 and 24, as well as three sketches on Pl. LXIX may be
Marcus Aurelius. If, as it would seem, Leonardo had not until then
visited Rome, he might easily have known this statue from drawings
by his former master and friend Verrocchio, for Verrocchio had been
in Rome for a long time between 1470 and 1480. In 1473 Pope Sixtus
521
Leonardo, although he was painting independently as early as in 1472
Leonardo probably had the opportunity of seeing all his designs for
the equestrian statue at Venice and the red chalk drawing on Pl.
appear that Leonardo was ever at Padua before 1499, but we may
Anatomy of the Horse which Lomazzo and Vas mention; the most
522
If we may trust the account given by Paulus Jovius--about l527--
but, need we, in fact, infer from this description that the horse
difference between the work of the middle ages and that of the
renaissance.
was taken by the French in 1499, the model sustained some injury;
that Leonardo had devoted fully sixteen years to this work (la forma
had lived in Milan ever since 1483. But I believe it is nearer the
that about sixteen years must have past since the competition in
523
which Leonardo had taken part.
observe that they are all, with the following two exceptions, in the
LXXVI No. 1 is in the MS. C. A. (see No. 7l2) and the fragmentary
the engraving with the facsimiles of drawings on Pl. LXV, No. 2, Pl.
On Pl. LXV No. 1, in the larger sketch to the right hand, only the
out.
524
The base of the monument--the pedestal for the equestrian statue--is
which more
canopy. In this the trophies and the captive warriors are detached
from the angles. In the first of these two sketches the place for
chalk drawing on Pl. LXVIII shows a base in which the angles are
525
or slabs, the upper one considerably smaller than the lower one
galloping but merely walking forward, we find only one drawing for
the pedestal, and this, to accord with the altered character of the
captive warriors. Probably only No. 724 in the text refers to the
study for the very monument concerning which the manuscript gives us
526
of sculpture which is certainly not Leonardo's work. Gian Giacomo
have been done under the auspices of Francis I, but the Italian
general was certainly not in favour with the French monarch at the
short time, however, he was forced to quit Milan again when Ludovico
il Moro bore down upon the city with a force of Swiss troops. On the
527
time that Trivulzio had a medal struck with a bust portrait of
DEO FAVENTE--1499--DICTVS--10--IA--EXPVLIT--LVDOVICV--SF--
Leonardo's design.
7O6.
OF A STATUE.
528
If you wish to make a figure in marble, first make one of clay, and
when you have finished it, let it dry and place it in a case which
receive also the marble, from which you intend to reveal the figure
in imitation of the one in clay. After you have put the clay figure
into this said case, have little rods which will exactly slip in to
the holes in it, and thrust them so far in at each hole that each
white rod may touch the figure in different parts of it. And colour
the portion of the rod that remains outside black, and mark each rod
and each hole with a countersign so that each may fit into its
place. Then take the clay figure out of this case and put in your
piece of marble, taking off so much of the marble that all your rods
better able to do this, make the case so that it can be lifted up;
but the bottom of it will always remain under the marble and in this
707.
equally round in every part where these threads were wound about
them.
708.
529
MEASUREMENT AND DIVISION OF A STATUE.
Divide the head into 12 degrees, and each degree divide into 12
points, and each point into 12 minutes, and the minutes into minims
Degree--point--minute--minim.
709.
the first scheme of the Sforza Monument, in which the horse was to
when compared with paintings are given under No. 655 and 656.]
530
Notes on the casting of the Sforza monument (710-715).
710.
[If you want to make simple casts quickly, make them in a box of
[When you shall have made the mould upon the horse you must make the
hundredweight. [In casting each one keep the furnace and its fire
well stopped up.] [Let the inside of all the moulds be wetted with
powdered borax and Greek pitch with aqua vitae, and pitch the mould
over outside so that being under ground the damp may not [damage
it?]
[To manage the large mould make a model of the small mould, make a
Hold the hoofs in the tongs, and cast them with fish glue. Weigh the
531
parts of the mould and the quantity of metal it will take to fill
them, and give so much to the furnace that it may afford to each
part its amount of metal; and this you may know by weighing the clay
of each part of the mould to which the quantity in the furnace must
correspond. And this is done in order that the furnace for the legs
when filled may not have to furnish metal from the legs to help out
not diminished by the fact that they have been lightly crossed out
with red chalk. Possibly they were the first scheme for some fuller
the equestrian statue. In the original the first two sketches are
711.
Make the horse on legs of iron, strong and well set on a good
the breadth of three fingers. Now fix and bind it with iron as may
be necessary. Moreover take off the mould and then make the
532
thickness. Then fill the mould by degrees and make it good
throughout; encircle and bind it with its irons and bake it inside
Draw upon the horse, when finished, all the pieces of the mould with
which you wish to cover the horse, and in laying on the clay cut it
in every piece, so that when the mould is finished you can take it
off, and then recompose it in its former position with its joins, by
the countersigns.
The square blocks a b will be between the cover and the core, that
is in the hollow where the melted bronze is to be; and these square
blocks of bronze will support the intervals between the mould and
the cover at an equal distance, and for this reason these squares
Take wax, to return [what is not used] and to pay for what is used.
Dry it in layers.
Make the outside mould of plaster, to save time in drying and the
expense in wood; and with this plaster enclose the irons [props]
533
both outside and inside to a thickness of two fingers; make terra
cotta. And this mould can be made in one day; half a boat load of
Good.
Dam it up again with glue and clay, or white of egg, and bricks and
rubbish.
[Footnote: See Pl. LXXV. The figure "40," close to the sketch in the
collector's hand.
In the original, below line 21, a square piece of the page has been
cut out about 9 centimetres by 7 and a blank piece has been gummed
Lines 22-24 are written on the margin. l. 27 and 28 are close to the
marginal sketch and on the back of this sheet is the text given as
712.
534
[Footnote: See Pl. LXXVI, No. i. This drawing has already been
Pl. XXIV, No. i. But, for various reasons I cannot regard the
Castello."
713.
714.
Salt may be made from human excrements, burnt and calcined, made
into lees and dried slowly at a fire, and all the excrements produce
salt in a similar way and these salts when distilled, are very
strong.
535
715.
This may be done when the furnace is made [Footnote: this note is
7l6.
717.
figured measurements.]
718.
536
[Footnote: There is no sketch belonging to this passage. Galeazze
here probably means Galeazze di San Severino, the famous captain who
719.
immortal glory and eternal honour of the happy memory of the prince
[Footnote: The letter from which this passage is here extracted will
page 2).]
720.
On the 23rd of April 1490 I began this book, and recommenced the
horse.
721.
rocks, and when I was at work on the great horse for Milan, a large
537
sackful of them, which were found thereabout, was brought to me into
722.
bronze statue of the Duke Francesco that he does not need to care
about it, because he has work for all his life time, and, being so
great a work, I doubt whether he can ever finish it. [Footnote: This
723.
Of the horse I will say nothing because I know the times. [Footnote:
724.
During ten years the works on the marbles have been going on I will
not wait for my payment beyond the time, when my works are finished.
[Footnote: This possibly refers to the works for the pedestal of the
538
the MSS. See p. 6.]
725.
[2] Cost of the making and materials for the horse [5].
Vol. V, Ser. 3a, of Transunti, Reale Accademia dei Linea, sed. del
intanto che siano stampati questi pochi frammenti perche so che sono
Leonardo."
The learned editor has left out line 22 and has written 3 pie for
A courser, as large as life, with the rider requires for the cost of
539
the metal, duc. 500.
And for cost of the iron work which is inside the model, and
charcoal, and wood, and the pit to cast it in, and for binding the
200.
under the horse which is 4 braccia long, 2 braccia and 2 inches wide
And for 13 braccia and 6 inches of cornice, 7 in. wide and 4 in.
And for the frieze and architrave, which is 4 br. and 6 in. long, 2
540
And for the capitals made of metal, which are 8, 5 inches in. square
and 2 in. thick, at the price of 15 ducats each, will come to......
duc. 122.
duc. 20.
And for 8 bases which are 5 1/2 in. square and 2 in. high 5 hund'..
duc. 5.
And for the slab of the tombstone 4 br. io in. long, 2 br. 4 1/2 in.
And for 8 pedestal feet each 8 br. long and 6 1/2 in. wide and 6 1/2
And for the cornice below which is 4 br. and 10 in. long, and 2 br.
And for the stone of which the figure of the deceased is to be made
which is 3 br. and 8 in. long, and 1 br. and 6 in. wide, and 9 in.
And for the stone on which the figure lies which is 3 br. and 4 in.
long and 1 br. and 2 in., wide and 4 1/2 in. thick duc. 16.
541
And for the squares of marble placed between the pedestals which are
8 and are 9 br. long and 9 in. wide, and 3 in. thick, 8
Round the base on which the horse stands there are 8 figures at 25
And on the same base there are 8 festoons with some other ornaments,
Again, for the large cornice which goes below the base on which the
horse stands, which is 13 br. and 6 in., at 2 due. per br. ......
duc. 27.
And for 12 br. of frieze at 5 due. per br. ........... duc. 60.
And for 12 br. of architrave at 1 1/2 duc. per br. ....... duc. 18.
542
And for 8 fluted columns at 8 ducats each ......... duc. 64.
And for squaring and carving the moulding of the pedestals at 2 duc.
And for 6 square blocks with figures and trophies, at 25 duc. each
.. duc. 150.
And for carving the moulding of the stone under the figure of the
For squaring the stone on which the statue lies, and carving the
The sum total of every thing added together amount to ...... duc.
543
3046.
726.
MINT AT ROME.
It can also be made without a spring. But the screw above must
The mint of Rome.] [Footnote: See Pl. LXXVI. This passage is taken
from a note book which can be proved to have been used in Rome.]
All coins which do not have the rim complete, are not to be accepted
that, in the first place, all the coins should be a perfect circle;
and to do this a coin must before all be made perfect in weight, and
the same size and thickness, all drawn through the same gauge so as
to come out in strips. And out of [24] these strips you will stamp
the coins, quite round, as sieves are made for sorting chestnuts
[27]; and these coins can then be stamped in the way indicated
above; &c.
[31] The hollow of the die must be uniformly wider than the lower,
544
This cuts the coins perfectly round and of the exact thickness, and
weight; and saves the man who cuts and weighs, and the man who makes
the coins round. Hence it passes only through the hands of the
gauger and of the stamper, and the coins are very superior.
[Footnote: See Pl. LXXVI No. 2. The text of lines 31-35 stands
parallel 1. 24-27.
under Pope Leo X. may be gathered from some rough copies of letters
which will be found in this volume. Hitherto nothing has been known
statements in Vasari.]
727.
tin and all the metals, alum, isinglass, smoke from a brass forge,
728.
545
OF TAKING CASTS OF MEDALS.
powdered.
hammer and several times extended; the lead is folded and kept
melt the lead, and the powder will be on the top of the melted lead,
times doubled, and hit it sideways with the hammer, when it will
break up; then mix it little by little and it can be founded with
ease; but if you hold it on the anvil you will never break it, when
it is large.
with a cone shaped grinder; then put it in aqua fortis, which melts
away the steel that may have been worked up and mixed with the
546
smalt, and which makes it black; it then remains purified and clean;
and if you grind it on porphyry the porphyry will work up and mix
with the smalt and spoil it, and aqua fortis will never remove it
If you want a fine blue colour dissolve the smalt made with tartar,
729.
STUCCO.
of Venus and Mercury, and lay it well over that prominence of the
thickness of the side of a knife, made with the ruler and cover this
with the bell of a still, and you will have again the moisture with
which you applied the paste. The rest you may dry [Margin note: On
stucco (729. 730).] [Footnote: In this passage a few words have been
547
stucco is composed.
STUCCO.
Powder ... with borax and water to a paste, and make stucco of it,
and then heat it so that it may dry, and then varnish it, with fire,
730.
when put with these 2 things melted, will make them as firm as wax
or modelling clay.
GLUE.
548
731.
TO CAST.
Tartar burnt and powdered with plaster and cast cause the plaster to
in water.
732.
733.
When you want to take a cast in wax, burn the scum with a candle,
734.
549
[Footnote: The second part of this is quite obscure.]
735.
[Dried earth 16 pounds, 100 pounds of metal wet clay 20,--of wet
736.
737.
Make a bunch of iron wire as thick as thread, and scrub them with
[this and] water; hold a bowl underneath that it may not make a mud
below.
Make an iron rod, after the manner of a large chisel, and with this
rub over those seams on the bronze which remain on the casts of the
550
guns, and which are caused by the joins in the mould; but make the
tool heavy enough, and let the strokes be long and broad.
TO FACILITATE MELTING.
First alloy part of the metal in the crucible, then put it in the
large chisels.
two furnaces and with 2000 pounds in each, or as much as 3000 pounds
at most.
738.
551
If you want to break up a large mass of bronze, first suspend it,
and then make round it a wall on the four sides, like a trough of
bricks, and make a great fire therein. When it is quite red hot give
it a blow with a heavy weight raised above it, and with great force.
739.
If you wish for economy in combining lead with the metal in order to
alloy the lead with the tin and then add the molten copper.
The coating should not be more than two fingers thick, it should be
laid on in four thicknesses over fine clay and then well fixed, and
552
The gun being made to carry 600 Ibs. of ball and more, by this rule
you will take the measure of the diameter of the ball and divide it
into 6 parts and one of these parts will be its thickness at the
muzzle; but at the breech it must always be half. And if the ball is
diameter in front; and if 900, 1/8th and 1/2 [3/16], and if 1000,
1/9th.
If you want it to throw a ball of stone, make the length of the gun
the mouth fitted to receive 600 lbs. of stone ball, and more.
one third of the diameter of the ball, and the length from 30 to 36
balls.
740.
553
The furnace must be luted before you put the metal in it, with earth
When you see that the bronze is congealing take some willow-wood cut
I say that the cause of this congealing often proceeds from too much
You may know when the fire is good and fit for your purpose by a
clear flame, and if you see the tips of the flames dull and ending
in much smoke do not trust it, and particularly when the flux metal
is almost fluid.
554
Metal for guns must invariably be made with 6 or even 8 per cent,
that is 6 of tin to one hundred of copper, for the less you put in,
The tin should be put in with the copper when the copper is reduced
to a fluid.
You can hasten the melting when 2/3ds of the copper is fluid; you
Until now very little has been known regarding Leonardo's labours
555
lately been confirmed by the publication of certain documents,
preparing plans but that he took an active part, with much credit,
other, that we can form any just estimate of their true worth.
questions, which are given in this work; that he was merely working
interest.
556
A great number of important buildings were constructed in Lombardy
during the period between 1472 and 1499, and among them there are
erection.
557
accompany the sketches. It is to Dr Richter's exertions that we owe
the original texts, he has also made it his task to extract the
whole of the materials from the various MSS. It has been my task to
arrange and elucidate the texts under the heads which have been
has been aimed at, and no efforts have been spared to include every
on Architecture.
558
I. Those drawings and sketches, often accompanied by short remarks
explanatory texts.
HENRY DE GEYMULLER
XII.
Architectural Designs.
A. Sketches for laying out a new town with a double system of high-
Pl. LXXVII, No. 1 (MS. B, 15b). A general view of a town, with the
559
Pl. LXXVII, No. 3 (MS. B, 16b. see No. 741; and MS. B. 15b, see No.
742) gives a partial view of the town, with its streets and houses,
Pl. LXXVII, No. 2 (MS. B, 15b; see No. 743). View of a double
B. Notes on removing houses (MS. Br. M., 270b, see No. 744).
741.
The roads m are 6 braccia higher than the roads p s, and each
road must be 20 braccia wide and have 1/2 braccio slope from the
sides towards the middle; and in the middle let there be at every
braccio an opening, one braccio long and one finger wide, where the
rain water may run off into hollows made on the same level as p s.
And on each side at the extremity of the width of the said road let
he who would go through the whole place by the high level streets
can use them for this purpose, and he who would go by the low level
can do the same. By the high streets no vehicles and similar objects
should circulate, but they are exclusively for the use of gentlemen.
560
The carts and burdens for the use and convenience of the inhabitants
have to go by the low ones. One house must turn its back to the
wood, wine and such things are carried in by the doors n, and
742.
must be 300 braccia, each street receiving its light through the
always fouled; they must be wide, and at the first vault there must
be a door entering into public privies and the said stairs lead from
the upper to the lower streets and the high level streets begin
outside the city gates and slope up till at these gates they have
attained the height of 6 braccia. Let such a city be built near the
sea or a large river in order that the dirt of the city may be
743.
744.
561
ON MOVING HOUSES.
Let the houses be moved and arranged in order; and this will be done
with facility because such houses are at first made in pieces on the
open places, and can then be fitted together with their timbers in
[9] Let the men of the country [or the village] partly inhabit the
the "(Lo)cra" (both are given in the text farther on). There can
hardly be a doubt that the last sentence of the passage given above,
right hand side of the page by the side of lines 1-8. The three
Pl. LXXIX, 1. and 2, (MS. B, 37b, see No. 745, and MS. B. 36a, see
No. 746). A Plan for streets and canals inside a town, by which the
562
The third text given under No. 747 refers to works executed by
Leonardo in France.
745.
diverted into canals in which the level of the water will not vary
and make choice of a fine river, which the rains do not render
muddy, such as the Ticino, the Adda and many others. [Footnote 12:
Tesino, Adda e molti altri, i.e. rivers coming from the mountains
way within, in order that the enemy may not destroy it [14].
[Footnote: L. 1-4 are on the left hand side and within the sketch
given on Pl. LXXIX, No. I. Then follows after line 14, the drawing
below it. On the page 38a, which comes next in the original MS. is
563
the sketch of an oval plan of a town over which is written "modo di
canal. J. P. R.]
746.
Let the width of the streets be equal to the average height of the
houses.
747.
The main underground channel does not receive turbid water, but that
water runs in the ditches outside the town with four mills at the
entrance and four at the outlet; and this may be done by damming the
passage given as No. 744. The remainder of the writing on the same
"Topographical Notes".
Lines 1-11 are written to the right of the plan lines 11-13
564
[Footnote 10: Romolontino is Romorantin, South of Orleans in
France.]
A. Castles.
Pl. LXXX, No. 1 (P. V. fol. 39b; No. d'ordre 2282). The fortified
Milan, but without any satisfactory reason. The high tower behind
Pl. LXXX, No. 3 (MS. B). Sketches for corner towers with steps for a
citadel.
reversed.
565
Pl. LXXXI, No. 2 (MS. C. A, 75b; 221a, see No. 748). Project for a
Pl. LXXXII, No. 1 (C. A 308a; 939a). A plan for a somewhat extensive
arch mo nino
Pl. LXXXIII (W. XVII). The text on this sheet refers to Cyprus (see
Pl. LXXXVIII, Nos. 6 and 7 (MS. B, 12a; see No. 751). A section of a
the text written below mentions the Duke and Duchess of Milan.
566
The sketch of a villa on a terrace at the end of a garden occurs in
view.
748.
to many persons, and above all let every wall, be it ever so thin,
Let all the privies have ventilation [by shafts] in the thickness of
567
The mezzanines should be vaulted, and the vaults will be stronger in
of the castle is a large basin for aquatic sports with the words
The privies must be numerous and going one into the other in order
that the stench may not penetrate into the dwellings., and all their
The main division of the facade of this palace is into two portions;
that is to say the width of the court-yard must be half the whole
749.
568
30 braccia wide on each side; the lower entrance leads into a hall
chimney.
[Footnote: On each side of the castle, Pl. LXXXII. No. 2 there are
750.
751.
569
e sotto la pianta: Fondamento del padiglione ch'e nel mezzo del
The original text however hardly bears the interpretation put upon
Leonardo was the architect who carried out the construction of the
the Pavilion drawn by the side of it. Must we, in fact, suppose that
assumed, Ludovico il Moro? He did not hold this title from the
Emperor before 1494; till that date he was only called Governatore
2nd January 1497, and for the reasons I have given it seems
appears to me to be beyond all doubt that the MS. B, from which this
passage is taken, is older than the dated MSS. of 1492 and 1493. In
570
that case the Duke of Milan here mentioned would be Gian Galeazzo
752.
The earth that is dug out from the cellars must be raised on one
hall; but between the earth of the terrace and the wall of the
house, leave an interval in order that the damp may not spoil the
principal walls.
A. General Observations.
753.
may be seen.
754.
571
Here there cannot and ought not to be any campanile; on the
contrary it must stand apart like that of the Cathedral and of San
church, make the lantern serve for the campanile as in the church at
Chiaravalle.
[Footnote: This text is written by the side of the plan given on Pl.
[Footnote 12: The Abbey of Chiaravalle, a few miles from Milan, has
755.
It never looks well to see the roofs of a church; they should rather
be flat and the water should run off by gutters made in the frieze.
572
B. The theory of Dome Architecture.
drawings than in writing. Still we may fairly assume that it was his
churches with one or more domes--from the simplest form to the most
they were not designed for any particular monument, but were
great central dome, with smaller ones grouped round it; and with or
573
not quite satisfactory; still they cannot be considered to give
produce the greatest effect possible, should rise either from the
being at the same time the centre of the whole plan of the building.
cross, and when this is met with, it generally gives evidence of the
574
Besides the theoretical interest of the question for Leonardo and
his Trattato and besides the taste for domes prevailing at that
the first importance like the Duomos of Pavia and Como, the church
Bramante for ten years or more, can hardly have remained without
indirect even on a genius like Leonardo seems the more likely, since
The church of San Lorenzo at Milan, was at that time still intact.
The dome is to this day one of the most wonderful cupolas ever
constructed, and with its two smaller domes might well attract the
575
the church of S. Lorenzo, and this also seems to have suggested the
view. On two sheets: Pl. LXXXIV (C.A. 354b; 118a) and Pl. LXXXV,
Nos. 1-11 (Ash. II, 6b) we see various dissimilar types, grouped
treat.
Group I.
colonnade.
576
Pl. LXXXVI, No. 1, 2, 3. Four round chapels are added at the
octagonal.
Group II.
to be octagonal.
Pl. LXXXIV. The square plan below the circular building No. 8, and
its elevation to the left, above the plan: here the ground-plan is
Pl, LXXXV, No. 4, and p. 45, Fig. 3, a Greek cross, repeated p. 45,
first the dome rises from a square plan,--in the second from an
octagonal base.
577
Group III.
Domes rising from a square base and four pillars. [Footnote 1: The
this type.]
the first type; columns are placed between the apses and the aisles;
Lorenzo at Milan.
578
adapted to a peculiar purpose about which we shall have to say a few
Pl. XCV, No. 1, shows the same plan but with the addition of a short
the four outer angles to the last named plan, we obtain a plan which
Rome. [Footnote 2: See Les projets primitifs etc., Pl. 9-12.] (See
p. 51 Fig. 1.)
Group IV.
principal axes being different in form from those which are added on
579
a. First Class.
this group; and, indeed it probably suggested it. The fact that we
Spirito in the same town and also in the above named chapel by
Brunellesco.
have been suggested by the plan given on page 44 Fig. 2 (MS. B, 55a)
a) (MS. B, 34b, page 44 Fig. 3). In the middle of each side a column
of columns forms an aisle round the octagon. These are placed at the
580
intersection of a system of semicircles, of which the sixteen
c) (MS. B. 96b, see p. 45 Fig. 2). Octagon with an aisle round it;
the angles of both are formed by columns. The outer sides are formed
chapels.
the chapels of the aisle have the same width of opening as the inner
The simplest type shows a niche in the middle of each side and is
repeated on several sheets, viz: MS. B 3; MS. C.A. 354b (see Pl.
LXXXIV, No. 11) and MS. Ash II 6b; (see Pl. LXXXV, No. 9 and the
581
elevations No. 8; Pl. XCII, No. 3; MS. B. 4b [not reproduced here]
Pl. XCII, 3 (MS. B, 56b) corresponds to a plan like the one in MS.
chapel.
A. by a square chapel:
C. by octagonal chapels:
582
"quest'e come le 8 cappele ano a essere facte" (this is how the
d) Pl. LXXXVIII, No. 1. Inside of the same octagon. MS. B, 30a, and
34b; these are three repetitions of parts of the same plan with very
slight variations.
D. by a circular chapel:
MS. B, 18a (see Fig. 1 on page 47) gives the plan of this
sketch.
would also produce a good effect if only the part above the lines a
b, c d, were executed").
583
Pl. LXXXIV, No. 11. The exterior has the form of an octagon, but the
chapels project partly beyond it. On the left side of the sketch
Pl. XC, No. 1, (MS. B, 25b); Repetition of Pl. LXXXIV, No. 11.
Pl. XC, No. 2. Elevation to the plan No. 1, and also to No. 6 of the
same sheet.
Pl. LXXXIV, No. 7 (the circular plan on the left below) shows this
arrangement in which the central dome has become circular inside and
and some others of this class remind us of the plan of the Mausoleum
6, 82.]
The sketch on the right hand side gives most likely the elevation
584
Pl. XCI, No. 2 (MS. Ash. 11. 8b) [Footnote 2: The note accompanying
this plan is given under No. 754.]; on this plan the chapels
b. Second Class.
two types of the first class--the one worked out on the principal
the diagonal axes, but with the dimensions of the squares on the two
colonnade; round chapels are placed against the four sides of the
principal axes.
The elevation, drawn on the same sheet (see page 47 Fig. 3), shows
585
the whole arrangement which is closely related with the one on Pl.
LXXXVI No. 1, 2.
in the principal axes of the sketch MS. B. l8a by square ones, with
Pl. LXXXIX (MS. B. 17b). Elevation for the preceding figure. The
bearing the same mark, and of the elevation on Pl. LXXXIX below
these studies.
Pl. LXXXIV No. 12 shows the design Pl. LXXXVII No. 3 combined with
586
Pl. LXXXIV No. 13 is a variation of the preceding sketch.
Pl. XC No. 3. MS. B. 25b. The round chapels of the preceding sketch
Pl. XCII No. 1. (MS. B. 39b.); the plan below. On the principal as
well as on the diagonal axes are diagonal chapels, but the latter
Pl. LXXXIV No. 3. On the principal axes are square chapels with
by square chapels with three niches; on the principal axes are inner
The plan Pl. XCIII No. 2 (MS. B. 22) differs from this only in so
587
far as the outer semicircles have become circular chapels,
already seen in Pl. XCI No. 2; the exterior presents two varieties.
b) It is semicircular.
Pl. LXXXVII No. 2 (MS. B. 18b) Elevation to the first variation MS.
MS. P. V. 39b. In the principal axes the chapels of MS. B. 19, and
588
Group V.
that of San Lorenzo. The diagonal sides of the irregular octagon are
not indicated.
Martimo Bassi, then this plan and the following section would be
the above-named plan. The recessed chapels are decorated with large
presso S. Satiro.
On the same sheet there is a plan similar to the one above-named but
the axes (compare Pl. XCVII No. 3 and page 44 Fig. 1), perhaps a
589
reminiscence of the two chapels annexed to San Lorenzo.--Leonardo
has here sketched the way of transforming this plan into a Latin
Pl. XCI No. 1. Plan showing a type deprived of aisles and comprised
756.
Sepolcro, and it is the same above as below, except that the upper
story has the dome c d; and the [Footnote: The church of San
middle of the XVIth century, still stands over the crypt of the
original structure.] lower has the dome a b, and when you enter
into the crypt, you descend 10 steps, and when you mount into the
upper you ascend 20 steps, which, with 1/3 braccio for each, make 10
braccia, and this is the height between one floor of the church and
the other.
Above the plan on the same sheet is a view of the exterior. By the
left side of the building seems not to be in keeping with the same
590
"dentro il difitio di sopra" (interior of the edifice
plan--it rises from the lower church into the upper-- above, and
larger, rises the dome c d. The aisles above and below thus
difference is, that in the section Leonardo has not taken the
trouble to make the form octagonal, but has merely sketched circular
seems already indicated by the diagonal lines in the plans Pl. LXXXV
No. 11 and No. 7. We shall find another application of the same type
the plan of the Latin cross; we shall begin by describing them, and
591
Pl. XCV No. 2. Plan accompanied by the words: "A e santo sepolcro
same in plan.
The second plan with its note: "B e la sua parte socto tera" (B is
visiting the crypt with this plan. Excepting the addition of a few
two columns near the entrance of the winding stairs are absent.
B. Designs or Studies.
principle of the second type of Group III. Leonardo has placed the
Pl. XCVI No. 2. In the plan the dome, as regards its interior,
belongs to the First Class of Group IV, and may be grouped with the
592
XLIII.].
757.
campaniles, and in going up one has to use the platform, where the
drums of the four domes are, and this platform has a parapet in
front, and none of these domes communicate with the church, but they
seen from behind; this recalls the Duomo at Florence, but with two
21st, 1490 as to this church; the fact that the only word
593
years after the beginning of the Cathedral, which at that time was
Pl. XCVII No. 2 shows the exterior of this design. Below is the
Here we may also mention the plan of a Latin cross drawn in MS. C.
Pl. XCIV No. 4 (V. A. V, 1). Principal front of a nave, most likely
style, such as we are accustomed to meet with only after the year
1520.
594
apparently a dome in the centre of four corinthian porticos bearing
sketches, clearly shows which plan seemed to him most favourable for
Pl. XCVII, No. 1 (MS. B, 52). Rectangular edifice divided into three
the centre. Leonardo has written on the left side of the sketch:
MS. B, 55a (see page 56, Fig. 1). A domed church after the type of
Pl. XCV, No. 1, shows four theatres occupying the apses and facing
the square "coro" (choir), which is in the centre between the four
595
above. At the place marked B Leonardo wrote teatri per uldire
(choir).
In MS. C.A. 260, are slight sketches of two plans for rectangular
choirs and two elevations of the altar and pulpit which seem to be
In MS. Ash II, 8a (see p. 56 and 57. Fig. 2 and 3). "Locho dove si
amphitheatres.
intended for the edifice, it would have comprised only about two
word he often employed for plans, and on the left side of the view
in).]
596
Pl. XCVIII (P. V., 182. No. d'ordre 2386). In the midst of a hilly
opening, like that in the Pantheon, is in the dome above what may be
terrace below.
feet.
597
The construction of the vaults resembles those in the galleries of
Mycenae.
The upper cone displays not only analogies with the monuments
mentioned in the note, but also with Etruscan tumuli, such as the
Architecture.
design. They are known to have served as the Mausolea of the Kings
598
Chretienne par M. J. DE LAURIERE, Tours l874.--Le tombeau de la
the coast of Africa are given later in this work. The Herodium near
Towards the end of the fifteenth century the Fabbricceria del Duomo
had to settle on the choice of a model for the crowning and central
tell us more about the part taken by Leonardo, than has hitherto
been known.] that among the artists who presented models in the year
599
1488 were: Bramante, Pietro da Gorgonzola, Luca Paperio (Fancelli),
Pl. XCIX, No. 2 (MS. S. K. III, No. 36a) a small plan of the whole
Pl. C, No. 2 (Tr. 21). Plan of the octagon tower, giving the
adjoining the four principal piers and intended to support the eight
600
MS. B, 3--three slight sketches of plans in connexion with the
preceding ones.
Pl. XCIX, No.1 (MS. Tr. 15) contains several small sketches of
notes:
758.
The inverted arch is better for giving a shoulder than the ordinary
weakness, whilst the latter finds in its weak part nothing but air.
the large drawing in the centre of Pl. C, No. 4 (M.S, Tr. 41) which
bring the weight of the lantern to bear on the base of the dome.
601
which part of its summit is to bear the weight: "il pilastro sara
Another note is above on the right side: Larcho regiera tanto sotto
neighbours. Thus the inside of the Dome cannot be seen from below.
slight modifications.]
MS. Tr. 9 (see Fig. 1 and 2). Section of the Dome with reverted
PI. XCIX, No. 3 (C. A., 262a) four sketches of the exterior of the
Dome.
602
It deserves to be noticed how easily and apparently without effort,
The following notes are on the same leaf, oni cosa poderosa, and
Bossi hazarded the theory that Leonardo might have been the
architect who built the church of Sta. Maria delle Grazie, but there
given at the side shows the arrangement of the second and third
that those sketches, in MS. S. K. M. II2, 2a and Ib, occur with the
603
F. The Project for lifting up the Battistero of Florence and
setting it on a basement.
604
promptement repare (Muratori, Scriptores rer. ital. Tom. XVIII, col.
transport avec une rare simplicite. D'apres cette note, on voit que
In the MS. C. A. fol. 293, there are two sketches which possibly
steps and of the new platform. In the perspective elevation the same
the ordinary position, but so placed that the inverted arches above
winding up, such as jacks, and a rack and wheel. As the lifting
605
applicable to an undertaking of such magnitude, we may consider it
759.
Twelve flights of steps led up to the great temple, which was eight
the eight corners were eight large plinths, one braccia and a half
high, and three wide, and six long at the bottom, with an angle in
top of these were eight capitals three braccia long and six wide,
above which were the architrave frieze and cornice, four braccia and
a half high, and this was carried on in a straight line from one
pillar to the next and so, continuing for eight hundred braccia,
entablature there were ten large columns of the same height as the
pillars, three braccia thick above their bases which were one
The ascent to this temple was by twelve flights of steps, and the
rose a large pillar; and between the pillars were placed ten columns
of the same height as the pillars, rising at once from the pavement
606
to a height of twenty eight braccia and a half; and at this height
the architrave, frieze and cornice were placed which surrounded the
and within the temple at the same level, and all round the centre of
same height as the former ones, and over these the continuous
V. Palace architecture.
607
Silvestri, and a painting by Montorfano in San Pietro in Gessate at
Milan, third chapel on the left hand side and also with Bramante's
Pl. LXXXI No. 1 (MS. Tr. 42). Sketch of a palace with battlements
riferisse alla cupola della chiesa delle Grazie tanto piu che a
si vede nella parte esterna del coro di quella chiesa." This may
MS. Mz. 0", contains a design for a palace or house with a loggia
in the middle of the first story, over which rises an attic with a
608
Pl. LXXXV No. 14 (MS. S. K. M. Ill 79a) contains a very slight
house, on which Leonardo notes; casa con tre terrazi (house with
three terraces).
760.
In the courtyard the walls must be half the height of its width,
609
that is if the court be 40 braccia, the house must be 20 high as
regards the walls of the said courtyard; and this courtyard must be
[Footnote: See Pl. CI, no. 1, and compare the dimensions here given,
with No. 748 lines 26-29; and the drawing belonging to it Pl. LXXXI,
no. 2.]
761.
The manner in which one must arrange a stable. You must first divide
its width in 3 parts, its depth matters not; and let these 3
divisions be equal and 6 braccia broad for each part and 10 high,
and the middle part shall be for the use of the stablemasters; the 2
side ones for the horses, each of which must be 6 braccia in width
contrary to the general custom, clean and neat: as to the upper part
of the stable, i. e. where the hay is, that part must have at its
610
simple means the hay is brought up to the loft, as is shown by the
are on either side of this, are again divided; those nearest to the
hay-loft are 4 braccia, p s, and only for the use and circulation
of the servants belonging to the stable; the other two which reach
funnels, narrow at the top and wide over the manger, in order that
the hay should not choke them. They must be well plastered and clean
the troughs must be of stone and above them [cisterns of] water. The
762.
The way in which the poles ought to be placed for tying bunches of
the vaulting and tie the bunches on with osier withes, so as to clip
611
Let the distance from one circle to another be half a braccia; and
the juniper [sprigs] must lie top downwards, beginning from below.
Round this column tie four poles to which willows about as thick as
a finger must be nailed and then begin from the bottom and work
upside down. [Footnote: See Pl. CII, No. 3. The words here given as
the title line, lines 1--4, are the last in the original MS.--Lines
763.
the original is a pen and ink drawing on blue paper; on Pl. CIII
612
MS. S. K. M. Ill, 47b (see Fig. 1). A diagram, indicating the rules
MS. S. K. M. Ill 55a (see Fig. 2). Diagram showing the same rules.
764.
3B orbiculo . . . . . . . . troclea
6B latastro . . . . . . . . plintho
Plinthus (pi lambda Xiv) but Vitruvius adopted this Greek name
613
indicates the abacus of a Doric capital.]
765.
STEPS OF URRBINO.
which the plinth is built. [Footnote: See Pl. CX No. 3. The hasty
766.
The ancient architects ...... beginning with the Egyptians (?) who,
large cities and castles, public and private buildings of fine form,
The column, which has its thickness at the third part .... The one
which would be thinnest in the middle, would break ...; the one
edifice. The second best as to the usefulness will be the one whose
614
here reproduced by a wood cut, stands in the original close to lines
5--8.]
The capital must be formed in this way. Divide its thickness at the
top into 8; at the foot make it 5/7, and let it be 5/7 high and you
will have a square; afterwards divide the height into 8 parts as you
did for the column, and then take 1/8 for the echinus and another
eighth for the thickness of the abacus on the top of the capital.
The horns of the abacus of the capital have to project beyond the
starting from the summit of the column and ending at its base and
their direction and length ..., their distance apart or width may be
767.
The cylinder of a body columnar in shape and its two opposite ends
are two circles enclosed between parallel lines, and through the
615
[Footnote: Leonardo wrote these lines on the margin of a page of the
sketch of a capital.]
768.
abacus is 3/9 the ovolo 4/9, the bead-moulding and the fillet 2/9
and 1/2.
[Footnote: See Pl. LXXXV, No. 16. In the original the drawing and
del capitelo deono essere la quarta parte d'uno quadro (The horns
windows.
In MS. C. A. 308a; 938a (see Pl. LXXXII No. 1) there are several
616
same columns appear in the sketch underneath the plan of a castle.
There they appear coupled, and in two stories one above the other.
The archivolls which seem to spring out of the columns, are shaped
we may suppose that Leonardo here had in mind either some festive
769.
piece, if those pieces are placed with their length in the direction
of the centre of the world. This is proved because stones have their
617
The Proportions of the stories of a building are indicated by a
sketch in MS. S. K. M. II2 11b (see Pl. LXXXV No. 15). The measures
Pl. LXXXV No. 13 (MS. B. 62a) and Pl. XCIII No. 1. (MS. B. 15a) give
XIII.
doubt that he himself did not complete them. It would seem that
periods, were noted down with a more or less definite aim and
purpose. They might all be collected under the one title: "Studies
618
Leonardo carefully avoids all abstract argument. His data are not
Though the conclusions drawn from his investigations may not have
any rate his deep sagacity and wonderfully clear mind. No one
I do not assert that the arrangement here adopted for the passages
in the place where they occur. But the comparatively small amount of
classification.
The small number of chapters given under the fifth class, treating
619
number of drawings and studies which refer to the same subject. Only
I.
ON FISSURES IN WALLS.
770.
First write the treatise on the causes of the giving way of walls
and as the strata are not continuous down to the bottom of the
valley, the rocks slide in the direction of the slope, and the
motion does not cease till they have reached the bottom of the
building which is separated by them from the rest. The remedy for
slipping, with arches from one to another, and with a good scarp and
let the piers have a firm foundation in the strata so that they may
620
In order to find the solid part of these strata, it is necessary to
make a shaft at the foot of the wall of great depth through the
strata; and in this shaft, on the side from which the hill slopes,
smooth and flatten a space one palm wide from the top to the bottom;
and after some time this smooth portion made on the side of the
771.
The cracks in walls will never be parallel unless the part of the
wall that separates from the remainder does not slip down.
two former cases. That is to say that the walls must be all built up
and the whole thickness at once, whatever kind of walls they may be.
And although a thin wall dries more quickly than a thick one it will
not necessarily give way under the added weight day by day and thus,
[16] although a thin wall dries more quickly than a thick one, it
will not give way under the weight which the latter may acquire from
day to day. Because if double the amount of it dries in one day, one
621
of double the thickness will dry in two days or thereabouts; thus
The part of the wall which does not slip is that in which the
obliquity projects and overhangs the portion which has parted from
OF RUIN.
When the crevice in the wall is wider at the top than at the bottom,
[Footnote: Lines 1-5 refer to Pl. CV, No. 2. Line 9 alle due
622
any case very obscure.
Lines 19-23 are on the right hand margin close to the two sketches
772.
That wall which does not dry uniformly in an equal time, always
cracks.
A wall though of equal thickness will not dry with equal quickness
one side of a wall were in contact with a damp slope and the other
were in contact with the air, then this latter side would remain of
the same size as before; that side which dries in the air will
shrink or diminish and the side which is kept damp will not dry. And
the dry portion will break away readily from the damp portion
because the damp part not shrinking in the same proportion does not
cohere and follow the movement of the part which dries continuously.
623
Arched cracks, wide at the top and narrow below are found in
width, and as the joints of the mortar are more numerous in the
Any crack made in a concave wall is wide below and narrow at the
figure.
imbibes.
Pl. CVI to the left. L. 36-40 are written inside the sketch No. 2.
L. 41-46 are partly written over the sketch No. 3 to which they
refer.]
773.
624
OF THE CAUSES OF FISSURES IN [THE WALLS OF] PUBLIC AND PRIVATE
BUILDINGS.
The walls give way in cracks, some of which are more or less
vertical and others are oblique. The cracks which are in a vertical
direction are caused by the joining of new walls, with old walls,
wall; for, as these indentations cannot bear the too great weight of
and give way to the settling of the new wall, which will shrink one
and whether this mortar is more or less liquid. And observe, that
the walls should always be built first and then faced with the
stones intended to face them. For, if you do not proceed thus, since
the wall settles more than the stone facing, the projections left on
the sides of the wall must inevitably give way; because the stones
used for facing the wall being larger than those over which they are
laid, they will necessarily have less mortar laid between the
joints, and consequently they settle less; and this cannot happen if
a b the new wall, c the old wall, which has already settled; and
on the old wall. But only the remainder b of the new wall will
625
break away, because it is built from top to bottom of the building;
and the remainder of the new wall will overhang the gap above the
774.
775.
Stones laid in regular courses from bottom to top and built up with
By what is said above it is proved that the small extent of the new
the extent of the same wall between c and d. The proportion will
[Footnote: See Pl. CV, No. 1. The top of the tower is wanting in
original, stands above the letter A over the top of the tower,
626
while c stands perpendicularly over d.]
776.
This wall will break under the arch e f, because the seven whole
square bricks are not sufficient to sustain the spring of the arch
placed on them. And these seven bricks will give way in their middle
above it only the weight a k, whilst the last brick under the arch
II.
ON FISSURES IN NICHES.
777.
ON FISSURES IN NICHES.
opposite thirds of its curve will give way at five points of the
627
curve. To prove this let the weights be at n m which will break
it follows, by the 5th, that the arch will give way at the point
which is furthest from the two forces acting on them and that is the
b; hence the weights n m must sink, but they cannot sink by the
7th, without coming closer together, and they cannot come together
unless the extremities of the arch between them come closer, and if
these draw together the crown of the arch must break; and thus the
arch will give way in two places as was at first said &c.
778.
into the soil in which foundations are built more than the lighter
settled, and this the piers n and m have not yet done. Hence the
628
is thrown outwards obliquely, and it cannot on the contrary be
thrown inwards, because a portion like this, separated from the main
wall, is larger outside than inside and the main wall, where it is
broken, is of the same shape and is also larger outside than inside;
disunited from the main wall will be thrust outwards, and not
weight the vault will give way, forming a crack which diminishes
towards the top and is wide below, narrow on the inner side and wide
the direction of its length, that part of the joints will open most,
which is most distant from the cause of the pressure; and for that
reason the arches of the vaults of any apse should never be more
loaded than the arches of the principal building. Because that which
weighs most, presses most on the parts below, and they sink into the
said apses.
629
refers to line 22. The drawing fig. 6 is, in the original, over line
Which of these two cubes will shrink the more uniformly: the cube
when both cubes are equal in weight and bulk, and of clay mixed with
breadth, which the cube above, hanging in the air, cannot do. Thus
The final result of the two cylinders of damp clay that is a and
mixed with a great deal of water will sink by its weight, which
III.
779.
630
WHAT IS AN ARCH?
each of which being very weak in itself tends to fall; but as each
the thrust is equal from both sides; and if one of the segments
weighs more than the other the stability is lost, because the
necessary to load them equally, or you will fall into the same
defect as before.
An arch breaks at the part which lies below half way from the
centre.
631
SECOND RUPTURE OF THE ARCH.
The arch will likewise give way under a transversal thrust, for when
the charge is not thrown directly on the foot of the arch, the arch
780.
The way to give stability to the arch is to fill the spandrils with
632
CROWN.
THE FLANKS.
and will do little harm to its abutments, and its places of giving
way are o p.
781.
sideways or upright.
The arch will not break if the chord of the outer arch does not
633
inner arch x b y the arch will be weak, and it will be weaker in
proportion as the inner arch passes beyond that chord. When an arch
is loaded only on one side the thrust will press on the top of the
side; and it will break at a point half way between its two
782.
A continuous body which has been forcibly bent into an arch, thrusts
783.
784.
I here ask what weight will be needed to counterpoise and resist the
[Footnote: The two lower sketches are taken from the MS. S. K. M.
634
785.
rests. This is proved by the 2nd "of supports" which says: that part
middle of its true foundation and the same being the case at the
opposite extremities of the arch which are the points farthest from
extremes.
The adversary says that this arch must be more than half a circle,
and that then it will not need a tie, because then the ends will not
device, for three reasons. The first refers to the strength of the
635
arch, since it is proved that the circular parallel being composed
than between the plane of the walls; the third reason is that the
in proportion as the piers of the arch are wider than the space
turn outwards, the piers are weaker to support the arch above them.
The 5th is that all the material and weight of the arch which are in
here it is to be noted that the weight placed above the arch will be
excess begins that is added to the semicircle, than if the pier were
arch].
AN ARCH LOADED OVER THE CROWN WILL GIVE WAY AT THE LEFT HAND
AND
This is proved by the 7th of this which says: The opposite ends of
equal strength [throughout] that portion will give way soonest which
636
is farthest from its attachment; whence it follows that d being
If the centering of the arch does not settle as the arch settles,
the mortar, as it dries, will shrink and detach itself from the
thus leaves them disjoined the vault will remain loosely built, and
786.
That part of the arch which is nearer to the horizontal offers least
each 1/2 circle that is a s and in the same way z m, the reason
f.
637
because the weight tends to fall past the point r.--And if,
against its nature it should tend to fall towards the point s the
tend to fall in the line n m, the arch would break in the middle
of the arch e m, otherwise it will break at one third from the top
The arch which is doubled to four times of its thickness will bear
four times the weight that the single arch could carry, and more in
times into its length. That is to say that if the thickness of the
single arch goes ten times into its length, the thickness of the
doubled arch will go five times into its length. Hence as the
thickness of the double arch goes only half as many times into its
double arch has 4 times the thickness of the single arch, it would
seem that it ought to bear 4 times the weight; but by the above rule
638
THAT PIER, WHICH is CHARGED MOST UNEQUALLY, WILL SOONEST GIVE
WAY.
The column c b, being charged with an equal weight, [on each side]
will be most durable, and the other two outward columns require on
of their centre, that is, from the centre of the column, towards the
Arches which depend on chains for their support will not be very
durable.
The arch itself tends to fall. If the arch be 30 braccia and the
cannot pass through the 20 unless 20 becomes likewise 30. Hence the
arch being crushed by the excess of weight, and the walls offering
insufficient resistance, part, and afford room between them, for the
But if you do not wish to strengthen the arch with an iron tie you
must give it such abutments as can resist the thrust; and you can do
this thus: fill up the spandrels m n with stones, and direct the
lines of the joints between them to the centre of the circle of the
639
arch, and the reason why this makes the arch durable is this. We
know very well that if the arch is loaded with an excess of weight
because the arch would yield in that direction; if the other quarter
787.
PLAN.
Here it is shown how the arches made in the side of the octagon
c and by the line t d which thrust out the pier m; that is they
788.
greater the weight placed on the arches, the less the arch transmits
then let him spread out his hands and feet between the walls of the
well, and you will see him weigh much less on the steel yard; give
him a weight on the shoulders, you will see by experiment, that the
640
greater the weight you give him the greater effort he will make in
spreading his arms and legs, and in pressing against the wall and
IV.
789.
public buildings, the depths of the foundations must bear the same
the lowest being the heaviest. And this can be proved, because these
layers have been formed by the sediment from water carried down to
the sea, by the current of rivers which flow into it. The heaviest
part of this sediment was that which was first thrown down, and so
stagnant, having first brought down the mud whence it first flowed.
And such layers of soil are seen in the banks of rivers, where their
641
constant flow has cut through them and divided one slope from the
other to a great depth; where in gravelly strata the waters have run
into hard stone, and this happened most in what was the finest mud;
790.
You should always make the foundations project equally beyond the
many do, that is to say if you make a foundation of equal width from
the bottom up to the surface of the ground, and charge it above with
do; since it does not cover the whole of its foundation, and
therefore thrusts less heavily and settles less. Hence, the pier b
642
791.
The window a is well placed under the window c, and the window
792.
OF THE SUPPORTS.
A pillar of which the thickness is increased will gain more than its
height.
EXAMPLE.
this will be ten braccia broad and 9 high; and if the first pillar
could carry 10000 pounds the second being only about as high as it
is wide, and thus lacking 8 parts of its proper length, it, that is
to say, each pillar thus united, will bear eight times more than
643
V.
793.
That angle will offer the greatest resistance which is most acute,
original, but the larger one is not directly connected with it. It
794.
If the beams and the weight o are 100 pounds, how much weight will
down?
795.
644
That beam which is more than 20 times as long as its greatest
remember, that the part built into the wall should be steeped in hot
pitch and filleted with oak boards likewise so steeped. Each beam
must pass through its walls and be secured beyond the walls with
are often seen to come out of the walls and bring down the walls and
floors; whilst if they are chained they will hold the walls strongly
together and the walls will hold the floors. Again I remind you
of the timber produced by damp and dryness such floors often crack,
and once cracked their divisions gradually produce dust and an ugly
somewhat in the middle while that part of the floor which rests on
the arches remains in its place; hence, floors laid over two kinds
645
architectural studies. However incomplete, however small in scale,
When Leonardo began his studies the great name of Brunellesco was
Leonardo was open to it, since we find among his sketches the plan
Lorenzo (Pl. XCIV No. 1), a plan almost identical with the chapel
Degli Angeli, only begun by him (Pl. XCIV, No. 3) while among
monuments.]
falls during the first twenty years of Leonardo's life. However the
new impetus given by Leon Battista Alberti either was not generally
no opportunity of showing that they did so. It was only when taken
architecture that this new influence was generally felt. Now the
646
Bramante, they appear to be the development and continuation of
Alberti's.
the dominant school of Brunellesco, which would then have given rise
to his "First manner", or had he, even before he left Florence, felt
Alberti at Mantua about 1470 and who not only carried out Alberti's
views and ideas, but, by his designs for St. Peter's at Rome, proved
Milan Bramante had already been living there for many years. One of
his earliest works in Milan was the church of Santa Maria presso San
LXXXV and in Pl. LXXX several sketches which seem to me to have been
647
MS. B. contains besides two notes relating to Pavia, one of them a
Florence, which occurs in the same Manuscript, may have been done
the forms of the cupolas of S. Maria del Fiore and of the Baptistery
made a similar design for the lantern of the Cupola of the Church of
building; and the Mausoleum on Pl. XCVIII, no less than one of the
648
same type.
The drawings Pl. LXXXIV No. 2, Pl. LXXXVI No. 1 and 2 and the ground
classic style, the use of brick for building, in that part of Italy,
649
It might be supposed, on the ground of Leonardo's relations with
the East given in sections XVII and XXI of this volume, that some
can be pointed out with certainty unless perhaps the drawing for a
cross there are some in which the forms are decidedly monotonous.
a Greek cross; and they also show a preference for a nave surrounded
(Pl. LXXXII No. 1; or grouped (Pl. LXXX No. 5 and XCIV No. 4), often
650
the cathedral of Florence, and with similar round windows in its
churches (Pl. XCI No. 1 and Pl. XCII No. 1); but it more generally
suggests the curve of Sta Maria del Fiore (Pl. LXXXVIII No. 5; Pl.
cases (Pl. LXXX No. 4; Pl. LXXXIX; Pl. XC No. 2) it shows the sides
Cathedral of Pavia.
in Pl. LXXXVII No. 2, shows the beautiful line, adopted sixty years
complete the architectural system. Not the least interesting are the
designs for the tiburio (cupola) of the Milan Cathedral. They show
651
The few examples of interiors of churches recall the style employed
beyond dispute. The project for the Mausoleum (Pl. XCVIII) would
alone suffice to rank him among the greatest architects who ever
lived. The peculiar shape of the tower (Pl. LXXX), of the churches
for preaching (Pl. XCVII No. 1 and pages 56 and 57, Fig. 1-4), his
curious plan for a city with high and low level streets (Pl. LXXVII
and LXXVIII No. 2 and No. 3), his Loggia with fountains (Pl. LXXXII
arches.
652
As an application of these studies the plan of a semicircular vault
ragio d'una volta cioe il terzo del diamitro della sua ... del
tedesco in domo.
treatment of detail. On Pl. LXXXV No. 10 and Pl. CIII No. 3, we find
for a fountain and on Pl. CIII No. 1 MS. B, is a pen and ink drawing
seem to have been intended to connect the upper parts with the base.
XIV.
653
largely treated of these two branches of learning. In the present
specialists only.
any exact dates, but in the year 1506 Marc Antonio della Torre seems
to have not yet left Padua. He was scarcely thirty years old when he
died in 1512, and his writings on anatomy have not only never been
and Marc Antonio della Torre. I may however observe that I have not
654
are printed in Section XXII. Here and there in the manuscripts
for supposing that Marc Antonio della Torre should have been this
"adversary".
with the coarse and inadequate figures given in the published books
the King's Library, has thus recorded his opinion: "I expected to
When I consider what pains he has taken upon every part of the body,
in mechanics and hydraulics, and the attention with which such a man
persuaded that Leonardo was the best Anatomist, at that time, in the
world ... Leonardo was certainly the first man, we know of, who
655
The illustrious German Naturalist Johan Friedrich Blumenback
esteemed them no less highly; he was one of the privileged few who,
day hardly anything has been made known of the text, and, for the
656
I.
ANATOMY.
796.
A general introduction
other men of more peaceful lives, or than those who want to grow
have dead water stir itself into life and perpetual motion, and to
painting and young artists rather than against medical men and
anatomists.]
will not see nor obtain knowledge of more than some few veins, to
657
obtain a true and perfect knowledge of which I have dissected more
than ten human bodies, destroying all the other members, and
[Footnote: Lines 1-59 and 60-89 are written in two parallel columns.
subject.]
And if you should have a love for such things you might be prevented
by loathing, and if that did not prevent you, you might be deterred
corpses, quartered and flayed and horrible to see. And if this did
not prevent you, perhaps you might not be able to draw so well as is
658
strength of the muscles; patience also may be wanting, so that you
wrote in note books of a very small size and only moderately thick;
this passage that the greater part of his Manuscripts were now
797.
This work must begin with the conception of man, and describe the
nature of the womb and how the foetus lives in it, up to what stage
it resides there, and in what way it quickens into life and feeds.
659
Also its growth and what interval there is between one stage of
growth and another. What it is that forces it out from the body of
the mother, and for what reasons it sometimes comes out of the
Then I will describe which are the members, which, after the boy is
born, grow more than the others, and determine the proportions of a
Then describe the fully grown man and woman, with their proportions,
Then how they are composed of veins, tendons, muscles and bones.
senses.
660
And then describe the nature of the senses.
the three first will show the ramification of the bones; that is:
first one to show their height and position and shape: the second
will be seen in profile and will show the depth of the whole and of
other figures from the same point of view, with the bones sawn
other figures of the bones complete, and of the nerves which rise
from the nape of the neck, and in what limbs they ramify. And three
others of the bones and veins, and where they ramify. Then three
figures with the muscles and three with the skin, and their proper
798.
if you had the natural man before you; and the reason is that if you
661
wish thoroughly to know the parts of man, anatomically, you--or your
below and from above and from its sides, turning it about and
seeking the origin of each member; and in this way the natural
satisfy you; seeing the very great confusion that must result from
muscles, bones, and blood which, of itself, tinges every part the
same colour. And the veins, which discharge this blood, are not
tinged with blood does not allow you to recognise the parts covered
which you want three to give full knowledge of the veins and
And three others to display the tissues; and three for the sinews
and muscles and ligaments; and three for the bones and cartilages;
and three for the anatomy of the bones, which have to be sawn to
show which are hollow and which are not, which have marrow and which
are spongy, and which are thick from the outside inwards, and which
are thin. And some are extremely thin in some parts and thick in
662
marrow, or spongy. And all these conditions are sometimes found in
one and the same bone, and in some bones none of them. And three you
must have for the woman, in which there is much that is mysterious
three different points of view of each part; for when you have seen
a limb from the front, with any muscles, sinews, or veins which take
their rise from the opposite side, the same limb will be shown to
you in a side view or from behind, exactly as if you had that same
limb in your hand and were turning it from side to side until you
same way there will be put before you three or four demonstrations
of each limb, from various points of view, so that you will be left
with a true and complete knowledge of all you wish to learn of the
slightly washed with Indian ink. On the back of this drawing is the
Thus, in twelve entire figures, you will have set before you the
cosmography of this lesser world on the same plan as, before me, was
divide them into limbs as he divided the whole world into provinces;
663
means of his different parts. And thus, if it please our great
And remember that the anatomy of the nerves will not give the
lime water; though indeed their origin and starting point may be
seen without such water as well as with it. But their ramifications,
when under running water, cling and unite--just like flat or hemp
799.
First draw the bones, let us say, of the arm, and put in the motor
muscle from the shoulder to the elbow with all its lines. Then
proceed in the same way from the elbow to the wrist. Then from the
And in the arm you will put the motors of the fingers which open,
664
secondary motors of the fingers and so proceed by degrees to avoid
confusion. But first lay on the bones those muscles which lie close
these you may put the nerves and veins which supply their
nourishment, after having first drawn the tree of veins and nerves
800.
Begin the anatomy at the head and finish at the sole of the foot.
801.
3 men complete, 3 with bones and nerves, 3 with the bones only. Here
802.
When you have finished building up the man, you will make the statue
to be different here and in the passage C.A. 157a, 468a (see No.
526, Note 1. 2). Here it can hardly mean anything else than
665
la statua would then mean, you must work out the figure in marble.
803.
You must show all the motions of the bones with their joints to
804.
you must pull the sinew from which the muscle springs in such a way
NOTE.
You will never get any thing but confusion in demonstrating the
666
threads; and thus you can represent them, one over another as nature
has placed them; and thus, too, you can name them according to the
limb they serve; for instance the motor of the point of the great
toe, of its middle bone, of its first bone, &c. And when you have
the knowledge you will draw, by the side of this, the true form and
size and position of each muscle. But remember to give the threads
will demonstrate the form of the leg and their distance in a plain
I have removed the skin from a man who was so shrunk by illness that
the muscles were worn down and remained in a state like thin
muscles ended in wide membrane; and where the bones were covered by
the skin they had very little over their natural size.
805.
Which nerve causes the motion of the eye so that the motion of one
667
Of frowning the brows, of raising the brows, of lowering the
nostrils, of opening the lips, with the teeth shut, of pouting with
Describe the beginning of man when it is caused in the womb and why
an eight months child does not live. What sneezing is. What yawning
Of the nerve which is the cause of movement from the shoulder to the
elbow, of the movement from the elbow to the hand, from the joint of
the hand to the springing of the fingers. From the springing of the
fingers to the middle joints, and from the middle joints to the
last.
Of the nerve which causes the movement of the thigh, and from the
knee to the foot, and from the joint of the foot to the toes, and
then to the middle of the toes and of the rotary motion of the leg.
806.
ANATOMY.
Which nerves or sinews of the hand are those which close and part
668
807.
Remove by degrees all the parts of the front of a man in making your
808.
Give the anatomy of the leg up to the hip, in all views and in every
muscles, skin and bones; then the bones in sections to show the
this text.]
809.
Make the rule and give the measurement of each muscle, and give the
reasons of all their functions, and in which way they work and what
[4] First draw the spine of the back; then clothe it by degrees, one
669
after the other, with each of its muscles and put in the nerves and
arteries and veins to each muscle by itself; and besides these note
come in contact with them; and which bones and other organs &c.
The most prominent parts of lean people are most prominent in the
[Footnote: The two drawings given on Pl. CVIII no. 1 come between
lines 3 and 4. A good and very early copy of this drawing without
810.
And observe that that part which on the surface of a fat person is
Where the muscles separate one from another you must give profiles
670
811.
flesh?
Or what part which as a man grows lean never falls away with a too
perceptible diminution? And among the parts which grow fat which is
Among those which grow lean which is that which grows leanest?
In very strong men which are the muscles which are thickest and most
prominent?
In your anatomy you must represent all the stages of the limbs from
man's creation to his death, and then till the death of the bone;
and which part of him is first decayed and which is preserved the
longest.
812.
671
ANATOMY.
veins, arteries, fascia, ligament and sinews, skin, muscle and fat.
OF THE HEAD.
The divisions of the head are 10, viz. 5 external and 5 internal,
the external are the hair, skin, muscle, fascia and the skull; the
internal are the dura mater, the pia mater, [which enclose] the
brain. The pia mater and the dura mater come again underneath and
enclose the brain; then the rete mirabile, and the occipital bone,
813.
a. hair
n. skin
c. muscle
m. fascia
672
b. dura mater
d. pia mater
f. brain
t. dura mater
l. rete mirablile
814.
673
intestines.
asleep.
Of the cause of lust and other appetites of the body, of the cause
[Footnote: By the side of this text stands the pen and ink drawing
815.
The tears come from the heart and not from the brain.
Define all the parts, of which the body is composed, beginning with
the skin with its outer cuticle which is often chapped by the
II.
674
ZOOLOGY AND COMPARATIVE ANATOMY.
816.
as are of almost the same species, as Apes, Monkeys and the like,
The Horse and its kindred, as Mule, Ass and the like, with incisor
The Bull and its allies with horns and without upper incisors as
the Buffalo, Stag Fallow Deer, Wild Goat, Swine, Goat, wild Goats
817.
675
Describe the various forms of the intestines of the human species,
of apes and such like. Then, in what way the leonine species differ,
and then the bovine, and finally birds; and arrange this description
818.
Procure the placenta of a calf when it is born and observe the form
819.
Describe the tongue of the woodpecker and the jaw of the crocodile.
820.
downward flight.
676
work.]
821.
Of the way in which the tail of a fish acts in propelling the fish;
muscles (822-826).
822.
they vary; as in the bear, which has the ligatures of the sinews of
823.
677
You will represent here for a comparison, the legs of a frog, which
have a great resemblance to the legs of man, both in the bones and
which are very muscular, with strong active muscles, because they
824.
man and the horse and in the same way with other animals. And first
I will begin with the bones, and then will go on to all the muscles
which spring from the bones without tendons and end in them in the
same way, and then go on to those which start with a single tendon
at one end.
825.
Note on the bendings of joints and in what way the flesh grows upon
678
of animals with four feet; among which is man, who likewise in his
826.
walking he puts forward, with it, his left arm and vice versa,
invariably.
III.
PHYSIOLOGY.
827.
with the bodies of animals the organs of sense are duller and
679
seen in the Lion tribe that the sense of smell is connected with
part of the substance of the brain which comes down the nostrils,
The eyes in the Lion tribe have a large part of the head for their
sockets and the optic nerves communicate at once with the brain; but
the contrary is to be seen in man, for the sockets of the eyes are
but a small part of the head, and the optic nerves are very fine and
long and weak, and by the weakness of their action we see by day but
day. The proof that they can see is that they prowl for prey at
828.
This happens because the pupil of the eye is much smaller at midday
680
proportion to the animal than that of man, so much the more light
can it see at night than man can; hence at midday it can see nothing
if its pupil does not diminish; and, in the same way, at night
829.
The eyes of all animals have their pupils adapted to dilate and
owls, and in the eyes of one species of owl; in these the pupil
ounces, tigers, lynxes, Spanish cats and other similar animals the
oval such as is shown in the margin. But man having a weaker sight
than any other animal is less hurt by a very strong light and his
pupil increases but little in dark places; but in the eyes of these
681
which time these birds remain hidden in dark holes; or if indeed
they are compelled to come out into the open air lighted up by the
sun, they contract their pupils so much that their power of sight
Study the anatomy of various eyes and see which are the muscles
which open and close the said pupils of the eyes of animals.
830.
When the eye of a bird closes with its two lids, the first to close
is the nictitating membrane which closes from the lacrymal duct over
to the outer corner of the eye; and the outer lid closes from below
upwards, and these two intersecting motions begin first from the
below birds are protected and use only the upper portion of the eye
from fear of birds of prey which come down from above and behind;
and they uncover first the membrane from the outer corner, because
682
if the enemy comes from behind, they have the power of escaping to
the front; and again the muscle called the nictitating membrane is
transparent, because, if the eye had not such a screen, they could
not keep it open against the wind which strikes against the eye in
the rush of their rapid flight. And the pupil of the eye dilates and
brilliancy.
831.
If at night your eye is placed between the light and the eye of a
(832. 833).
832.
a e i o u
ba be bi bo bu
ca ce ci co cu
da de di do du
fa fe fi fo fu
ga ge gi go gu
la le li lo lu
683
ma me mi mo mu
na ne ni no nu
pa pe pi po pu
qa qe qi qo qu
ra re ri ro ru
sa se si so su
ta te ti to tu
muscles which compose the portion of the tongue which moves in the
mouth.
between, that the opening of the lips should close by degrees; that
It may be shown how all the vowels are pronounced with the farthest
833.
If you draw in breath by the nose and send it out by the mouth you
will hear the sound made by the division that is the membrane in
684
On the conditions of sight (834. 835).
834.
nocturnal animals, I must say that this in the same way is subject
to the very same natural laws. For it will easily be understood that
the senses which receive the images of things do not project from
contrary the atmospheric medium which exists between the object and
to the ear or the nose, then light is not required and does not act.
The forms of objects do not send their images into the air if they
are not illuminated [8]; and the eye being thus constituted cannot
receive that from the air, which the air does not possess, although
it touches its surface. If you choose to say that there are many
animals that prey at night, I answer that when the little light
not impeded by the darkness, and in which they are very far superior
685
to man. If you make a cat leap, by daylight, among a quantity of
jars and crocks you will see them remain unbroken, but if you do the
same at night, many will be broken. Night birds do not fly about
unless the moon shines full or in part; rather do they feed between
No body can be apprehended without light and shade, and light and
835.
Sight is better from a distance than near in those men who are
near.
836.
the other senses. The ancient speculators have concluded that that
686
part of man which constitutes his judgment is caused by a central
impressibility; and to this centre they have given the name Common
Sense. And they say that this Sense is situated in the centre of the
head between Sensation and Memory. And this name of Common Sense is
five senses i.e. Seeing, Hearing, Touch, Taste and Smell. This
that is to say the senses which are the medium between external
things and Sensation. In the same way the senses are acted upon by
the Common Sense, and by it they are stamped upon the memory and are
nearest to the sensitive medium and the eye, being the highest is
the chief of the others. Of this then only we will speak, and the
others we will leave in order not to make our matter too long.
things, that is: Light and Darkness, one being the cause of the
perception of the nine others, and the other its absence:-- Colour
and substance, form and place, distance and nearness, motion and
687
On the origin of the soul.
837.
devise any inventions more beautiful, nor more simple, nor more to
when she makes limbs proper for motion in the bodies of animals. But
she puts into them the soul of the body, which forms them that is
the soul of the mother which first constructs in the womb the form
of the man and in due time awakens the soul that is to inhabit it.
And this at first lies dormant and under the tutelage of the soul of
with all its spiritual parts, and this happens because this
child is attached to the mother. And these are the reason why a
the mother, has more influence on the child than on the mother; for
there are many cases when the child loses its life from them, &c.
This discourse is not in its place here, but will be wanted for the
688
[Footnote 57: lettere incoronate. By this term Leonardo probably
understands not the Bible only, but the works of the early Fathers,
and all the books recognised as sacred by the Roman Church.] I leave
838.
The soul seems to reside in the judgment, and the judgment would
seem to be seated in that part where all the senses meet; and this
would have been no need to make the instruments of the senses meet
in one centre and in one single spot; on the contrary it would have
sufficed that the eye should fulfil the function of its sensation on
its surface only, and not transmit the image of the things seen, to
the sense, by means of the optic nerves, so that the soul--for the
the voice had merely sounded in the porous cavity of the indurated
portion of the temporal bone which lies within the ear, without
689
making any farther transit from this bone to the common sense, where
the voice confers with and discourses to the common judgment. The
that same judgment. Feeling passes through the perforated cords and
ramifications into the skin which encloses the members of the body
and the viscera. The perforated cords convey volition and sensation
to the subordinate limbs. These cords and the nerves direct the
motions of the muscles and sinews, between which they are placed;
shrink which are interwoven among the particles of the limbs; being
extended to the tips of the fingers, they transmit to the sense the
The nerves with their muscles obey the tendons as soldiers obey the
officers, and the tendons obey the Common [central] Sense as the
officers obey the general. [27] Thus the joint of the bones obeys
the nerve, and the nerve the muscle, and the muscle the tendon and
the tendon the Common Sense. And the Common Sense is the seat of the
its referendary since the sense waits on the soul and not the soul
on the sense. And where the sense that ministers to the soul is not
at the service of the soul, all the functions of that sense are also
wanting in that man's life, as is seen in those born mute and blind.
690
[Footnote: The peculiar use of the words nervo, muscolo,
muscle cord or tendon and Common Sense may be understood from lines
27 and 28.]
839.
This is most plainly seen; for you will see palsied and shivering
persons move, and their trembling limbs, as their head and hands,
quake without leave from their soul and their soul with all its
power cannot prevent their members from trembling. The same thing
840.
691
There are four Powers: memory and intellect, desire and
covetousness. The two first are mental and the others sensual. The
touch and taste not at all. Smell is connected with taste in dogs
841.
their existence.
842.
843.
692
dies and is constantly renewed; because nourishment can only enter
into places where the former nourishment has expired, and if it has
the same instant all the flame is dead and all regenerated,
844.
King of the animals--as thou hast described him--I should rather say
spared slaying them, in order that they may give thee their children
for the benefit of the gullet, of which thou hast attempted to make
a sepulchre for all animals; and I would say still more, if it were
happen among the animals of the earth, inasmuch as among them are
693
found none who eat their own kind, unless through want of sense (few
indeed among them, and those being mothers, as with men, albeit they
be not many in number); and this happens only among the rapacious
cats and the like, who sometimes eat their children; but thou,
nor is this enough for thee, but thou goest to the chase on the
islands of others, taking other men and these half-naked, the ...
and the ... thou fattenest, and chasest them down thy own
throat[18]; now does not nature produce enough simples, for thee to
satisfy thyself? and if thou art not content with simples, canst
feeding?
694
acquainted, writes in his second letter to Pietro Soderini, about
huomini. Viddi anche vna certa citta, nella quale io dimorai forse
845.
intellectual.
695
846.
Here nature appears with many animals to have been rather a cruel
847.
Man and animals are really the passage and the conduit of food, the
sepulchre of animals and resting place of the dead, one causing the
848.
Death in old men, when not from fever, is caused by the veins which
go from the spleen to the valve of the liver, and which thicken so
much in the walls that they become closed up and leave no passage
[6]The incessant current of the blood through the veins makes these
veins thicken and become callous, so that at last they close up and
696
849.
The waters return with constant motion from the lowest depths of the
sea to the utmost height of the mountains, not obeying the nature of
beings which always moves from the sea of the heart and flows
towards the top of the head; and here it may burst a vein, as may be
seen when a vein bursts in the nose; all the blood rises from below
to the level of the burst vein. When the water rushes out from the
burst vein in the earth, it obeys the law of other bodies that are
[Footnote: From this passage it is quite plain that Leonardo had not
the heart are to be found in the MS. W. An. III. but no information
about them has hitherto been made public. The limits of my plan in
very brief excerpt from this note book can be given here. WILLIAM
sanguinis.]
850.
697
That the blood which returns when the heart opens again is not the
851.
Make them give you the definition and remedies for the case ... and
you will see that men are selected to be doctors for diseases they
do not know.
852.
incense. Keep each thing separate; and melt the wax, and then put in
the incense and then the colophony, make a mixture of it and put it
853.
854.
698
Those who are annoyed by sickness at sea should drink extract of
wormwood.
855.
To keep in health, this rule is wise: Eat only when you want and
relish food. Chew thoroughly that it may do you good. Have it well
advised.
856.
I teach you to preserve your health; and in this you will succed
XV.
Astronomy.
699
Ever since the publication by Venturi in 1797 and Libri in 1840
have been based on very important discoveries, and that the great
manuscripts, which have come down to us. Unlike his other purely
whose influence and teaching but little is now known, beyond the
700
Leonardo, and from the dates of the manuscripts from which the texts
(see Nos. 869 and 870), this being the term universally applied
Leonardo conceives of the earth as fixed, with the moon and sun
897. He does not go into any theory of the motions of the planets;
with regard to these and the fixed stars he only investigates the
the earth, but even in the moon. Although his acute research into
the nature of the moon's light and the spots on the moon did not
701
evident that they were a refutation of the errors of his
date.
it, namely: the assumption that the moon was at a relatively short
distance from the earth. So long as the motion of the earth round
its parallax.
appear however from certain passages in the notes here printed for
the first time, that Leonardo was in a position to study the spots
in the moon more closely than he could have done with the unaided
702
constructed like a telescope--telescopes were first made about
I.
857.
The equator, the line of the horizon, the ecliptic, the meridian:
These lines are those which in all their parts are equidistant from
858.
The earth is not in the centre of the Sun's orbit nor at the centre
united with them. And any one standing on the moon, when it and the
sun are both beneath us, would see this our earth and the element of
703
water upon it just as we see the moon, and the earth would light it
as it lights us.
859.
motion, and the grand-child of spiritual motion, and the mother and
generated.
Force, with physical motion, and gravity, with resistance are the
Force has its origin in spiritual motion; and this motion, flowing
contract the tendons which are connected with them, and this is the
The quality and quantity of the force of a man are able to give
704
[Footnote: Only part of this passage belongs, strictly speaking, to
section on Physiology.]
860.
Why does not the weight o remain in its place? It does not remain
towards the centre [of gravity]. And why by no other line? Because a
weight which has no support falls by the shortest road to the lowest
point which is the centre of the world. And why does the weight know
[Footnote: This text and the sketch belonging to it, are reproduced
on Pl. CXXI.]
861.
Let the earth turn on which side it may the surface of the waters
will never move from its spherical form, but will always remain
Granting that the earth might be removed from the centre of the
705
globe, what would happen to the water?
It would remain in a sphere round that centre equally thick, but the
earth.
862.
Supposing the earth at our antipodes which supports the ocean were
to rise and stand uncovered, far out of the sea, but remaining
863.
Each man is always in the middle of the surface of the earth and
under the zenith of his own hemisphere, and over the centre of the
earth.
864.
Mem.: That I must first show the distance of the sun from the earth;
706
and, by means of a ray passing through a small hole into a dark
chamber, detect its real size; and besides this, by means of the
Here it will be shown, that when the sun is in the meridian of our
word Antipodes does not here bear its literal sense, but--as we
the antipodes to the East and to the West, alike, and at the same
time, see the sun mirrored in their waters; and the same is equally
inhabited.
865.
866.
In your discourse you must prove that the earth is a star much like
the moon, and the glory of our universe; and then you must treat of
707
867.
First describe the eye; then show how the twinkling of a star is
really in the eye and why one star should twinkle more than another,
and how the rays from the stars originate in the eye; and add, that
if the twinkling of the stars were really in the stars --as it seems
the diameter of the body of the star; therefore, the star being
rapid doubling of the size of the star. Then prove that the surface
of the air where it lies contiguous to fire, and the surface of the
fire where it ends are those into which the solar rays penetrate,
and transmit the images of the heavenly bodies, large when they
rise, and small, when they are on the meridian. Let a be the earth
sun; then I say that when the sun appears on the horizon g, its
rays are seen passing through the surface of the air at a slanting
atmosphere.
868.
708
Beyond the sun and us there is darkness and so the air appears blue.
869.
PERSPECTIVE.
It is possible to find means by which the eye shall not see remote
by the method I here teach in the margin [9] these pyramids are
convex pupil of the eye can take in the whole of our hemisphere,
while this will show only a single star; but where many small stars
transmit their images to the surface of the pupil those stars are
extremely small; here only one star is seen but it will be large.
And so the moon will be seen larger and its spots of a more defined
form [Footnote 20 and fol.: Telescopes were not in use till a century
later. Compare No. 910 and page 136.]. You must place close to the
eye a glass filled with the water of which mention is made in number
709
it may refer, on the other hand, to one of the 120 Books mentioned
in No. 796. l. 84.]; for this water makes objects which are enclosed
OF THE EYE.
Among the smaller objects presented to the pupil of the eye, that
the same time, the experiments here made with the power of sight,
Compare with this the passage in Vol. I, No. 52, written about
[34]Those objects are seen largest which come to the eye at the
largest angles.
But the images of the objects conveyed to the pupil of the eye are
and the proof of this is in what follows; that when we look at the
starry sky, without gazing more fixedly at one star than another,
the sky appears all strewn with stars; and their proportions to the
eye are the same as in the sky and likewise the spaces between them
[61].
710
[Footnote: 9. 32. in margine: lines 34-61 are, in the original,
870.
PERSPECTIVE.
Among objects moved from the eye at equal distance, that undergoes
their original position, that which was at first the farthest from
the eye will diminish least. And the proportion of the diminution
its place and set it farther from the eye by one of the 5 parts into
to the eye has doubled the distance and according to the last
size; and the body e, by the same motion, is diminished 1/5 of its
whole size. Therefore, by that same last proposition but one, that
711
the motions of the celestial bodies which are more distant by 3500
miles when setting than when overhead, and yet do not increase or
871.
a b is the aperture through which the sun passes, and if you could
trace the real lines of the convergence of the solar rays, the
at the. inner side of the aperture at cd, where they maybe measured
at the spot where the solar rays fall. Then place your mirror at the
method, but you must use this mirror always in the same month, and
the same day, and hour and instant, and this will be better than at
872.
a, the side of the body in light and shade b, faces the whole
portion of the hemisphere bed e f, and does not face any part of
the darkness of the earth. And the same occurs at the point o;
712
therefore the space a o is throughout of one and the same
873.
these I reply: No; because objects seen through a mist are similar
board placed half under water. But the reason why the sun looks
713
On the luminosity of the Earth in the universal space (874-878).
874.
In my book I propose to show, how the ocean and the other seas must,
by means of the sun, make our world shine with the appearance of a
moon, and to the remoter worlds it looks like a star; and this I
shall prove.
Show, first that every light at a distance from the eye throws out
rays which appear to increase the size of the luminous body; and
from this it follows that 2 ...[Footnote 10: Here the text breaks
[11]The moon is cold and moist. Water is cold and moist. Thus our
875.
the sun when the water is smooth. Let f be the eye which sees the
image in all the waves included within the base of the triangle c e
714
space c e (as is proved in the 4th of my "Perspective") [Footnote
to some particular work, the largest of the diagrams here given must
be meant. It is the lowest and actually the fifth, but he would have
called it the fourth, for the text here given is preceded on the
part of the Book on Painting; see Vol. I, No. 206, 207.] and it will
In the two next diagrams at the spot here marked L the word Luna
a.]
The image of the sun will be more brightly shown in small waves than
715
in large ones--and this is because the reflections or images of the
sun are more numerous in the small waves than in large ones, and the
the fewer.
Waves which intersect like the scales of a fir cone reflect the
image of the sun with the greatest splendour; and this is the case
because the images are as many as the ridges of the waves on which
the sun shines, and the shadows between these waves are small and
That reflection of the sun will cover most space on the surface of
the water which is most remote from the eye which sees it.
surface of the water, in which the sun is mirrored, and r the eye
which sees this reflection on the surface of the water occupying the
of the water and also from the reflection; hence this reflection
876.
716
the sun, should reflect its radiance unless this mirror were
You see here the sun which lights up the moon, a spherical mirror,
and all of its surface, which faces the sun is rendered radiant.
like that of our seas, and in waves as that is; and that portion
and the sun, is given to show that, just as the reflection of the
sun is seen in each of these bodies, in the same way that image may
be seen in each curve of the waves of the sea; and as in these many
spheres many reflections of the sun are seen, so in many waves there
to the eye. And, as this happens with each wave, the spaces
interposed between the waves are concealed; and, for this reason, it
looks as though the many suns mirrored in the many waves were but
one continuous sun; and the shadows,, mixed up with the luminous
images, render this radiance less brilliant than that of the sun
717
877.
The edges in the moon will be most strongly lighted and reflect most
light, because, there, nothing will be visible but the tops of the
878.
The sun will appear larger in moving water or on waves than in still
monochord.
II.
THE SUN.
The question of the true and of the apparent size of the sun
(879-884).
879.
718
If you look at the stars, cutting off the rays (as may be done by
looking through a very small hole made with the extreme point of a
very fine needle, placed so as almost to touch the eye), you will
see those stars so minute that it would seem as though nothing could
of their diminution, for many of them are very many times larger
than the star which is the earth with water. Now reflect what this
our star must look like at such a distance, and then consider how
those stars which are scattered over the darkened sky. But I cannot
forbear to condemn many of the ancients, who said that the sun was
atmosphere equidistant from the centre of the earth. Any one looking
rea-
880.
719
sons of its size and power I shall reserve for Book 4. But I wonder
occasion that in his youth he had turned his mind to the study of
bodies. Leonardo may very well have known of these, since the Latin
edition exists which may very likely have appeared between 1480--90.
There is but one passage in Plato, Epinomis (p. 983) where he speaks
Aristotle who goes very fully into the subject says the same. A
MULLER-STRUBING).]
should have depreciated that solar body, saying that it was of the
720
nature of incandescent stone, and the one who opposed him as to that
error was not far wrong. But I only wish I had words to serve me to
blame those who are fain to extol the worship of men more than that
body of greater magnitude and power than the sun. Its light gives
the universe; and from it descends all vital force, for the heat
that is in living beings comes from the soul [vital spark]; and
men as gods--as Jove, Saturn, Mars and the like--have fallen into
the gravest error, seeing that even if a man were as large as our
earth, he would look no bigger than a little star which appears but
as a speck in the universe; and seeing again that these men are
quibusdam aliis. This was much read in the middle ages. The editto
881.
721
Epicurus perhaps saw the shadows cast by columns on the walls in
shadows were cast; and the breadth of the shadows being parallel
from beginning to end, he thought he might infer that the sun also
breadth was not greater than that of the column; not perceiving that
remoteness of the sun. If the sun were smaller than the earth, the
which is evidence against Epicurus who says the sun is only as large
as it appears.
882.
Epicurus says the sun is the size it looks. Hence as it looks about
that when the moon eclipses the sun, the sun ought not to appear the
larger, as it does. Then, the moon being smaller than the sun, the
moon must be less than a foot, and consequently when our world
luminous cause of the cone of shadow must be larger than the opaque
722
body which casts the cone of shadow.
883.
To measure how many times the diameter of the sun will go into its
course in 24 hours.
Make a circle and place it to face the south, after the manner of a
sundial, and place a rod in the middle in such a way as that its
length points to the centre of this circle, and mark the shadow cast
measure how many times this shadow will go into this circumference
of a circle, and that will give you the number of times that the
solar body will go into its orbit in 24 hours. Thus you may see
whether Epicurus was [right in] saying that the sun was only as
about a foot, and as that sun would go a thousand times into the
would follow that the course of the sun during the day would be the
sixth part of a mile and that this venerable snail, the sun will
884.
723
Posidonius composed books on the size of the sun. [Footnote:
among them.
Strabo quotes no doubt from one of his works, when he says that
Poseidonius explained how it was that the sun looked larger when it
was rising or setting than during the rest of its course (III, p.
wrote this note in 1508, and as the original Greek was first printed
885.
OF THE PROOF THAT THE SUN IS HOT BY NATURE AND NOT BY VIRTUE.
724
That the heat of the sun resides in its nature and not in its virtue
solar body on which the human eye cannot dwell and besides this no
which--when they strike the eye with such splendour that the eye
place. And that this is true I prove by the fact that if the mirror
heat that strikes from the reflected rays of such a mirror. And if
you argue that the mirror itself is cold and yet send forth hot
rays, I should reply that those rays come really from the sun and
that it is the ray of the concave mirror after having passed through
the window.
886.
The sun does not move. [Footnote: This sentence occurs incidentally
letters.]
887.
725
PROOF THAT THE NEARER YOU ARE TO THE SOURCE OF THE SOLAR RAYS,
THE
LARGER WILL THE REFLECTION OF THE SUN FROM THE SEA APPEAR TO
YOU.
from the centre that the sun employs its radiance to intensify the
power of its whole mass, it is evident that the farther its rays
extend, the more widely they will be divided; and this being so,
you, whose eye is near the water that mirrors the sun, see but a
small portion of the rays of the sun strike the surface of the
water, and reflecting the form of the sun. But if you were near to
the sun--as would be the case when the sun is on the meridian and
the sea to the westward--you would see the sun, mirrored in the sea,
of a very great size; because, as you are nearer to the sun, your
eye taking in the rays nearer to the point of radiation takes more
of them in, and a great splendour is the result. And in this way it
can be proved that the moon must have seas which reflect the sun,
888.
889.
WHY THE SUN APPEARS LARGER WHEN SETTING THAN AT NOON, WHEN IT IS
726
NEAR TO US.
than it is.
earth).]
890.
Because the eye is small it can only see the image of the sun as of
a small size. If the eye were as large as the sun it would see the
image of the sun in water of the same size as the real body of the
891.
Take a piece of paper and pierce holes in it with a needle, and look
III.
THE MOON.
727
On the luminousity of the moon (892-901).
892.
OF THE MOON.
it is that the solar rays which fall on the waves of the sea, are
seen by the eye of the same width at the angle nearest to the eye,
notwithstanding this the solar rays reflected from the waves of the
which is heavier.
728
3dly. As to whether the moon is situated in the centre of its
elements or not.
And, if it has no proper place of its own, like the earth, in the
midst of its elements, why does it not fall to the centre of our
5-15.]
And, if the moon is not in the centre of its own elements and yet
does not fall, it must then be lighter than any other element.
And, if the moon is lighter than the other elements why is it opaque
A.]
893.
729
The image of the sun in the moon is powerfully luminous, and is only
illuminate about half of the ball, the eye will perceive its
reflection only in a small part of its surface, and all the rest of
only in that spot that the image of the light is seen, and all the
rest remains invisible, the eye being at a distance from the ball.
The same thing would happen on the surface of the moon if it were
surface.
Show how, if you were standing on the moon or on a star, our earth
And show that the image of the sun in the sea cannot appear one and
894.
side of the moon which is never seen. [Footnote: Compare also Vol.
I, Nos. 175-179.]
730
895.
Either the moon has intrinsic luminosity or not. If it has, why does
it not shine without the aid of the sun? But if it has not any light
"luna o noi terra" (the moon or our earth). Compare also the text
896.
OF THE MOON.
The moon has no light in itself; but so much of it as faces the sun
faces the earth. And the moon's night receives just as much light as
is lent it by our waters as they reflect the image of the sun, which
is mirrored in all those waters which are on the side towards the
sun. The outside or surface of the waters forming the seas of the
moon and of the seas of our globe is always ruffled little or much,
731
numberless images of the sun which are repeated in the ridges and
different positions to view them from. This could not happen, if the
aqueous sphere which covers a great part of the moon were uniformly
spherical, for then the images of the sun would be one to each
in the gilt balls placed on the tops of high buildings. But if those
globules, then each portion of these little balls, when seen in the
sun, would display to the eye the lustre resulting from the
reflection of the sun, and thus, in one and the same body many tiny
suns would be seen; and these often combine at a long distance and
appear as one. The lustre of the new moon is brighter and stronger,
than when the moon is full; and the reason of this is that the angle
which the angles [of incidence and reflection] are highly acute. The
waves of the moon therefore mirror the sun in the hollows of the
waves as well as on the ridges, and the sides remain in shadow. But
at the sides of the moon the hollows of the waves do not catch the
sunlight, but only their crests; and thus the images are fewer and
732
because the curves of the sides of the waves are insufficient to
reflect to the eye the rays that fall upon them. Now the new moon
naturally reflects the solar rays more directly towards the eye from
the crests of the waves than from any other part, as is shown by the
form of the moon, whose rays a strike the waves b and are
cannot happen at the full moon, when the solar rays, being in the
west, fall on the extreme waters of the moon to the East from n to
m, and are not reflected to the eye in the West, but are thrown
back eastwards, with but slight deflection from the straight course
of the solar ray; and thus the angle of incidence is very wide
indeed.
The moon is an opaque and solid body and if, on the contrary, it
rise above all the albumen and stop in contact with the shell of the
[54].
733
The innumerable images of the solar rays reflected from the
innumerable waves of the sea, as they fall upon those waves, are
what cause us to see the very broad and continuous radiance on the
897.
That the sun could not be mirrored in the body of the moon, which is
illuminated by the sun, should reflect the sun unless the moon had a
surface adapted to reflect it--in waves and ridges, like the surface
The waves in water multiply the image of the object reflected in it.
These waves reflect light, each by its own line, as the surface of
the fir cone does [Footnote 14: See the diagram p. 145.]
These are 2 figures one different from the other; one with
734
sphere.
Here you must prove that the earth produces all the same effects
with regard to the moon, as the moon with regard to the earth.
The moon, with its reflected light, does not shine like the sun,
of the sun on its whole surface, but only on the crests and hollows
of the waves of its waters; and thus the sun being confusedly
reflected, from the admixture of the shadows that lie between the
lustrous waves, its light is not pure and clear as the sun is.
and B.--]. The earth between the moon on the fifteenth day and the
sun. [Footnote 39: See the diagram below the one referred to in the
preceding note.] Here the sun is in the East and the moon on the
below the others.] The moon on the fifteenth [day] between the earth
and the sun. [41]Here it is the moon which has the sun to the West
898.
735
assimilate the character of light after the manner of a mirror, or
the East and in the West, like the sun and the other planets. And
luna (the moon).], and if you see the sun or moon mirrored in the
water near to you, it looks to you of the same size in the water as
look 100 times larger; and if you see the sun reflected in the sea
at sunset, its image would look to you more than 10 miles long;
because that reflected image extends over more than 10 miles of sea.
And if you could stand where the moon is, the sun would look to you,
and the land amid the water would appear just like the dark spots
that are on the moon, which, when looked at from our earth, appears
to men the same as our earth would appear to any men who might dwell
in the moon.
736
When the moon is entirely lighted up to our sight, we see its full
rays which fall on it and are thrown off towards us, its ocean casts
off less moisture towards us; and the less light it gives the more
injurious it is.
899.
OF THE MOON.
I say that as the moon has no light in itself and yet is luminous,
900.
OF THE MOON.
moon. [Footnote: The objections are very minutely noted down in the
901.
Answer to Maestro Andrea da Imola, who said that the solar rays
737
the moon is of the nature of a mirror, and that consequently the
Let o p be the body of the sun, c n s the moon, and b the eye
902.
OF THE MOON.
Having proved that the part of the moon that shines consists of
water, which mirrors the body of the sun and reflects the radiance
it receives from it; and that, if these waters were devoid of waves,
738
it would appear small, but of a radiance almost like the sun; --[5]
distance from the earth greater levity must prevail, so that water
is lighter than the earth, and air than water, and fire than air and
really has, it would have weight, and having weight, that it could
would fall towards the centre of the universe and become united to
the earth; or if not the moon itself, at least its waters would fall
away and be lost from it, and descend towards the centre, leaving
the moon without any and so devoid of lustre. But as this does not
air and fire; and thus is, of itself and by itself, suspended in
that part of space, as our earth with its element is in this part of
space; and that heavy bodies act in the midst of its elements just
original discoverer of the cause of the ashy colour of the new moon
century later.
739
718b and 719b; "Perche la luna cinta della parte alluminata dal
of the "Saggio" who first published this passage (page 12) add
another short one about the seasons in the moon which I confess not
When the eye is in the East and sees the moon in the West near to
luminous portions; and the lateral and upper portion of this light
is derived from the sun, and the lower portion from the ocean in the
West, which receives the solar rays and reflects them on the lower
waters of the moon, and indeed affords the part of the moon that is
Therefore it is not totally dark, and hence some have believed that
the moon must in parts have a light of its own besides that which is
given it by the sun; and this light is due, as has been said, to the
moon when it and the sun are both in the West is wholly borrowed
from the sun, when it, and the sun, and the eye are situated as is
740
shown above.
[Footnote 23. 24: The larger of the two diagrams reproduced above
stands between these two lines, and the smaller one is sketched in
(solar body) in the larger diagram and Sole (sun) in the smaller
Some might say that the air surrounding the moon as an element,
catches the light of the sun as our atmosphere does, and that it is
this which completes the luminous circle on the body of the moon.
Some have thought that the moon has a light of its own, but this
seen between the hornes of the new moon, which looks dark where it
new radiance completing the circle where the tips of the horns
illuminated by the sun cease to shine [Footnote 34: See Pl. CVIII,
No. 5.]. And this difference of background arises from the fact that
than it is; while at the upper part, where a portion of the luminous
741
edge than it is. And that brightness at such a time itself is
derived from our ocean and other inland-seas. These are, at that
as that the sea then fulfils the same function to the dark side of
the moon as the moon at its fifteenth day does to us when the sun is
set. And the small amount of light which the dark side of the moon
receives bears the same proportion to the light of that side which
If you want to see how much brighter the shaded portion of the moon
portion of the moon with your hand or with some other more distant
object.
903.
Some have said that vapours rise from the moon, after the manner of
clouds and are interposed between the moon and our eyes. But, if
this were the case, these spots would never be permanent, either as
to position or form; and, seeing the moon from various aspects, even
if these spots did not move they would change in form, as objects do
742
which are seen from different sides.
904.
parts; as though one part were something like alabaster and others
like crystal or glass. It would follow from this that the sun
casting its rays on the less transparent portions, the light would
darker depths; and this is their account of the structure and nature
of the moon. And this opinion has found favour with many
and sun to our eyes, we should see these spots vary, at one time
looking dark and at another light: they would be dark when the sun
is in the West and the moon in the middle of the sky; for then the
edges of those transparent hollows, because the sun could not then
fling his rays into the mouth of the hollows, which however, at full
the East and faces the sun in the West; then the sun would
743
would not show us the spots in question; and so it would be, now
more and now less, according to the changes in the position of the
sun to the moon, and of the moon to our eyes, as I have said above.
905.
It has been asserted, that the spots on the moon result from the
moon being of varying thinness or density; but if this were so, when
there is an eclipse of the moon the solar rays would pierce through
This word, as it seems to me, here means eclipses of the sun; and
foregoing hypothesis the moon, when it comes between the sun and the
Others say that the surface of the moon is smooth and polished and
covered with water, presents various aspects and forms. Hence when
the moon is in the East it would reflect different spots from those
the moon, as they are seen at full moon, never vary in the course of
744
reflected in a convex body takes up but a small portion of that
when the moon is full, it only faces half the hemisphere of the
illuminated earth, on which only the ocean and other waters reflect
bright light, while the land makes spots on that brightness; thus
half of our earth would be seen girt round with the brightness of
the sea lighted up by the sun, and in the moon this reflection would
it borrows its brightness from the sun,--as the moon does--, could
not cause the earth to be reflected in it, nor indeed could the body
of the sun be seen reflected in it, nor indeed any star opposite to
it.
906.
If you keep the details of the spots of the moon under observation
you will often find great variation in them, and this I myself have
proved by drawing them. And this is caused by the clouds that rise
from the waters in the moon, which come between the sun and those
waters, and by their shadow deprive these waters of the sun's rays.
Thus those waters remain dark, not being able to reflect the solar
body.
907.
745
How the spots on the moon must have varied from what they formerly
908.
I have found, that the circles which at night seem to surround the
altitudes between the moon and our eyes. And of these halos the
largest and least red is caused by the lowest of these vapours; the
seen through two vapours. And so on, as they are higher they will
appear smaller and redder, because, between the eye and them, there
909.
If you want to prove why the moon appears larger than it is, when it
746
reaches the horizon; take a lens which is highly convex on one
surface and concave on the opposite, and place the concave side next
the eye, and look at the object beyond the convex surface; by this
included beneath the sphere of fire and outside that of water; for
this atmosphere is concave on the side next the earth, and convex
910.
I.
THE STARS.
911.
The stars are visible by night and not by day, because we are
747
articles of moisture, each of which independently, when the
ays of the sun fall upon it, reflects a radiance, and so these
or this atmosphere the sky would always display the stars against
ts darkness.
912.
Whether the stars have their light from the sun or in themselves.
nd Mercury had not a light of their own, when they come between
ur eye and the sun they would darken so much of the sun as they
ould cover from our eye. But this is false, for it is proved that
he branches do not conceal any portion of the sun from our eye.
hough they have no light of their own, do not--as has been said--
[18].
SECOND ARGUMENT.
Some say that the stars appear most brilliant at night in proportion
as they are higher up; and that if they had no light of their own,
748
the shadow of the earth which comes between them and the sun, would
darken them, since they would not face nor be faced by the solar
body. But those persons have not considered that the conical shadow
of the earth cannot reach many of the stars; and even as to those it
little of the star's mass, and all the rest is illuminated by the
sun.
Footnote: From this and other remarks (see No. 902) it is clear
13.
Why the planets appear larger in the East than they do overhead,
whereas the contrary should be the case, as they are 3500 miles
All the degrees of the elements, through which the images of the
celestial bodies pass to reach the eye, are equal curves and the
elsewhere does not mean unequal in the sense of not being equal to
each other, but angles which are not right angles.]; and the
749
Observations on the stars.
914.
To see the real nature of the planets open the covering and note at
instrument, perhaps the Camera obscura.] one single planet, and the
reflected movement of this base will show the nature of the said
planet; but arrange that the base may face only one at the time.
On history of astronomy.
915.
practised five hundred seventy thousand years before the Trojan war.
57000.
750
Eudoxus, Platonis auditor, in astrologia judicio doctissimorum
CICERO; and the word Astronomia he does not seem to have used at
916.
its first principles does it agree, that is with the Point and the
Line; the point may be compared to an instant of time, and the line
751
same nature; and as the divisions of the line may bear a certain
the same manuscript and this is accounted for by the text in Vol. I,
917.
definitions.
918.
Divide an hour into 3000 parts, and this you can do with a clock by
XVI.
Physical Geography.
752
structure of the globe, the primitive state of the earth's surface,
now in the Library of the Barberini palace at Rome and was published
CARDINALI, Bologna 1828. In this work the texts are arranged under
Del moto dell'acqua; Libr. III. Dell'onda dell'acqua; Libr. IV. Dei
and I have actually arranged the texts in accordance with the clue
753
referring to the subject (No. 920). The text given as No. 930
in se).
so forth (No. 920, Books 10, 11 and 12); but those passages in
canal-making in general.
On one point only can the collection of passages included under the
comparing and sorting the materials for this work I took particular
754
was mentioned even incidentally, since in all such researches the
Danube, on England and Flanders, must have been obtained from maps
himself acknowledges this (see No. 1008). But that most of the
Leonardo himself, may be safely assumed from their method and the
recorded observations.
I.
INTRODUCTION.
919.
755
in its motions; the others treat of the effects of its currents,
920.
Book 4 of rivers.
Book 7 of gravels.
756
Book 11 of conduits.
Book 12 of canals.
921.
waters, and the second by salt waters, and the third, how by the
disappearance of these, our parts of the world were made lighter and
922.
First write of all water, in each of its motions; then describe all
propositions concerning the said waters; and let the order be good,
Describe all the forms taken by water from its greatest to its
757
smallest wave, and their causes.
923.
924.
925.
releasing waters.
A book showing how the waters safely bring down timber cut in the
mountains.
the waters.
758
not be damaged by them.
926.
A book of the mountains, which would stand forth and become land, if
A book of the earth carried down by the waters to fill up the great
A book of the ways in which a tempest may of itself clear out filled
up sea-ports.
A book of how to deal with rivers, so that they may keep their
bottom scoured by their own flow near the cities they pass.
the rivers.
759
A book of the formation of hills of sand or gravel at great depths
in water.
927.
fordable.
A book of the waters which with various currents pass through seas.
water.
of different forms.
760
A book of preventing small rivers from diverting the larger one into
A book of the lowest level which can be found in the current of the
surface of rivers.
A book of the origin of rivers which flow from the high tops of
mountains.
928.
761
[3] A book of water contained in vessels with air, and of its
movements.
[5] A book of the meetings and union of waters coming from different
directions.
[6] A book of the various forms of the banks through which rivers
pass.
[7] A book of the various forms of shoals formed under the sluices
of rivers.
rivers.
[9] A book of the various places whence the waters of rivers are
derived.
their permanency.
762
[12] Abook of the course of water when it is impeded in various
places.
[12] A book of the various forms of the obstacles which impede the
course of waters.
repairing them.
[16] Abook of creating currents for rivers, which quit their beds,
General introduction.
929.
By the ancients man has been called the world in miniature; and
763
composed of earth, water, air and fire, his body resembles that of
the earth; and as man has in him bones the supports and framework of
his flesh, the world has its rocks the supports of the earth; as man
has in him a pool of blood in which the lungs rise and fall in
breathing, so the body of the earth has its ocean tide which
likewise rises and falls every six hours, as if the world breathed;
as in that pool of blood veins have their origin, which ramify all
over the human body, so likewise the ocean sea fills the body of the
earth with infinite springs of water. The body of the earth lacks
sinews and this is, because the sinews are made expressely for
I.
930.
Define first what is meant by height and depth; also how the
764
solid weight and by liquid weight; but first what weight and
lightness are in themselves. Then describe why water moves, and why
its motion ceases; then why it becomes slower or more rapid; besides
this, how it always falls, being in contact with the air but lower
than the air. And how water rises in the air by means of the heat of
the sun, and then falls again in rain; again, why water springs
forth from the tops of mountains; and if the water of any spring
higher than the ocean can pour forth water higher than the surface
of that ocean. And how all the water that returns to the ocean is
higher than the sphere of waters. And how the waters of the
equatorial seas are higher than the waters of the North, and higher
beneath the body of the sun than in any part of the equatorial
circle; for experiment shows that under the heat of a burning brand
the water near the brand boils, and the water surrounding this
ebullition always sinks with a circular eddy. And how the waters of
the North are lower than the other seas, and more so as they become
931.
OF WHAT IS WATER.
Among the four elements water is the second both in weight and in
instability.
765
932.
Sea is the name given to that water which is wide and deep, in which
the subject.]
933.
The centres of the sphere of water are two, one universal and common
to all water, the other particular. The universal one is that which
rivers, lakes, stagnant pools and seas, which, although they are at
equally distant from the centre of the earth, such as lakes placed
at the tops of high mountains; as the lake near Pietra Pana and the
lake of the Sybil near Norcia; and all the lakes that give rise to
great rivers, as the Ticino from Lago Maggiore, the Adda from the
766
lake of Como, the Mincio from the lake of Garda, the Rhine from the
lakes of Constance and of Chur, and from the lake of Lucerne, like
the Tigris which passes through Asia Minor carrying with it the
which the highest is Munace, the middle one Pallas, and the lowest
Triton; the Nile again flows from three very high lakes in Ethiopia.
we may read Norchia, the remains of the Etruscan city near Viterbo,
934.
The centre of the sphere of waters is the true centre of the globe
of our world, which is composed of water and earth, having the shape
the ocean, and not equidistant from the surface of the earth; for it
still waters. And every part of the earth that rises above the water
767
935.
sea-mud, bear witness to the changes of the earth round the centre
friction of their waters at the bottom and on their shores; and this
shells, which lie on the surface of the marine mud, and which were
produced there when the salt waters covered them; and these strata
were covered over again from time to time, with mud of various
more or less extent; and thus these layers of mud became raised to
such a height, that they came up from the bottom to the air. At the
present time these bottoms are so high that they form hills or high
mountains, and the rivers, which wear away the sides of these
mountains, uncover the strata of these shells, and thus the softened
side of the earth continually rises and the antipodes sink closer to
the centre of the earth, and the ancient bottoms of the seas have
936.
768
Let the earth make whatever changes it may in its weight, the
surface of the sphere of waters can never vary in its equal distance
938).
937.
Some assert that it is true that the earth, which is not covered by
water is much less than that covered by water. But considering the
938.
OF THE EARTH.
The great elevations of the peaks of the mountains above the sphere
of the water may have resulted from this that: a very large portion
of the earth which was filled with water that is to say the vast
cavern inside the earth may have fallen in a vast part of its vault
course of the springs which continually wear away the place where
769
they pass.
and Gomorrah.
the visible portion of the sea does not show this; so that there
must be a great deal of water inside the earth, besides that which
rises into the lower air and which flows through rivers and springs.
939.
Of the figures of the elements; and first as against those who deny
the opinions of Plato, and who say that if the elements include one
vacuum one within the other. I say it is not true, and I here prove
770
of that which is included. We see that the sphere of the waters
that, far from investing the earth when that was in the form of a
cube that is of 8 angles as Plato will have it, that it invests the
earth which has innumerable angles of rock covered by the water and
between the earth and water; again, the air invests the sphere of
waters together with the mountains and valleys, which rise above
that sphere, and no vacuum remains between the earth and the air, so
But to Plato I would reply that the surface of the figures which
940.
PROVES HOW THE EARTH IS NOT GLOBULAR AND NOT BEING GLOBULAR
CANNOT
We see the Nile come from Southern regions and traverse various
771
allowed to the course of rivers in general, we shall find that the
Nile must have its mouth ten miles lower than its source. Again, we
see the Rhine, the Rhone and the Danube starting from the German
parts, almost the centre of Europe, and having a course one to the
East, the other to the North, and the last to Southern seas. And if
you consider all this you will see that the plains of Europe in
their aggregate are much higher than the high peaks of the maritime
mountains; think then how much their tops must be above the sea
shores.
941.
Where there is life there is heat, and where vital heat is, there is
element of fire by its heat always draws to itself damp vapours and
lakes and rivers and damp valleys; and these being drawn by degrees
as far as the cold region, the first portion stops, because heat and
moisture cannot exist with cold and dryness; and where the first
portion stops the rest settle, and thus one portion after another
being added, thick and dark clouds are formed. They are often wafted
about and borne by the winds from one region to another, where by
772
their density they become so heavy that they fall in thick rain; and
if the heat of the sun is added to the power of the element of fire,
the clouds are drawn up higher still and find a greater degree of
cold, in which they form ice and fall in storms of hail. Now the
rain from the clouds, draws them from below upwards, from the foot
of the mountains, and leads and holds them within the summits of the
cause rivers.
The relative height of the surface of the sea to that of the land
(942-945).
942.
ends at the sea, and since in fact the dry land that is uncovered is
motion--as the river does move, this place is a slope rather than a
would go down beneath the sea, whence it follows that the sea a c
773
b looks higher than the dry land.
943.
OF CERTAIN PERSONS WHO SAY THE WATERS WERE HIGHER THAN THE DRY
LAND.
of men. And this is that all are agreed that the surface of the sea
is higher than the highest peaks of the mountains; and they allege
many vain and childish reasons, against which I will allege only one
simple and short reason; We see plainly that if we could remove the
shores of the sea, it would invest the whole earth and make it a
perfect sphere. Now, consider how much earth would be carried away
to enable the waves of the sea to cover the world; therefore that
944.
THE OPINION OF SOME PERSONS WHO SAY THAT THE WATER OF SOME
SEAS IS
774
WATER WAS FORCED UP TO THESE SUMMITS.
Water would not move from place to place if it were not that it
from the mountain came to light. And that portion of the sea which,
in your vain imagining, you say was so high that it flowed over the
swallowed up and poured out again through the issue from these
mountains. You can well imagine that all the time that Tigris and
Euphrates
945.
believed that all the water of the ocean has passed very many times
through these mouths. And do you not believe that the Nile must have
sent more water into the sea than at present exists of all the
element of water? Undoubtedly, yes. And if all this water had fallen
away from this body of the earth, this terrestrial machine would
long since have been without water. Whence we may conclude that the
water goes from the rivers to the sea, and from the sea to the
rivers, thus constantly circulating and returning, and that all the
sea and the rivers have passed through the mouth of the Nile an
775
ruine?]". He renders this "Le Tigre et l'Euphrate se sont deverses
tu ne crois pas que le Nil ait mis plus d'eau dans la mer qu'il n'y
II.
ON THE OCEAN.
947).
946.
Pliny says in his second book, chapter 103, that the water of the
sea is salt because the heat of the sun dries up the moisture and
drinks it up; and this gives to the wide stretching sea the savour
sea were caused by the heat of the sun, there can be no doubt that
lakes, pools and marshes would be so much the more salt, as their
776
waters have less motion and are of less depth; but experience shows
us, on the contrary, that these lakes have their waters quite free
from salt. Again it is stated by Pliny in the same chapter that this
saltness might originate, because all the sweet and subtle portions
which the heat attracts easily being taken away, the more bitter and
coarser part will remain, and thus the water on the surface is
fresher than at the bottom [Footnote 22: Compare No. 948.]; but this
is contradicted by the same reason given above, which is, that the
same thing would happen in marshes and other waters, which are dried
up by the heat. Again, it has been said that the saltness of the sea
is the sweat of the earth; to this it may be answered that all the
salt. But the conclusion is, that the saltness of the sea must
proceed from the many springs of water which, as they penetrate into
the earth, find mines of salt and these they dissolve in part, and
carry with them to the ocean and the other seas, whence the clouds,
the begetters of rivers, never carry it up. And the sea would be
salter in our times than ever it was at any time; and if the
adversary were to say that in infinite time the sea would dry up or
the earth by the setting free of that part of the earth which rises
out of the sea with the salt it has acquired, and the rivers return
[Footnote: See PLINY, Hist. Nat. II, CIII [C]. Itaque Solis ardore
777
cuncta sorbensque. (cp. CIV.) Sic mari late patenti saporem
incoqui salis, aut quia exhausto inde dulci tenuique, quod facillime
quod mare terrae sudor sit aeternus: aut quia plurimum ex arido
misceatur illi vapore: aut quia terrae natura sicut medicatas aquas
947.
For the third and last reason we will say that salt is in all
created things; and this we learn from water passed over the ashes
and cinders of burnt things; and the urine of every animal, and the
superfluities issuing from their bodies, and the earth into which
must be admitted that its population will also be eternal; hence the
human species has eternally been and would be consumers of salt; and
778
if all the mass of the earth were to be turned into salt, it would
not suffice for all human food [Footnote 27: That is, on the
everlasting like the world, or that it dies and is born again like
the men who devour it. But as experience teaches us that it does not
die, as is evident by fire, which does not consume it, and by water
and as much salt is thus got rid of as is carried every year into
We will say that the rains which penetrate the earth are what is
under the foundations of cities with their inhabitants, and are what
taken from the sea; and that the change in the place of the sea,
which has been over all the mountains, caused it to be left there in
948.
779
The waters of the salt sea are fresh at the greatest depths.
949.
The ocean does not penetrate under the earth, and this we learn from
the many and various springs of fresh water which, in many parts of
the ocean make their way up from the bottom to the surface. The same
from the said ocean, which fill with fresh water; and this happens
because the fresh water is lighter than salt water and consequently
more penetrating.
FRESH WATER PENETRATES MORE AGAINST SALT WATER THAN SALT WATER
That fresh water penetrates more against salt water, than salt water
against fresh is proved by a thin cloth dry and old, hanging with
the two opposite ends equally low in the two different waters, the
how much higher the fresh water will rise in this piece of linen
than the salt; by so much is the fresh lighter than the salt.
780
On the formation of Gulfs (950. 951).
950.
All inland seas and the gulfs of those seas, are made by rivers
951.
All the lakes and all the gulfs of the sea and all inland seas are
due to rivers which distribute their waters into them, and from
Africa from Europe and Europe from Asia by means of the Nile and the
Don which pour their waters into it. It is asked what impediment is
great enough to stop the course of the waters which do not reach the
ocean.
(952-954).
952.
781
OF WAVES.
A wave of the sea always breaks in front of its base, and that
portion of the crest will then be lowest which before was highest.
953.
That the shores of the sea constantly acquire more soil towards the
middle of the sea; that the rocks and promontories of the sea are
constantly being ruined and worn away; that the Mediterranean seas
will in time discover their bottom to the air, and all that will be
left will be the channel of the greatest river that enters it; and
this will run to the ocean and pour its waters into that with those
954.
How the river Po, in a short time might dry up the Adriatic sea in
782
955.
Look whether the sea is at its greatest flow when the moon is half
956.
Whether the flow and ebb are caused by the moon or the sun, or are
the breathing of this terrestrial machine. That the flow and ebb are
explanation of the ebb and flow given in the Edda. Utgardloki says
to Thor (Gylfaginning 48): "When thou wert drinking out of the horn,
which I should not have believed possible: the other end of the horn
lay in the sea, which thou sawest not; but when thou shalt go to the
sea, thou shalt see how much thou hast drunk out of it. And that men
783
957.
Book 9 of the meeting of rivers and their flow and ebb. The cause is
958.
All seas have their flow and ebb in the same period, but they seem
to vary because the days do not begin at the same time throughout
begins the day, which follows the night from the opposite side.
one and the same space of time, are seen to vary from the above
mentioned causes. The waters are then withdrawn into the fissures
which start from the depths of the sea and which ramify inside the
constantly taking from the bottom of the sea the water which has
flowed into it. A sea of water is incessantly being drawn off from
784
the surface of the sea. And if you should think that the moon,
rising at the Eastern end of the Mediterranean sea must there begin
must at once see the effect of it at the Eastern end of that sea.
the flow and ebb only occur 4 times in 24 hours, these results would
not agree with the time of 24 hours, unless this Mediterranean sea
behind the moon, the rush of the water through that strait would be
so great, and would rise to such a height, that beyond the straits
it would for many miles rush so violently into the ocean as to cause
pass through. This agitated ocean would afterwards return the waters
it had received with equal fury to the place they had come from, so
that no one ever could pass through those straits. Now experience
shows that at every hour they are passed in safety, but when the
wind sets in the same direction as the current, the strong ebb
of Gibraltar.]. The sea does not raise the water that has issued
from the straits, but it checks them and this retards the tide; then
it makes up with furious haste for the time it has lost until the
785
end of the ebb movement.
959.
That the flow and ebb are not general; for on the shore at Genoa
because all the waters from the rivers that flow into the Adriatic
pass there.
than 2 1/2 feet, and that only in stormy weather, but the current is
all the stronger. When Leonardo accounts for this by the southward
flow of all the Italian rivers along the coasts, the explanation is
it.]
960.
In the West, near to Flanders, the sea rises and decreases every 6
786
hours about 20 braccia, and 22 when the moon is in its favour; but
cannot have the moon for its cause. This variation in the increase
and decrease of the sea every 6 hours may arise from the damming up
quantity of rivers from Africa, Asia and Europe, which flow into
that sea, and the waters which are given to it by those rivers; it
Gibraltar. Leonardo here uses the ancient names of the rocks, which
and kept high in various gulfs. These, being seas of which the
waters coming out of the straits; and this it does most against the
III.
787
SUBTERRANEAN WATER COURSES.
961.
962.
showing the depths of the sea and of the earth; the waters start
from the bottom of the seas, and ramifying through the earth they
rise to the summits of the mountains, flowing back by the rivers and
963.
The waters circulate with constant motion from the utmost depths of
the sea to the highest summits of the mountains, not obeying the
nature of heavy matter; and in this case it acts as does the blood
of animals which is always moving from the sea of the heart and
flows to the top of their heads; and here it is that veins burst--as
788
one may see when a vein bursts in the nose, that all the blood from
below rises to the level of the burst vein. When the water rushes
out of a burst vein in the earth it obeys the nature of other things
heavier than the air, whence it always seeks the lowest places. [7]
ramifications.
[Footnote: The greater part of this passage has been given as No.
964.
The same cause which stirs the humours in every species of animal
body and by which every injury is repaired, also moves the waters
965.
this arid earth; and the cause which moves it through its ramified
rises from the utmost depths of the sea to the highest tops of the
mountains, and flowing from the opened veins returns to the low
seas; then once more, and with extreme swiftness, it mounts again
789
and returns by the same descent, thus rising from the inside to the
outside, and going round from the lowest to the highest, from whence
the earth.
966.
The water of the ocean cannot make its way from the bases to the
tops of the mountains which bound it, but only so much rises as the
dryness of the mountain attracts. And if, on the contrary, the rain,
which penetrates from the summit of the mountain to the base, which
is the boundary of the sea, descends and softens the slope opposite
to the said mountain and constantly draws the water, like a syphon
[Footnote 11: Cicognola, Syphon. See Vol. I, Pl. XXIV, No. 1.] which
pours through its longest side, it must be this which draws up the
water of the sea; thus if s n were the surface of the sea, and the
Syphon. See Vol. I, Pl. XXIV, No. 1.]. And at all times the water
which has softened the mountain, by the great rain which runs down
790
its longest side together with the water from the sea, if that side
967.
and that the tops of the mountains are farther from this centre in
the body of the earth were not like that of man, it would be
impossible that the waters of the sea--being so much lower than the
keeps the blood at the top of the head in man keeps the water at the
MS. A, from which these passages are taken, was written about twenty
years earlier than the MS. Leic. (Nos. 963 and 849) and twenty-five
791
There is, in the original a sketch with No. 968 which is not
No. 982. There are veins, or branched streams, on the side of the
968.
I say that just as the natural heat of the blood in the veins keeps
it in the head of man,--for when the man is dead the cold blood
sinks to the lower parts--and when the sun is hot on the head of a
man the blood increases and rises so much, with other humours, that
by pressure in the veins pains in the head are often caused; in the
same way veins ramify through the body of the earth, and by the
the water is raised through the veins to the tops of mountains. And
this water, which passes through a closed conduit inside the body of
the mountain like a dead thing, cannot come forth from its low place
unless it is warmed by the vital heat of the spring time. Again, the
heat of the element of fire and, by day, the heat of the sun, have
power to draw forth the moisture of the low parts of the mountains
and to draw them up, in the same way as it draws the clouds and
792
969.
That many springs of salt water are found at great distances from
the sea; this might happen because such springs pass through some
mine of salt, like that in Hungary where salt is hewn out of vast
million cwt. of rock-salt are annually dug out, extends for 3000
metres from West to East, and 1150 metres from North to South.]
IV.
OF RIVERS.
970.
creatures. These come from the depth of the sea and, after many
793
bursting of these springs; and if you chose to say that the rains of
the winter or the melting of the snows in summer were the cause of
snows--because the intense heat always melts into air all the clouds
which are borne thither by the winds. And if you chose to say that
such rivers, as increase in July and August, come from the snows
which melt in May and June from the sun's approach to the snows on
India.], and that such meltings come down into certain valleys and
form lakes, into which they enter by springs and subterranean caves
because Scythia is lower than the sources of the Nile, and, besides,
Scythia is only 400 miles from the Black sea and the sources of the
Nile are 3000 miles distant from the sea of Egypt into which its
waters flow.
971.
Book 9, of the meeting of rivers and of their ebb and flow. The
794
[3] If two rivers meet together to form a straight line, and then
below two right angles take their course together, the flow and ebb
will happen now in one river and now in the other above their
[Footnote: The first two lines of this passage have already been
given as No. 957. In the margin, near line 3 of this passage, the
confluence (972-974).
972.
When a smaller river pours its waters into a larger one, and that
larger one flows from the opposite direction, the course of the
smaller river will bend up against the approach of the larger river;
and this happens because, when the larger river fills up all its bed
river, and so carries the water poured in by the smaller river with
its own. When the smaller river pours its waters into the larger
one, which runs across the current at the mouth of the smaller
river, its waters will bend with the downward movement of the larger
795
Mugnone.]
973.
and wider at the point; like the current a n and the current d
say, that when it is in this condition if, before the fullest time,
full of sand and mud. When the water d n falls, it will carry away
the mud and remain with a lower bottom, and the channel a n
finding itself the higher, will fling its waters into the lower, d
n, and will wash away all the point of the sand-spit b n c, and
thus the angle a c d will remain larger than the angle a n d and
ceppo."]
974.
WATER.
796
OF THE MOVEMENT OF A SUDDEN RUSH MADE BY A RIVER IN ITS BED
PREVIOUSLY DRY.
draining of the lake is slow or rapid in the dry river bed, so will
than another, according to this proposition: the flow and ebb of the
sea which enters the Mediterranean from the ocean, and of the rivers
which meet and struggle with it, will raise their waters more or
form islands.]
Whirlpools.
975.
precipitated waters.
976.
797
The subterranean channels of waters, like those which exist between
the air and the earth, are those which unceasingly wear away and
977.
stones in its bed, which still have some of their angles and sides,
and in the course of its flow it carries down smaller stones with
the angles more worn; that is to say the large stones become
and as it proceeds this becomes coarse sand and then finer, and
going on thus the water, turbid with sand and gravel, joins the sea;
and the sand settles on the sea-shores, being cast up by the salt
almost like water, and it will not stop on the shores of the sea but
when the weather is calm, settles and becomes solid at the bottom of
smoothness resists the waves which glide over it; and in this shells
798
978.
All the torrents of water flowing from the mountains to the sea
carry with them the stones from the hills to the sea, and by the
thrown back towards the mountains, and as the waters rose and
angles hit together; then as the parts, which least resisted the
blows, were worn off, the stones ceased to be angular and became
round in form, as may be seen on the banks of the Elsa. And those
remained larger which were less removed from their native spot; and
they became smaller, the farther they were carried from that place,
so that in the process they were converted into small pebbles and
then into sand and at last into mud. After the sea had receded from
the mountains the brine left by the sea with other humours of the
earth made a concretion of these pebbles and this sand, so that the
pebbles were converted into rock and the sand into tufa. And of this
Como and in the Ticino, the Adige and the Oglio coming from the
German Alps, and in the Arno at Monte Albano [Footnote 13: At the
Monte Lupo and Capraia where the rocks, which are very large, are
799
V.
ON MOUNTAINS.
979.
980.
That the Northern bases of some Alps are not yet petrified. And this
is plainly to be seen where the rivers, which cut through them, flow
towards the North; where they cut through the strata in the living
stone in the higher parts of the mountains; and, where they join the
the valley of Lamona where the river Lamona, as it issues from the
That the rivers have all cut and divided the mountains of the great
Alps one from the other. This is visible in the order of the
800
stratified rocks, because from the summits of the banks, down to the
mountains are all layers of clay, deposited one above the other by
the various floods of the rivers. That the different size of the
981.
below; the depths of the valleys which are above the sphere of the
In an equal period, the valleys sink much more than the mountains
rise.
982.
801
In every concavity at the summit of the mountains we shall always
983.
I find that of old, the state of the earth was that its plains were
all covered up and hidden by salt water. [Footnote: This passage has
984.
Since things are much more ancient than letters, it is no marvel if,
countries; and if, moreover, some records had existed, war and
the testimony of things created in the salt waters, and found again
802
VI.
GEOLOGICAL PROBLEMS.
985.
In this work you have first to prove that the shells at a thousand
they are seen to be all at one level, and many mountains are seen to
be above that level; and to inquire whether the deluge was caused by
rain or by the swelling of the sea; and then you must show how,
the mountains by the sea, nor have carried there by the rivers
986.
A DOUBTFUL POINT.
Here a doubt arises, and that is: whether the deluge, which happened
at the time of Noah, was universal or not. And it would seem not,
for the reasons now to be given: We have it in the Bible that this
803
and that this rain rose to ten cubits above the highest mountains in
the world. And if it had been that the rain was universal, it would
of its sphere; hence the sphere of the waters being under the same
else to say that all this water was evaporated by the heat of the
sun.
[Footnote: The passages, here given from the MS. Leic., have
to be found in MS. F 8oa and 8ob; but as compared with the fuller
pages 218--221, has printed the text of F 80a and 80b, therefore it
work.]
804
987.
If you were to say that the shells which are to be seen within the
confines of Italy now, in our days, far from the sea and at such
heights, had been brought there by the deluge which left them there,
I should answer that if you believe that this deluge rose 7 cubits
have been left on the mountains; and not such a little way from the
foot of the mountains; nor all at one level, nor in layers upon
layers. And if you were to say that these shells are desirous of
height, the shells quitted their first home, and followed the
that the cockle is an animal of not more rapid movement than the
805
time. And if you say that the waves carried them there, by their
gravity they could not move, excepting at the bottom. And if you
will not grant me this, confess at least that they would have to
stay at the summits of the highest mountains, in the lakes which are
is here a slip of the pen since the the words in the MS. are: "Come
And if you should say that the shells were carried by the waves,
being empty and dead, I say that where the dead went they were not
far removed from the living; for in these mountains living ones are
found, which are recognisable by the shells being in pairs; and they
are in a layer where there are no dead ones; and a little higher up
they are found, where they were thrown by the waves, all the dead
ones with their shells separated, near to where the rivers fell into
the sea, to a great depth; like the Arno which fell from the
gravel which may still be seen, and which has agglomerated; and of
806
conglomerate a tufa has been formed, where it turned towards Castel
Florentino; farther on, the mud was deposited in which the shells
lived, and which rose in layers according to the levels at which the
turbid Arno flowed into that sea. And from time to time the bottom
seen in the cutting at Colle Gonzoli, laid open by the Arno which is
wearing away the base of it; in which cutting the said layers of
various marine objects are found there. And if the earth of our
through the rift between Gibraltar and Ceuta; and all the more the
higher it rose, because the weight of the waters which were thus
lost would be added to the earth in the other hemisphere. And if the
shells had been carried by the muddy deluge they would have been
mixed up, and separated from each other amidst the mud, and not in
The marine shells were not produced away from the sea.
988.
As to those who say that shells existed for a long time and were
born at a distance from the sea, from the nature of the place and of
807
place the animals all on one line, except those of the same sort and
age; and not the old with the young, nor some with an operculum and
others without their operculum, nor some broken and others whole,
nor some filled with sea-sand and large and small fragments of other
shells inside the whole shells which remained open; nor the claws of
crabs without the rest of their bodies; nor the shells of other
them; since the traces of their track still remain, on the outside,
after the manner of worms in the wood which they ate into. Nor would
there be found among them the bones and teeth of fish which some
been thrown on the sea shore. And the deluge cannot have carried
them there, because things that are heavier than water do not float
they had not been carried there by the water, such a thing being
impossible from their weight. In places where the valleys have not
been filled with salt sea water shells are never to be seen; as is
bank which kept the river pent up, in such a way that before it
could flow into the sea, which was afterwards at its foot, it formed
two great lakes; of which the first was where we now see the city of
808
followed the rest of its bank as far as where Serravalle now stands.
>From the Val d'Arno upwards, as far as Arezzo, another lake was
formed, which discharged its waters into the former lake. It was
closed at about the spot where now we see Girone, and occupied the
This valley received on its bottom all the soil brought down by the
Magno; it there lies very high where the rivers have not worn it
away. Across this land are to be seen the deep cuts of the rivers
that have passed there, falling from the great mountain of Prato
marine soil. This lake was joined with that of Perugia [Footnote:
A great quantity of shells are to be seen where the rivers flow into
the sea, because on such shores the waters are not so salt owing to
the admixture of the fresh water, which is poured into it. Evidence
rivers into the Adriatic sea; for there in most places great
with bluish marine clay; and all the rocks which are torn off in
such places are full of shells. The same may be observed to have
been done by the Arno when it fell from the rock of Gonfolina into
the sea, which was not so very far below; for at that time it was
higher than the top of San Miniato al Tedesco, since at the highest
summit of this the shores may be seen full of shells and oysters
809
within its flanks. The shells did not extend towards Val di Nievole,
because the fresh waters of the Arno did not extend so far.
That the shells were not carried away from the sea by the deluge,
because the waters which came from the earth although they drew the
sea towards the earth, were those which struck its depths; because
the water which goes down from the earth, has a stronger current
enters beneath the sea water and stirs the depths and carries with
proportion as the water which comes from the land is muddier than
way of getting the said shells so far in land, unless they had been
born there. If you were to tell me that the river Loire [Footnote:
covers when the sea rises more than eighty miles of country, because
and shells are found in this plain at the distance of 80 miles from
the sea; here I answer that the flow and ebb in our Mediterranean
Sea does not vary so much; for at Genoa it does not rise at all, and
at Venice but little, and very little in Africa; and where it varies
810
where the current is impeded; it behaves as it does where it is
989.
I say that the deluge could not carry objects, native to the sea, up
could not have occurred because it would cause a vacuum; and if you
were to say that the air would rush in there, we have already
rain water, so that all these waters ran to the sea, and the sea did
not run up the mountains; and as they ran to the sea, they thrust
the shells from the shore of the sea and did not draw them to wards
themselves. And if you were then to say that the sea, raised by the
already said that things heavier than water cannot rise upon it, but
remain at the bottom of it, and do not move unless by the impact of
811
the waves. And if you were to say that the waves had carried them to
such high spots, we have proved that the waves in a great depth move
this is shown by the turbidity of the sea from the earth washed down
near its shores. Anything which is lighter than the water moves with
the waves, and is left on the highest level of the highest margin of
the waves. Anything which is heavier than the water moves, suspended
in it, between the surface and the bottom; and from these two
that the waves of the surface cannot convey shells, since they are
If the deluge had to carry shells three hundred and four hundred
miles from the sea, it would have carried them mixed with various
oysters all together, and sea-snails, and cuttlefish, and all the
dead; and the solitary shells are found wide apart from each other,
of very large shells joined together and among them very many which
still have the covering attached, indicating that they were left
here by the sea, and still living when the strait of Gibraltar was
sticking to the rocks there. When I was making the great horse for
812
peasants; these were found in that place and among them were many
found of wrought beams and already black. Such were found in my time
deep place before the sand carried by the Arno into the sea, then
covering the plain, had heen raised to such a height; and before the
And if you were to say that these shells were created, and were
and of the heavens which might have some influence there, such an
opinion cannot exist in a brain of much reason; because here are the
years of their growth, numbered on their shells, and there are large
and small ones to be seen which could not have grown without food,
and could not have fed without motion--and here they could not move
990.
That in the drifts, among one and another, there are still to be
found the traces of the worms which crawled upon them when they were
813
not yet dry. And all marine clays still contain shells, and the
shells are petrified together with the clay. From their firmness and
unity some persons will have it that these animals were carried up
also find the bones of fishes which have taken a long time to grow;
and as if, we could not count, in the shells of cockles and snails,
and oxen, and in the branches of plants that have never been cut in
any part. Besides, having proved by these signs the length of their
could not live without moving to fetch their food; and we find in
find them enclosed. But how could we find in a large snail shell the
sorts, if they had not been thrown there, when dead, by the waves of
the sea like the other light objects which it throws on the earth?
Why do we find so many fragments and whole shells between layer and
layer of stone, if this had not formerly been covered on the shore
these parts of the sea, you might find these shells at the boundary
of one drift but not at the boundary between many drifts. We must
also account for the winters of the years during which the sea
814
neighbouring rivers, by washing down the shores; and if you chose to
say that there were several deluges to produce these rifts and the
shells among them, you would also have to affirm that such a deluge
took place every year. Again, among the fragments of these shells,
where all the shells were thrown up, broken, and divided, and never
in pairs, since they are found alive in the sea, with two valves,
each serving as a lid to the other; and in the drifts of rivers and
on the shores of the sea they are found in fragments. And within the
limits of the separate strata of rocks they are found, few in number
and in pairs like those which were left by the sea, buried alive in
991.
And if you choose to say that it was the deluge which carried these
shells away from the sea for hundreds of miles, this cannot have
naturally forces the rivers to rush towards the sea with all the
things they carry with them, and not to bear the dead things of the
sea shores to the mountains. And if you choose to say that the
deluge afterwards rose with its waters above the mountains, the
movement of the sea must have been so sluggish in its rise against
the currents of the rivers, that it could not have carried, floating
upon it, things heavier than itself; and even if it had supported
815
various spots. But how are we to account for the corals which are
found every day towards Monte Ferrato in Lombardy, with the holes of
of rivers? These rocks are all covered with stocks and families of
oysters, which as we know, never move, but always remain with one of
their halves stuck to a rock, and the other they open to feed
not find that the sand mixed with seaweed has been petrified,
because the weed which was mingled with it has shrunk away, and this
992.
Why do we find the bones of great fishes and oysters and corals and
993.
You now have to prove that the shells cannot have originated if not
in salt water, almost all being of that sort; and that the shells in
made at various times. And they all occur in valleys that open
816
towards the seas.
994.
>From the two lines of shells we are forced to say that the earth
indignantly submerged under the sea and so the first layer was made;
the same sheet are the passages No. 1217 and 1219. Compare also No.
1339. All the foregoing chapters are from Manuscripts of about 1510.
VII.
ON THE ATMOSPHERE.
995.
That the brightness of the air is occasioned by the water which has
lighted by the sun from the opposite side, reflect the brightness
817
caused by the darkness that is hidden beyond the air. [Footnote:
996.
strike upon the waters and scoop them out in a great hollow, whirl
the water into the air in the form of a column, and of the colour of
a cloud. And I saw this thing happen on a sand bank in the Arno,
where the sand was hollowed out to a greater depth than the stature
of a man; and with it the gravel was whirled round and flung about
bell-tower; and the top spread like the branches of a pine tree, and
then it bent at the contact of the direct wind, which passed over
997.
The element of fire acts upon a wave of air in the same way as the
earth; and their motions are in the same proportions as those of the
998.
818
OF MOTION.
I ask whether the true motion of the clouds can be known by the
sun.
999.
with this text I may here mention a hygrometer, drawn and probably
with the note: 'Modi di pesare l'arie eddi sapere quando s'a
1000.
and rational life; feathers grow upon birds and are changed every
year; hairs grow upon animals and are changed every year, excepting
some parts, like the hairs of the beard in lions, cats and their
like. The grass grows in the fields, and the leaves on the trees,
and every year they are, in great part, renewed. So that we might
819
say that the earth has a spirit of growth; that its flesh is the
soil, its bones the arrangement and connection of the rocks of which
the mountains are composed, its cartilage the tufa, and its blood
the springs of water. The pool of blood which lies round the heart
is the ocean, and its breathing, and the increase and decrease of
the blood in the pulses, is represented in the earth by the flow and
ebb of the sea; and the heat of the spirit of the world is the fire
which pervades the earth, and the seat of the vegetative soul is in
the fires, which in many parts of the earth find vent in baths and
XVII.
Topographical Notes.
820
he writes at second hand. In some cases again, although the style
these cases are not very numerous--we find, on the other hand, among
the Master's life and travels may have been throughout his
even know with certainty that he was living in Italy. Thus, from a
the topographical notes, and for this reason it seemed that it would
the view, that the MSS. in which the Topographical Notes occur are
in only a very few instances such diaries as may have been in use
during a journey. These notes are mostly found in the MSS. books of
Gibraltar, the Nile, the Taurus Mountains and the Tigris and
821
statements (see XIX Philosophy No. 987--991,) should here have made
of personal study.
822
That Florence, and its neighbourhood, where Leonardo spent his
the projects for canals, which occupied his attention for some short
time during the first ten years of the XVIth century, need not
Lombardy; and after these come notes on the city and vicinity of
the same order as in the note book used during these travels (MS.
districts drawn by Leonardo at the time are more valuable (see No.
1054 note). The names on these maps are not written from right to
left, but in the usual manner, and we are permitted to infer that
they were made in obedience to some command, possibly for the use of
doubt that these maps, which are here published for the first time,
823
the fact--among others--that we find among his manuscripts not only
the finished maps themselves but the rough sketches and studies for
the XVIth century, any maps at all approaching these in accuracy and
finish.
1034-1054. The most interesting are those which relate to the Alps
824
of the East held in his geographical studies. He never once alludes
I.
ITALY.
1001.
CANAL OF FLORENCE.
when, in the summer, the Arno lacks water, the canal may not remain
dry: and let this canal be 20 braccia wide at the bottom, and at the
top 30, and 2 braccia deep, or 4, so that two of these braccia may
flow to the mills and the meadows, which will benefit the country;
and Prato, Pistoia and Pisa, as well as Florence, will gain two
hundred thousand ducats a year, and will lend a hand and money to
this useful work; and the Lucchese the same, for the lake of Sesto
through Serravalle and make an issue into the lake; for there will
825
And know that in digging this canal where it is 4 braccia deep, it
will cost 4 dinari the square braccio; for twice the depth 6 dinari,
Firenze.] and there are but 2 banks; that is to say one from the
bottom of the trench to the surface of the edges of it, and the
other from these edges to the top of the ridge of earth which will
be raised on the margin of the bank. And if this bank were of double
the depth only the first bank will be increased, that is 4 braccia
the trench were 16 braccia wide and 4 deep, coming to 4 lire for the
1002.
>From the wall of the Arno at [the gate of] la Giustizia to the bank
of the Arno at Sardigna where the walls are, to the mills, is 7400
braccia, that is 2 miles and 1400 braccia and beyond the Arno is
5500 braccia.
826
commonly known as Porta Guelfa, Porta San Francesco del Renaio,
Porta Nuova, and Porta Reale. It was close to the Arno opposite to
1003.
By guiding the Arno above and below a treasure will be found in each
1004.
The wall of the old houses runs towards the gate of San Nicolo.
resembling that given under No.973. On the bank is written the word
lines. Four horizontal lines indicate the bridges. By the side these
vecchio); pote lung br. 152 e largo; 4. (at the Ponte alle
827
There is, in MS. W. L. 2l2b, a sketched plan of Florence, with the
--Prato--Faenza--Ghallo--Pinti--Giustitia.]
1005.
The ruined wall is 640 braccia; 130 is the wall remaining with the
1006.
They do not know why the Arno will never remain in a channel. It is
because the rivers which flow into it deposit earth where they
enter, and wear it away on the opposite side, bending the river in
that direction. The Arno flows for 6 miles between la Caprona and
Leghorn; and for 12 through the marshes, which extend 32 miles, and
16 from La Caprona up the river, which makes 48; by the Arno from
Arno.
828
[Footnote: This passage is written by the side of a map washed in
a completer map.
Vinci a livellare Arno in quello di Pisa per levallo del lilo suo.
829
XVI.} VASARI asserts: (Leonardo) fu il primo ancora, che
CXII, where the course of the Arno westward from Empoli is shown.]
1007.
The eddy made by the Mensola, when the Arno is low and the Mensola
full.
1008.
That the river which is to be turned from one place to another must
sort of floodgate should be made in the river, and then lower down
that the river may discharge itself into the channel given to it, or
that by this means it may be diverted from the place it has damaged,
830
How to protect and repair the banks washed by the water, as below
Ponte Rubaconte (Fig. 1); below [the palaces] Bisticci and Canigiani
sand bank opposite the end of the island of the Cocomeri in the
middle of the Arno (Fig. 4). [Footnote: The course of the river Arno
1009.
The canal of San Cristofano at Milan made May 3rd 1509. [Footnote:
This observation is written above a washed pen and ink drawing which
estrazione d'acqua."]
1010.
831
irrigation of the fields. A remedy for this would be to make several
one; and by making these channels the water which before was lost
issued his degree in 1493, but Leonardo's notes about this canal
were, with the exception of one (No. 1343), written about sixteen
years later.]
1011.
1012.
832
and two thirds; and here the canal is 57 braccia higher than the
water).]
1013.
833
"Presidente dell' Ufficio regolatore dell' acqua" on No. 1350. See
also the note to No. 745, 1. 12.] and the king will pay it by
1014.
CANAL.
The canal which may be 16 braccia wide at the bottom and 20 at the
braccia deep, at 4 dinari the square braccia; it will only cost 900
braccia, these 3000 braccia will lack 1/4; there remain 2250
mile. At 3 dinari the square braccio, the mile will amount to 506
1015.
To make the great canal, first make the smaller one and conduct into
834
it the waters which by a wheel will help to fill the great one.
1016.
Lodovica--acqua.
[Footnote: See Pl. CIX. The original sketch is here reduced to about
half its size. The gates of the town are here named, beginning at
the right hand and following the curved line. In the bird's eye view
to the right is the tower of San Gottardo. The square, above the
number 9147, is the Lazzaretto, which was begun in 1488. On the left
sketched Plan of Florence (see No. 1004 note) Leonardo has written
--Ticinese--Ludovica--Romana--Orientale--
1017.
835
The moat of Milan.
1018.
THE BATH.
To heat the water for the stove of the Duchess take four parts of
il Moro to whom she was married, in 1491. She died in June 1497.]
1019.
Item.
836
[Footnote: On this passage AMORETTI remarks (Memorie Storiche
AMORETTI'S views as to the mark on the MS, and the date when it was
Leonardo was in Milan at that time; this however would not prevent
Cathedral at Milan.]
1020.
its Northern side, and it descended with a slow motion down that
side, and then at once parted from that tower and carried with it
and tore away from that wall a space of 3 braccia wide and two deep;
837
and this wall was 4 braccia thick and was built of thin and small
old bricks; and this was dragged out by the vacuum which the flame
and 756, and Pl. XCV, No. 2 (explained on p. 52), Pl. C (explained
1021.
And lately over Milan towards Lago Maggiore I saw a cloud in the
the rays of the sun, which was already close to the horizon and red,
tinged the cloud with its own hue. And this cloud attracted to it
all the little clouds that were near while the large one did not
move from its place; thus it retained on its summit the reflection
large was it; and about two hours after sunset such a violent wind
838
1022.
place.
[Footnote: With these two texts, (l. 1--2 and l. 3--5 are in the
chalk.]
Note on Pavia.
1023.
The chimneys of the castle of Pavia have 6 rows of openings and from
1024.
839
On the 2nd day of February 1494. At Sforzesca I drew twenty five
[Footnote: See Pl. CX, No. 2. The rest of the notes on this page
1025.
1026.
1027.
Again if the lowest part of the bank which lies across the current
of the waters is made in deep and wide steps, after the manner of
perpendicularly from the top of such a place to the bottom, and wear
away the foundations of this bank can no longer descend with a blow
of too great a force; and I find the example of this in the stairs
840
over which the running water falls for a height of 50 braccia.
1028.
and 1/2 braccio wide, down which the water falls, so as not to wear
away anything at the end of its fall; by these steps so much soil
has come down that it has dried up a pool; that is to say it has
filled it up and a pool of great depth has been turned into meadows.
1029.
In many places there are streams of water which swell for six hours
and ebb for six hours; and I, for my part, have seen one above the
have said, in such a way as to turn the stones of two mills; and
deep pit.
near Torno, on the Eastern shore of Como. The waters still rise and
fall with the flow and ebb of the tide as Pliny described it (Epist.
841
1030.
where the river Mera flows into this lake. Here are barren and very
found the water-birds called gulls. Here grow fir trees, larches and
impossible to climb them without using hands and feet. The peasants
go there at the time of the snows with great snares to make the
bears fall down these rocks. These mountains which very closely
approach each other are parted by the river. They are to the right
and left for the distance of 20 miles throughout of the same nature.
>From mile to mile there are good inns. Above on the said river there
are waterfalls of 400 braccia in height, which are fine to see; and
VAL SASINA.
Val Sasina runs down towards Italy; this is almost the same form and
character. There grow here many mappello and there are great ruins
unknown.].
842
VALLEY OF INTROZZO.
and from here Ambrogio Fereri has his timber brought down; at the
BELLAGGIO.
Opposite the castle Bellaggio there is the river Latte, which falls
from a height of more than 100 braccia from the source whence it
VALTELLINA.
much cattle that the natives conclude that more milk than wine grows
there. This is the valley through which the Adda passes, which first
runs more than 40 miles through Germany; this river breeds the fish
sands. In this country every one can sell bread and wine, and the
wine is worth at most one soldo the bottle and a pound of veal one
soldo, and salt ten dinari and butter the same and their pound is 30
843
1031.
At BORMIO.
Pliniana, which increases and ebbs every six hours, and its swell
supplies water for two mills; and its ebbing makes the spring dry
up; two miles higher up there is Nesso, a place where a river falls
excursions are to be made in the month of May. And the largest bare
rocks that are to be found in this part of the country are the
its base an opening towards the lake, which goes down 200 steps, and
IN VAL SASINA.
going in by the road to Lecco, is the river Troggia which falls from
a very high rock, and as it falls it goes underground and the river
copper and silver near a place called Pra' Santo Pietro, and mines
844
is in this part, and it is quite bare.
and I should infer from their contents, that they were notes made in
from some person (unknown to us) who had given him an account of
them.]
1032.
The lake of Pusiano flows into the lake of Segrino [Footnote 3: The
Valle Assina, above the lake of Pusiano.] and of Annone and of Sala.
than the surface of the water of the lake of Lecco, and the lake of
the afore said 22 braccia make 42 braccia and this is the greatest
illustrate it.]
1033.
845
At Santa Maria in the Valley of Ravagnate [Footnote 2: Ravagnate
this note to prove his hypothesis that Leonardo paid two visits to
Lyon en Italie. Ce fut par le mont Viso que passerent, en aout 1515,
Marignan.
Louis XII, aurait-il ete pour quelque chose dans le plan du celebre
passage des Alpes, qui eut lieu en aout 1515, et a la suite duquel
ete appele par le jeune roi, de Rome ou l'artiste etait alors, des
14 braccia.
846
distinct from Varallo the chief town in the Val di Sesia.]
1034.
1035.
Made by the sea at Piombino. [Footnote: Below the sketch there are
1036.
1037.
The rock of Cesena. [Footnote: See Pl. XCIV No. 1, the lower sketch.
847
1038.
1039.
The bell of Siena, that is the manner of its movement, and the place
by an indistinct sketch.]
1040.
1041.
1042.
1043.
848
Windows at Cesena. [Footnote: There are four more lines of text
1044.
The way in which bastions ought to project beyond the walls of the
towers to defend the outer talus; so that they may not be taken by
artillery.
1045.
The rock of the harbour of Cesena is four points towards the South
1046.
are used, of which O the two in front are small and two high ones
because on the fore wheels more weight is laid than on those behind,
849
1047.
Thus grapes are carried at Cesena. The number of the diggers of the
refers to these first two lines. Cesena is mentioned again Fol. 82a:
1048.
1049.
1050.
Imola, as regards Bologna, is five points from the West, towards the
Castel San Piero is seen from Imola at four points from the West
850
Faenza stands with regard to Imola between East and South East at a
South East and East at a distance of 20 miles from Imola and ten
from Faenza.
1051.
Imola as regards Bologna is five points from the West towards the
7 miles.
Faenza, as regards Imola lies exactly half way between the East and
Bertinoro is seen from Imola two points from the East towards the
851
[Footnote: Leonardo inserted this passage on the margin of the
circular plan, in water colour, of Imola--see Pl. CXI No. 1.--In the
original the fields surrounding the town are light green; the moat,
Santerno, are light blue. The parts, which have come out blackish
close to the river are yellow ochre in the original. The dark groups
of houses inside the town are red. At the four points of the compass
drawn in the middle of the town Leonardo has written (from right to
West). The arch in which the plan is drawn is, in the original, 42
centimetres across.
5).
this map, which is at Windsor, with the siege of 1502 and with
comparison of these texts, Nos. 1050 and 1051, raise, I believe, the
852
hypothesis to a certainty.]
1052.
>From Bonconventi to Casa Nova are 10 miles, from Casa Nova to Chiusi
described lie within the district shown in the maps on Pl. CXIII.]
1053.
1054.
OF PAINTING.
On the tops and sides of hills foreshorten the shape of the ground
and its divisions, but give its proper shape to what is turned
maps; and all the less since the foregoing chapters clearly prove
that at a time so full of events Leonardo would only now and then
853
commit his observations to paper, in the MS. L.
here inserted a much clearer sketch of a position from the same MS.,
L. 82b and 83a. They are the only drawings of landscape, it may be
1055.
underground; and as the timber was black and fine, it seemed good to
the said Messer Gualtieri to have the mouth of the well lengthened
1056.
making lime of, but such as are mixed up with an infinite variety of
things native to the sea, which is now more than 200 miles away.
854
The Alps (1057-1062).
1057.
has promised to give me a small slab, for the colours, the second
the promise to Leonardo. The colours may have been given to the
sculptor Benedetto and the stone may have been in payment for them.
855
>From the description of the stone here given we may conclude that it
1058.
in Savoy where certain forests sank in and left a very deep gap, and
about four miles from here the earth opened itself like a gulf in
the mountain, and threw out a sudden and immense flood of water
overflowed.
1059.
The river Arve, a quarter of a mile from Geneva in Savoy, where the
1060.
And this may be seen, as I saw it, by any one going up Monbroso
856
[Footnote: I have vainly enquired of every available authority for a
Monboso (Comp. Vol. I Nos. 300 and 301). It seems most obvious to
refer it to Monte Rosa. ROSA derived from the Keltic ROS which
thus Monte Rosa would mean literally the High Peak.], a peak of the
Alps which divide France from Italy. The base of this mountain gives
great a height as this, which lifts itself above almost all the
clouds; and snow seldom falls there, but only hail in the summer,
when the clouds are highest. And this hail lies [unmelted] there, so
that if it were not for the absorption of the rising and falling
clouds, which does not happen more than twice in an age, an enormous
the middle of July I found it very considerable; and I saw the sky
above me quite dark, and the sun as it fell on the mountain was far
atmosphere lay between the summit of the mountain and the sun.
Leic. 9b]
1061.
857
In the mountains of Verona the red marble is found all mixed with
cockle shells turned into stone; some of them have been filled at
the mouth with the cement which is the substance of the stone; and
in some parts they have remained separate from the mass of the rock
which enclosed them, because the outer covering of the shell had
interposed and had not allowed them to unite with it; while in other
places this cement had petrified those which were old and almost
1062.
himself says in another place that he had been in Friuli (see No.
1077 1. 19).]
1063.
That part of the earth which was lightest remained farthest from the
centre of the world; and that part of the earth became the lightest
858
over which the greatest quantity of water flowed. And therefore that
part became lightest where the greatest number of rivers flow; like
the Alps which divide Germany and France from Italy; whence issue
the Rhone flowing Southwards, and the Rhine to the North. The Danube
or Tanoia towards the North East, and the Po to the East, with
innumerable rivers which join them, and which always run turbid with
The shores of the sea are constantly moving towards the middle of
the sea and displace it from its original position. The lowest
current of the Nile, the largest river that flows into that sea. And
with it are grouped all its tributaries, which at first fell into
the sea; as may be seen with the Po and its tributaries, which first
fell into that sea, which between the Appenines and the German Alps
1064.
And of these I found some in the rocks of the high Appenines and
The frowning rock between the sources of the Arno and the Tiber, as
859
This note is written by the side of that given as No. 1020; but
their connection does not make it clear what Leonardo's purpose was
in writing it.]
1065.
1066.
in No. 1035.]
1067.
on one side they fasten a horn. This little horn becomes one and the
same with the said cavity and thus they produce by blowing into it a
very loud noise. [Footnote: As to the Romagna see also No. 1046.]
860
1068.
do not grow, hence it is evident that that spring must issue from
some abyss in Italy and then flow beneath the sea to break forth in
II.
FRANCE.
1069.
GERMANY. FRANCE.
a. Austria, a. Picardy.
b. Saxony. b. Normandy.
c. Nuremberg. c. Dauphine.
d. Flanders.
SPAIN.
a. Biscay.
861
b. Castille.
c. Galicia.
d. Portugal.
e. Taragona.
f. Granada.
1070.
[Footnote: Roana does not seem to mean here Rouen in Normandy, but
1071.
ebb, and the river there is filled with salt water for more than a
hundred and fifty miles; and the vessels which are repaired there
rest high and dry on a high hill above the sea at low tide.
862
1072.
The Rhone issues from the lake of Geneva and flows first to the West
and then to the South, with a course of 400 miles and pours its
1073.
discharges into the river. [Footnote: The tenor of this note (see
evidence as to when this note may have been written beyond the
not before the year 1505. The greater part of the magnificent
Chateau of Blois has now disappeared. Whether this note was made for
863
See S. DE LA SAUSSAYE, Histoire du Chateau de Blois 4eme edition
comte de Blois.
Le roi fit commencer, dans la meme annee, les travaux de celle belle
juillet, l'an mil cinq cent et seize. P. 24: Les jardins avaient
elevees sur les terrasses, cet edifice est tris-digne d'interet par
garden as follows: Le jardin haut etait fort bien dresse par grands
864
compartimens de toutes sortes de figures, avec des allees de
qui dans son milieu avait encore un plus petit dome, ou lanterne
865
deuxiesme bassin s'y levoit un autre petit piedestal qui portait un
1074.
The river is higher within the bank b d than outside that bank.
d, and when it has passed the bridge it turns back, against the
bank which lies between the two contrary currents of the said river,
r t. But when the river is very full it flows all in one channel
passing over the bank b d. [Footnote: See Pl. CXV. Lines 1-7 are
above, lines 8-10 in the middle of the large island and the word
866
Isola is written above d in the smaller island; a is written
sentence, the observation was made after long study of the river's
course, when Leonardo had resided for some time at, or near,
Amboise.]
1075.
1075.
be done by the inhabitants; and the timber of which their houses are
744.]. The river may be dammed up at such a height that the waters
1076.
The answer is that in one single turn the wheel could not support
867
all the water that it can raise in two turns, because at the half
turn of the wheel it would be raising 100 pounds and no more; and if
it had to raise the whole, 200 pounds in one turn, it could not
raise them unless the wheel were of double the diameter and if the
such a wheel of half the size (?) the land which it would water and
The way in which the river in its flow should scour its own channel.
By the ninth of the third; the more rapid it is, the more it wears
away its channel; and, by the converse proposition, the slower the
And let the sluice be movable like the one I arranged in Friuli
[Footnote 19: This passage reveals to us the fact that Leonardo had
visited the country of Friuli and that he had stayed there for some
one sluice was opened the water which passed through it dug out the
bottom. Therefore when the rivers are flooded, the sluices of the
mills ought to be opened in order that the whole course of the river
may pass through falls to each mill; there should be many in order
to give a greater impetus, and so all the river will be scoured. And
below the site of each of the two mills there may be one of the said
868
sluice falls; one of them may be placed below each mill.
1078.
said braccia. Each braccio is divided into 12 inches; and the water
waters in the said canals, that is one braccio and a half in the
mile. And from this it may be concluded that the water taken from
will..... Where one river by reason of its low level cannot flow
acquire a fall into the other, which was previously the higher.
Saudre, and from that bridge as far as Tours it is called the Cher.
I would test the level of that channel which is to lead from the
Loire to Romorantin, with a channel one braccio wide and one braccio
deep.
869
[Footnote: Lines 6-18 are partly reproduced in the facsimile on p.
The following names are written along the rivers on the larger
sketch, era f (the Loire) scier f (the Cher) three times. Pote
below do not belong to the map of the rivers. The following names
(Milano, 1872) Pl. XXII, and the editors remark: Forse la linia
Canale, che poi rembra prolungarsi in giu fin dove sta scritto
Lione.
M. Ravaisson has enlarged on this idea in the Gazette des Beaux Arts
870
rash, however, to found so elaborate an hypothesis on these sketches
1079.
At 1/4 from the South to the South East. At 1/3 from the South to
the South East. At 1/4 from the South to the South East. At 1/5 from
the South to the South East. Between the South West and South, to
the East bearing to the South; from the South towards the East 1/8;
thence to the West, between the South and South West; at the South.
1080.
down and putting one of the ends on the ground while they hold the
871
lines crossing each other and the words de ponderibus. The meaning
1081.
The Germans are wont to annoy a garrison with the smoke of feathers,
sulphur and realgar, and they make this smoke last 7 or 8 hours.
Likewise the husks of wheat make a great and lasting smoke; and also
dry dung; but this must be mixed with olive husks, that is olives
pressed for oil and from which the oil has been extracted.
shrouded in smoke.]
The Danube.
1082.
That the valleys were formerly in great part covered by lakes the
mountains and the wandering courses of the rivers carried away the
other plains enclosed by the mountains; and the cutting away of the
which go along Thrace and Dardania and join the Sardonius mountains
872
which, going on to the westward change their name from Sardus to
Rebi, as they come near Dalmatia; then turning to the West cross
and going on still to the West, they change to Mount Ocra in the
North; and to the South above Istria they are named Caruancas; and
to the West above Italy they join the Adula, where the Danube rises
[8], which stretches to the East and has a course of 1500 miles; its
shortest line is about l000 miles, and the same or about the same is
some places 300 miles wide; and in the midst flows the Danube, the
Poland, Hungary, Wallachia and Bosnia and then the Danube or Donau
flows into the Black Sea, which formerly extended almost to Austria
and occupied the plains through which the Danube now courses; and
many places on the sides of those mountains; and this sea was formed
extended to the East joining the spurs of the Taurus which extend to
the West. And near Bithynia the waters of this Black Sea poured into
the Propontis [Marmora] falling into the Aegean Sea, that is the
873
mountains became separated from those of the Taurus. The Black Sea
sank lower and laid bare the valley of the Danube with the above
named countries, and the whole of Asia Minor beyond the Taurus range
to the North, and the plains from mount Caucasus to the Black Sea to
the West, and the plains of the Don this side--that is to say, at
the foot of the Ural mountains. And thus the Black Sea must have
III.
1083.
ELSEWHERE.
874
This proposition is clearly proved by reason confirmed by
flows one mile in length of water; where the river is five miles
equal to the square mile of water required in the sea, and where the
river is 3 miles wide each of these square miles will require the
third of its volume to make up the amount of the square mile of the
1084.
THE EAST.
The reason is that if you put together the mouths of the rivers
which discharge into the Mediterranean sea, you would find the sum
of water to be larger than that which this sea pours through the
straits into the ocean. You see Africa discharging its rivers that
run northwards into this sea, and among them the Nile which runs
through 3000 miles of Africa; there is also the Bagrada river and
875
the Schelif and others. [Footnote 5: Bagrada (Leonardo writes
Likewise Europe pours into it the Don and the Danube, the Po, the
Rhone, the Arno, and the Tiber, so that evidently these rivers, with
and depth and current; and the sea is not wider than 18 miles at the
1085.
principal waters of Africa, Asia and Europe that flowed towards it;
and its waters came up to the foot of the mountains that surrounded
it and made its shores. And the summits of the Apennines stood up
again, behind its Atlas mountains did not expose uncovered to the
sky the surface of its vast plains about 3000 miles in length, and
Memphis [Footnote 6: Mefi. Leonardo can only mean here the citadel
of Cairo on the Mokattam hills.] was on the shores of this sea, and
above the plains of Italy, where now birds fly in flocks, fish were
1086.
Tunis.
876
The greatest ebb made anywhere by the Mediterranean is above Tunis,
being about two and a half braccia and at Venice it falls two
braccia. In all the rest of the Mediterranean sea the fall is little
or none.
1087.
Libya.
and hills, such as occur in Libya. Examples may be seen on the wide
1088.
Majorca.
shown in a sketch.]
1089.
877
Some at the Tyrrhene sea employ this method; that is to say they
fastened an anchor to one end of the yard, and to the other a cord,
of which the lower end was fastened to an anchor; and in battle they
flung this anchor on to the oars of the opponent's boat and by the
use of a capstan drew it to the side; and threw soft soap and tow,
daubed with pitch and set ablaze, on to that side where the anchor
ship had to fly to the opposite side; and in doing this they aided
to the attack, because the galley was more easily drawn to the side
IV.
THE LEVANT.
1090.
On the shores of the Mediterranean 300 rivers flow, and 40, 200
ports. And this sea is 3000 miles long. Many times has the increase
the West winds, caused the overflow of the Nile and of the rivers
which flow out through the Black Sea, and have so much raised the
seas that they have spread with vast floods over many countries. And
878
these floods take place at the time when the sun melts the snows on
the high mountains of Ethiopia that rise up into the cold regions of
the air; and in the same way the approach of the sun acts on the
gathering together of these three things are, and always have been,
the cause of tremendous floods: that is, the return flow of the sea
with the West wind and the melting of the snows. So every river will
Lebanon, and in the rest of Syria between the Lebanon and the Taurus
Pamphilia and in Lycia within the hills, and in Egypt as far as the
Atlas mountains. The gulf of Persia which was formerly a vast lake
of the Tigris and discharged into the Indian Sea, has now worn away
the mountains which formed its banks and laid them even with the
its flow through the gulf of Arabia, it would have done the same,
1091.
For a long time the water of the Mediterranean flowed out through
the Red Sea, which is 100 miles wide and 1500 long, and full of
reefs; and it has worn away the sides of Mount Sinai, a fact which
879
testifies, not to an inundation from the Indian sea beating on these
rivers which abound round the Mediterranean, and besides this there
is the reflux of the sea; and then, a cutting being made to the West
3000 miles away from this place, Gibraltar was separated from Ceuta,
which had been joined to it. And this passage was cut very low down,
in the plains between Gibraltar and the ocean at the foot of the
the legend of the pillars of Hercules.] came to open the sea to the
westward and then the sea waters began to pour into the Western
Ocean; and in consequence of this great fall, the Red Sea remained
the higher; whence the water, abandoning its course here, ever after
1092.
A mountain may have fallen and closed the mouth of the Red Sea and
thus overfilled had for outlet the passage below the mountains of
Gades; for, in our own times a similar thing has been seen [Footnote
6: Compare also No. 1336, ll. 30, 35 and 36.-- Paolo Giovio, the
880
celebrated historian (born at Como in 1483) reports that in 1513 at
earthquake, and that the mass of rocks, which fell on the left
(Western) side blocked the river Breno (T. I p. 218 and 345 of D.
and closed it up and made a lake. And thus most lakes have been made
and the Lago Maggiore. The Mediterranean fell but little on the
great deal in this passage, because before this cutting was made the
Mediterranean sea flowed to the South East, and then the fall had to
All the plains which lie between the sea and mountains were formerly
Every valley has been made by its own river; and the proportion
881
And its greatest height is in Outer Mauritania and it has a course
of ten thousand miles before it reunites with its ocean, the father
of the waters.
That is 3000 miles for the Mediterranean, 3000 for the Nile, as far
as discovered and 3000 for the Nile which flows to the East, &c.
writing leads us to conclude that this text was written later than
1093.
height, above which the clouds falling in snow give rise to the
Nile.
1094.
The Egyptians, the Ethiopians, and the Arabs, in crossing the Nile
882
with camels, are accustomed to attach two bags on the sides of the
In these four meshes of the net the camels for baggage place their
feet.
the two sacks joined by ropes, as here described, the other shows
1095.
The Tigris passes through Asia Minor and brings with it the water of
three lakes, one after the other of various elevations; the first
being Munace and the middle Pallas and the lowest Triton. And the
Nile again springs from three very high lakes in Ethiopia, and runs
northwards towards the sea of Egypt with a course of 4000 miles, and
that it issues from the Mountains of the Moon, and has various
unknown sources. The said lakes are about 4000 braccia above the
probably here intended. Compare, as to the Nile, Nos. 970, 1063 and
883
1084.]
1096.
Very many times the Nile and other very large rivers have poured out
1097.
Why does the inundation of the Nile occur in the summer, coming from
torrid countries?
1098.
Egyptian sea and that its turbidity is caused by soil that this
its shores. You see the sandy desert beyond Mount Atlas where
1099.
884
carry sacks which they can at pleasure fill with air, and which in
case of need they carry instead of the girth of the saddle above and
at the side, and they are well covered with plates of cuir bouilli,
they have not on their minds their security in flight, when the
1100.
SMALL BOATS.
The small boats used by the Assyrians were made of thin laths of
willow plaited over rods also of willow, and bent into the form of a
boat. They were daubed with fine mud soaked with oil or with
and because pine would split; and always remained fresh; and they
covered this sort of boats with the skins of oxen in safely crossing
See Lucan's Pharsalia IV, 130: Utque habuit ripas Sicoris camposque
sic cum tenet omnia Nilus, Conseritur bibula Memphitis cymbo papyro.
885
The Spaniards, the Scythians and the Arabs, when they want to make a
1101.
for more than three hours the bottom of the sea was uncovered by
reason of the water which was lost in it, and then it closed to the
former level.
886
no doubt means, was in Pamphylia and more than 150 English miles
the year 867 of the Mohamedan Era corresponding to the year 1489,
the fortress of Kerak. There are three places of this name. Kerak on
1102.
887
1103.
formed by nature at the top of a rock which may be hollowed out and
portico,
have been drawn first; there is no reason for assuming that the text
and this sketch, which have no connection with each other, are of
which was always considered by the ancients to be the home and birth
may overflow from these. And round this portico towards the North
should be a thick and shady wood; the waters at the top of the
888
pilasters should pour into vases at their base, from whence they
Starting from the shore of Cilicia towards the South you discover
1104.
>From the shore of the Southern coast of Cilicia may be seen to the
South the beautiful island of Cyprus, which was the realm of the
had their ships and rigging broken amidst the reefs, surrounded by
verdure, where the winds are tempered and fill the island and the
surrounding seas with fragrant odours. Ah! how many a ship has here
been sunk. Ah! how many a vessel broken on these rocks. Here might
be seen barks without number, some wrecked and half covered by the
sand; others showing the poop and another the prow, here a keel and
there the ribs; and it seems like a day of judgment when there
them covering all the Northern shore; and while the North gale makes
889
1105.
Write to Bartolomeo the Turk as to the flow and ebb of the Black
sea, and whether he is aware if there be such a flow and ebb in the
1106.
>From the straits of Gibraltar to the Don is 3500 miles, that is one
mile and 1/6, giving a fall of one braccio in a mile to any water
that moves gently. The Caspian sea is a great deal higher; and none
summits of our mountains might come from the height of those seas,
and of the rivers which flow into them, and which are still higher.
1107.
Hence it follows that the sea of Azov is the highest part of the
890
has 3500 braccia of descent, that is, one mile and 1/6; therefore it
The Dardanelles.
1108.
In the Bosphorus the Black Sea flows always into the Egean sea, and
the Egean sea never flows into it. And this is because the Caspian,
which is 400 miles to the East, with the rivers which pour into it,
always flows through subterranean caves into this sea of Pontus; and
the Don does the same as well as the Danube, so that the waters of
Pontus are always higher than those of the Egean; for the higher
always fall towards the lower, and never the lower towards the
higher.
Constantinople.
1109.
high above the water, 600 braccia long; that is 400 over the sea and
891
[Footnote: See Pl. CX No. 1. In 1453 by order of Sultan Mohamed II.
the Golden Horn was crossed by a pontoon bridge laid on barrels (see
essendo stato dal Turco ricercato con grandissime promesse per mezzo
for this bridge was made in 1502. We may therefore conclude that at
about that time the Sultan Bajazet II. had either announced a
The Euphrates.
892
1110.
If the river will turn to the rift farther on it will never return
to its bed, as the Euphrates does, and this may do at Bologna the
Centrae Asia.
1111.
between Bactria and India, and give birth to the river Oxus which
takes its rise in these mountains and flows 500 miles towards the
North and as many towards the West, and discharges its waters into
Xariaspes, Dargamaim, Ocus and Margus, all very large rivers. From
the opposite side towards the South rises the great river Indus
which sends its waters for 600 miles Southwards and receives as
Vandabal Bislaspus to the East, Suastes and Coe to the West, uniting
with these rivers, and with their waters it flows 800 miles to the
West; then, turning back by the Arbiti mountains makes an elbow and
side of the same mountains rises the great Ganges, which river flows
893
Southwards for 500 miles and to the Southwest a thousand ... and
1112.
Men born in hot countries love the night because it refreshes them
and have a horror of light because it burns them; and therefore they
XVIII.
Sections XVI and XVII, though they were the chief subjects of
this section, which prove that he had turned his mind to the
894
is true, as to when or where these matters came under his
consideration; but the fact remains certain both from these notes in
his manuscripts, and from the well known letter to Ludovico il Moro
work. It seems probable that the idea which led him to these
machine for man. At the same time it must be admitted that the notes
that those on the flight of birds are by far the most numerous and
XVI, No. 1 and Tav. XVIII in the "Saggio delle opere di Leonardo
printed for the first time and hitherto unknown--refer to the same
a flying machine.
895
and similar matters which fall within the department of the
Engineer, have not been included in this work, for the reasons given
the passages Nos. 1127 and 1128, because they have a more
rash to assert that Leonardo was the first to introduce the science
the earliest writers who can be proved to have known and understood
it; while, on the other hand, it is almost beyond doubt that in the
East at that time, the whole science of besieging towns and mining
fosse con maggior tuba e piu sonora di voce; laonde supero tutti i
896
The only notes on musical matters are those given as Nos. 1129
1113.
fallacious as all the others; and this is a mill wheel which touches
the waves of the sea at one end and in each complete revolution
water moves together with the ship at an equal rate, then the wheel
rapid than that of the ship, then neither has the wheel the same
between one island and another; and this is done by a board or under
897
the pressure of wind which strikes on it with more or less
distance between one island and another. But such an invention does
not succeed excepting on a ship like the one on which the experiment
was made, and it must be of the same burden and have the same sails,
and the sails in the same places, and the size of the waves must be
the same. But my method will serve for any ship, whether with oars
or low, it always serves [Footnote 52: Leonardo does not reveal the
1114.
How an army ought to cross rivers by swimming with air-bags ... How
fishes swim [Footnote 2: Compare No. 821.]; of the way in which they
898
jump out of the water, as may be seen with dolphins; and it seems a
wonderful thing to make a leap from a thing which does not resist
eels and the like. Of the mode of swimming against currents and in
round form. How it is that animals which have not long hind quartres
cannot swim. How it is that all other animals which have feet with
toes, know by nature how to swim, excepting man. In what way man
ought to learn to swim. Of the way in which man may rest on the
the water, which drag him down. How a man dragged to the bottom must
seek the reflux which will throw him up from the depths. How he
ought to move his arms. How to swim on his back. How he can and how
he cannot stay under water unless he can hold his breath [13]. How
by means of a certain machine many people may stay some time under
water, or how long I can stay without eating; and I do not publish
nor divulge these by reason of the evil nature of men who would use
ships to the bottom, and sinking them together with the men in them.
because the mouth of the tube, by which you breathe, is above the
899
On naval warfare (1115. 1116).
1115.
Supposing in a battle between ships and galleys that the ships are
victorious by reason of the high of heir tops, you must haul the
yard up almost to the top of the mast, and at the extremity of the
yard, that is the end which is turned towards the enemy, have a
then, with the capstan, haul down the opposite end of this yard and
the top on the opposite side will go up so high, that it will be far
above the round-top of the ship, and you will easily drive out the
men that are in it. But it is necessary that the men who are in the
counterpoise to the weight of the men placed inside the cage on the
yard.
1116.
If you want to build an armada for the sea employ these ships to ram
in the enemy's ships. That is, make ships 100 feet long and 8 feet
wide, but arranged so that the left hand rowers may have their oars
to the right side of the ship, and the right hand ones to the left
longer. And the said ship may be one foot and a half thick, that is
900
made with cross beams within and without, with planks in contrary
directions. And this ship must have attached to it, a foot below the
and this, by force of oars may, after it has given the first blow,
be drawn back, and driven forward again with fury give a second
blow, and then a third, and so many as to destroy the other ship.
1117.
Have a coat made of leather, which must be double across the breast,
will be double from the waist to the knee; and the leather must be
quite air-tight. When you want to leap into the sea, blow out the
skirt of your coat through the double hems of the breast; and jump
into the sea, and allow yourself to be carried by the waves; when
you see no shore near, give your attention to the sea you are in,
and always keep in your mouth the air-tube which leads down into the
coat; and if now and again you require to take a breath of fresh
air, and the foam prevents you, you may draw a breath of the air
901
the same figure, somewhat altered. 6. La canna dell' aria. Compare
1118.
If the weight of the sea bears on its bottom, a man, lying on that
bottom and having l000 braccia of water on his back, would have
1119.
1120.
Just as on a frozen river a man may run without moving his feet, so
902
direct connection with the problem as stated in words.--Compare No.
1448, l. 17.]
1121.
original.]
1122.
Man when flying must stand free from the waist upwards so as to be
resistance.
1123.
Remember that your flying machine must imitate no other than the
bat, because the web is what by its union gives the armour, or
If you imitate the wings of feathered birds, you will find a much
903
stronger structure, because they are pervious; that is, their
feathers are separate and the air passes through them. But the bat
is aided by the web that connects the whole and is not pervious.
1124.
first is the breaking of the machine. The second would be when the
centre must be very far from the other; that is, in a machine 30
braccia long the centres must be 4 braccia one from the other.
1125.
back.
904
1126.
the object. You may see that the beating of its wings against the
close to the sphere of elemental fire. Again you may see the air in
motion over the sea, fill the swelling sails and drive heavily laden
ships. From these instances, and the reasons given, a man with wings
Saggio, and in: Leonardo da Vinci als Ingenieur etc., Ein Beitrag
Of mining.
1127.
If you want to know where a mine runs, place a drum over all the
places where you suspect that it is being made, and upon this drum
put a couple of dice, and when you are over the spot where they are
mining, the dice will jump a little on the drum at every blow which
905
There are persons who, having the convenience of a river or a lake
in their lands, have made, close to the place where they suspect
countermined the enemy, and having found them, have turned the water
Of Greek fire.
1128.
GREEK FIRE.
wool, and boil them all together. This fire is so ready to burn that
strong vinegar, and mix all together and dry it in the sun, or in an
oven when the bread is taken out; and then stick it round hempen or
other tow, moulding it into a round form, and studding it all over
with very sharp nails. You must leave in this ball an opening to
Again, this fire, stuck at the top of a long plank which has one
braccio length of the end pointed with iron that it may not be burnt
906
by the said fire, is good for avoiding and keeping off the ships, so
when the men in them are intent on the battle; and then by throwing
similar burning balls upon them you have it in your power to burn
[Footnote: Venturi has given another short text about the Greek fire
qui ont ete les plus cherchees et qui sont encore les plus
907
parvenait. Suivant quelques historiens le feu gregeois etait compose
1129.
shown on Pl. CXXI. Lines 1 and 2 of the text are to be seen at the
top at the left hand side of the first sketch of a drum. Lines 3-5
side of the seventh sketch, and lines 7 and 8 at the side of the
908
eighth. Lines 9-16 are at the bottom in the middle. The remainder of
[9] Just as one and the same drum makes a deep or acute sound
parchments variously tightened on one and the same drum will make
Keys narrow and close together; (bicchi) far apart; these will be
a must enter in the place of the ordinary keys which have the ...
1130.
909
clappers with a musical round called a Canon, which is sung in four
parts; each singer singing the whole round. Therefore I here make a
wheel with 4 teeth so that each tooth takes by itself the part of a
singer.
the text, from line 6, refers. They are studies for a contrivance
1131.
Of decorations.
the decoration.
XIX.
cose naturali" and says on this point: "Per il che fece nell'animo
910
religione, stimando per avventura assai piu lo esser filosofo che
not a very serious one--and the less so, since, throughout the
that he was an atheist. His views of nature and its laws are no
(see No. 1566) that, in the year before his death, he had
Catholic faith, and this evidently from his own personal desire and
impulse.
tuttavia quanto avea offeso Dio e gli uomini del mondo, non avendo
911
Leonardo. It seems to imply that Leonardo was disdainful of diligent
natura, ecc.
name given to the warrant cases of the night police). The acquittal
occasion the Master and his pupil were again fully acquitted.
912
me desirable to give the reader this brief account of the leading
facts of the story, as the vague hints of it, which have recently
been made public, may have given to the incident an aspect which it
The passages here classed under the head "Morals" reveal Leonardo
lofty principles and aims. He could scarcely have recorded his stern
and strive only for riches, if his own life and ambitions had been
dominion over the minds not merely of the illiterate crowd, but of
have expressed them; this accounts for the argumentative tone of all
913
Polemics, have been included in this section as occur as independent
far closer in places where they have appeared already, than it would
be here.
I.
PHILOSOPHICAL MAXIMS.
1132.
I obey Thee Lord, first for the love I ought, in all reason to bear
Thee; secondly for that Thou canst shorten or prolong the lives of
men.
1133.
A PRAYER.
914
Thou, O God, dost sell us all good things at the price of labour.
1134.
permitted that any force should fail of the order or quality of its
necessary results.
1135.
Necessity is the theme and the inventress, the eternal curb and law
of nature.
1136.
In many cases one and the same thing is attracted by two strong
forces, namely Necessity and Potency. Water falls in rain; the earth
absorbs it from the necessity for moisture; and the sun evaporates
1137.
915
Weight, force and casual impulse, together with resistance, are the
1138.
1139.
Psychology (1140-1147).
1140.
And you, O Man, who will discern in this work of mine the wonderful
destroy it, reflect how much more criminal it is to take the life of
will and pleasure, and let not your rage or malice destroy a
life--for indeed, he who does not value it, does not himself deserve
916
non la merita.].
Pl. CVII. Compare No. 798, 35 note on p. 111: Compare also No. 837
and 838.]
1141.
The soul can never be corrupted with the corruption of the body,,
but is in the body as it were the air which causes the sound of the
organ, where when a pipe bursts, the wind would cease to have any
1142.
The part always has a tendency to reunite with its whole in order to
The spirit desires to remain with its body, because, without the
anything.
1143.
If any one wishes to see how the soul dwells in its body, let him
observe how this body uses its daily habitation; that is to say, if
917
this is devoid of order and confused, the body will be kept in
1144.
Why does the eye see a thing more clearly in dreams than with the
1145.
1146.
1147.
918
Science, its principles and rules (1148--1161)
1148.
1149.
race, teaches how that nature acts among mortals; and being
1150.
1151.
experience.
1152.
919
Truth was the only daughter of Time.
1153.
experiments.
Experience does not err; only your judgments err by expecting from
with great abuse they accuse her of leading them astray but they set
to promise ourselves, in her name, things that are not in her power;
evidence.
1154.
most useful, seeing that by means of this all animated bodies that
have movement perform all their actions; and these movements are
920
1155.
OF MECHANICS.
1157.
1158.
mathematics.
1159.
Any one who in discussion relies upon authority uses, not his
921
understanding, but rather his memory. Good culture is born of a good
1160.
1161.
Those who fall in love with practice without science are like a
sailor who enters a ship without a helm or a compass, and who never
II.
MORALS.
1162.
922
Now you see that the hope and the desire of returning home and to
one's former state is like the moth to the light, and that the man
who with constant longing awaits with joy each new spring time, each
new summer, each new month and new year--deeming that the things he
longs for are ever too late in coming--does not perceive that he is
longing for his own destruction. But this desire is the very
imprisoned with the soul is ever longing to return from the human
body to its giver. And you must know that this same longing is that
the world.
1163.
O Time! consumer of all things; O envious age! thou dost destroy all
things and devour all things with the relentless teeth of years,
mirror, seeing the withered wrinkles made in her face by old age,
wept and wondered why she had twice been carried away.
Death.
1164.
923
Every evil leaves behind a grief in our memory, except the supreme
evil, that is death, which destroys this memory together with life.
1165.
then dost thou not work in such wise as that after death thou mayst
sleep so like to the hapless dead? [Footnote: Compare No. 676, Vol.
I. p. 353.]
1166.
By these square-blocks are meant the life and the studies of men.
1167.
The knowledge of past times and of the places on the earth is both
1168.
924
To lie is so vile, that even if it were in speaking well of godly
things it would take off something from God's grace; and Truth is so
this does not prevent that the truth of things is the chief
But you who live in dreams are better pleased by the sophistical
those reasons which are certain and natural and not so far above us.
1169.
1170.
Men are in error when they lament the flight of time, accusing it of
passes; but good memory, with which nature has endowed us, causes
925
things long past to seem present.
1171.
Learning acquired in youth arrests the evil of old age; and if you
understand that old age has wisdom for its food, you will so conduct
yourself in youth that your old age will not lack for nourishment.
1172.
because it may thus drive out useless things and retain the good.
1173.
1174.
The water you touch in a river is the last of that which has passed,
and the first of that which is coming. Thus it is with time present.
926
1175.
1176.
takes in.
1177.
On Mount Etna the words freeze in your mouth and you may make ice of
sentence.]
use.
You do ill if you praise, and still worse if you reprove in a matter
927
When Fortune comes, seize her in front with a sure hand, because
1178.
knowledge; but merely a sack in which their food may be stowed and
else than vehicles for food; for it seems to me they have nothing
about them of the human species but the voice and the figure, and
1179.
Some there are who are nothing else than a passage for food and
no other things in the world, nor any good effects are produced,
1180.
928
1181.
glorified.
1182.
lascivious joys.
Because it does not know the true light. Because it does not know
Vain splendour takes from us the power of being .... behold! for its
On riches (1183--1187).
1183.
That is not riches, which may be lost; virtue is our true good and
the true reward of its possessor. That cannot be lost; that never
929
deserts us, but when life leaves us. As to property and external
riches, hold them with trembling; they often leave their possessor
1184.
Man has much power of discourse which for the most part is vain and
false; animals have but little, but it is useful and true, and a
1185.
1186.
1187.
That man is of supreme folly who always wants for fear of wanting;
and his life flies away while he is still hoping to enjoy the good
930
Rules of Life (1188-1202).
1188.
If you governed your body by the rules of virtue you would not walk
1189.
1190.
1191.
931
queen-bee.
He who takes the snake by the tail will presently be bitten by it.
1192.
The man who does not restrain wantonness, allies himself with
beasts.
You can have no dominion greater or less than that over yourself.
youth.
1193.
932
great martyr.
1194.
1195.
the cold. For if you multiply your garments as the cold increases,
that cold cannot hurt you; in the same way increase your patience
1196.
good man.
1197.
933
Envy wounds with false accusations, that is with detraction, a thing
1198.
The rest of this passage may be rendered in various ways, but none
1199.
1200.
Wherever good fortune enters, envy lays siege to the place and
behind.
934
if you do not understand the matter well.
not understand.
1201.
Words which do not satisfy the ear of the hearer weary him or vex
him, and the symptoms of this you will often see in such hearers in
their frequent yawns; you therefore, who speak before men whose good
will you desire, when you see such an excess of fatigue, abridge
instead of the favour you desire, you will get dislike and
hostility.
And if you would see in what a man takes pleasure, without hearing
and when you presently see him intent, without yawning or wrinkling
his brow or other actions of various kinds, you may be certain that
&c.
1202.
sensible objects; and they unite and become one and the same thing.
935
The work is the first thing born of this union; if the thing loved
When the thing taken into union is perfectly adapted to that which
When that which loves is united to the thing beloved it can rest
1203.
There will be eternal fame also for the inhabitants of that town,
All communities obey and are led by their magnates, and these
magnates ally themselves with the lords and subjugate them in two
these build a house or two inside your city which may yield some
congregation of people which stand like goats one behind the other,
filling every place with fetid smells and sowing seeds of pestilence
936
and death;
And the city will gain beauty worthy of its name and to you it will
aggrandizement.
1204.
tyrants, and first I will speak of the situation of the walls, and
also I shall show how communities can maintain their good and just
Lords.
III.
POLEMICS.--SPECULATION.
1205.
937
Oh! speculators on things, boast not of knowing the things that
nature ordinarily brings about; but rejoice if you know the end of
1206.
delli autori che anno sol col immaginatione voluto farsi interpreti
tra la natura e l'omo, ma sol di quelli che non coi cienni della
ingegni.]
1207.
common seed of every metal, not remembering that nature varies the
in the world.
938
1208.
Against friars.
1209.
[Footnote: Compare No. 837, 11. 54-57, No. 1296 (p. 363 and 364),
1210.
of any thing is the offspring of this knowledge, the love being the
which, when combined, compose the totality of the thing which ought
while he leaves behind the chief part of the things of which the
939
whole is composed? It is true that impatience, the mother of
subject, such as the human body; and then they want to comprehend
dissect it!
Oh! human stupidity, do you not perceive that, though you have been
with yourself all your life, you are not yet aware of the thing you
possess most of, that is of your folly? and then, with the crowd of
the things included in them. And then you occupy yourself with
which the human mind is incapable and which cannot be proved by any
instance from nature. And you fancy you have wrought miracles when
you spoil a work of some speculative mind, and do not perceive that
you are falling into the same error as that of a man who strips a
Pompeius, who lived in the time of Augustus. The work of the latter
940
the worthy deeds of his forefathers, full of the most admirable and
those impatient spirits, who fancy they are losing as much time as
that which they employ usefully in studying the works of nature and
the deeds of men. But these may remain in company of beasts; among
their associates should be dogs and other animals full of rapine and
they may hunt with them after...., and then follow helpless beasts,
which in time of great snows come near to your houses asking alms as
On spirits (1211--1213).
1211.
body, and where there is a body space is occupied, and this prevents
the eye from seeing what is placed behind that space; hence the
1212.
941
being so, a spirit can have neither voice, nor form, nor strength.
where the passages are closed. And if any one should say that by
various forms and by this means speak and move with strength--to him
I reply that when there are neither nerves nor bones there can be no
spirits.
1213.
gives birth to simple and natural things. But it is all the more
but what is like itself, that is, lies; this does not happen in
their hands, who have produced, for instance, glass &c. but this
Necromancy the flag and flying banner, blown by the winds, is the
dazzling and endless effects of this art; and there are books full,
942
declaring that enchantments and spirits can work and speak without
storms and rain; and that men can be turned into cats and wolves and
true that there were in such an art a power to disturb the calm
say, the man who has power to command the winds and to make ruinous
gales by which any fleet may be submerged, --surely a man who could
treasures and gems reposing in the body of the earth would all be
would be able to save any one against the will of the necromancer.
943
He would have himself carried through the air from East to West and
through all the opposite sides of the universe. But why should I
enlarge further upon this? What is there that could not be done by
deity? For I know that there are numberless people who would, to
satisfy a whim, destroy God and all the universe; and if this
left among them, it can never have existed, nor will it ever exist
Turn over.
1214.
OF SPIRITS.
We have said, on the other side of this page, that the definition of
its own accord, nor can it have any kind of motion in space; and if
you were to say that it moves itself, this cannot be within the
944
quantity is called a vacuum, and a vacuum does not exist in nature;
above it and lighter than it; as we see that the parts of water have
up into the air, then it would acquire weight, and if you were to
draw the air beneath the water then the water which remains above
this air would acquire weight, which weight could not sustain itself
wherever the vacuum may be in this water it will fall in; and this
motion unless it be to rise upwards. But now we will say how such a
945
form a vacuum, as is said above; therefore it is inevitable, if it
a certain quantity of air; and if it were mingled with the air, two
the air with which it mingles; and for this cause the rarefied air
must fly up of itself and will not remain among the air that is
heavier than itself; and besides this the subtle spiritual essence
1215.
AS TO WHETHER THE SPIRIT, HAVING TAKEN THIS BODY OF AIR, CAN MOVE
OF
ITSELF OR NOT.
air, should move this air; and this is proved by the above passage
946
where it is said: the spirit rarefies that portion of the air in
above the other air and there will be a motion of the air caused by
the air will be moved by the wind and not by the spirit incorporated
in it.
generated; and we will say that the voice is, as it were, the
friction of the dense and the rare condenses the rare and causes
resistance; again, the rare, when in swift motion, and the rare in
slow motion condense each other when they come in contact and make a
noise and very great uproar; and the sound or murmur made by the
rare moving through the rare with only moderate swiftness, like a
great flame generating noises in the air; and the tremendous uproar
made by the rare mingling with the rare, and when that air which is
both swift and rare rushes into that which is itself rare and in
motion, it is like the flame of fire which issues from a big gun and
striking against the air; and again when a flame issues from the
947
Therefore we may say that the spirit cannot produce a voice without
movement of the air, and air in it there is none, nor can it emit
itself, and that cannot multiply which has no quantity. And in the
4th place it is said that no rare body can move, if it has not a
stable spot, whence it may take its motion; much more is it so when
an element has to move within its own element, which does not move
which it is squeezed.
spirit can be heard, and what hearing is, and seeing; the wave of
the voice passes through the air as the images of objects pass to
the eye.
Nonentity.
1216.
divisible.
948
[Amid the vastness of the things among which we live, the existence
of nothingness holds the first place; its function extends over all
lies precisely between the past and the future, and has nothing in
the present. This nothingness has the part equal to the whole, and
the whole to the part, the divisible to the indivisible; and the
tenth figure which represents zero; and its power has not extension
speech. In time it stands between the past and future and has no
With regard to time, nothingness lies between the past and the
future, and has nothing to do with the present, and as to its nature
949
1217.
of stillness and to obey the law which God and time gave to
procreative nature.]
Ah! how many a time the shoals of terrified dolphins and the huge
the uncovered shores with the terrified and desperate fishes which
fled from thee, and left by the sea, remained in spots where they
O time, swift robber of all created things, how many kings, how many
nations hast thou undone, and how many changes of states and of
various events have happened since the wondrous forms of this fish
time thou liest patiently in this confined space with bones stripped
mountain.
950
period of Leonardo's life. It has become very indistinct, and is at
doubtful.]
1218.
The watery element was left enclosed between the raised banks of the
rivers, and the sea was seen between the uplifted earth and the
machine of the earth, and whose mass, standing between the water and
the fruitful earth will put forth no more her light verdure; the
fields will no more be decked with waving corn; all the animals,
finding no fresh grass for pasture, will die and food will then be
lacking to the lions and wolves and other beasts of prey, and to men
who after many efforts will be compelled to abandon their life, and
the human race will die out. In this way the fertile and fruitful
earth will remain deserted, arid and sterile from the water being
continue a little time to increase until the cold and subtle air
being gone, it will be forced to end with the element of fire; and
then its surface will be left burnt up to cinder and this will be
951
written on the same sheet.]
1219.
Why did nature not ordain that one animal should not live by the
creating and making constantly new lives and forms, because she
more ready and more swift in her creating, than time in his
destruction; and so she has ordained that many animals shall be food
for others. Nay, this not satisfying her desire, to the same end she
upon the vast increase and congregation of animals; and most of all
upon men, who increase vastly because other animals do not feed upon
them; and, the causes being removed, the effects would not follow.
This earth therefore seeks to lose its life, desiring only continual
demonstrate, like effects always follow like causes, animals are the
XX.
Humorous Writings.
952
writings collected in this section, the transcript of Leonardo's
tirava a se gli animi delle genti. And Paulus Jovius says in his
principibus mire placuit. There can be no doubt that the fables are
any foreign source; indeed the schemes and plans for the composition
in which they are written in MS. H. This is one of the very rare
notes, all in one MS., and Leonardo has also departed from his
953
ordinary habits, by occasionally not completing the text on the page
been placed here, simply because they may possibly have been
they would seem to be extracts. On the one hand the names of some of
the animals seem to prove that Leonardo could not here be recording
observations of his own; on the other hand the notes on their habits
useful to the reader, and, also, because in reading the long series,
as they occur in the original, we may follow the author's mind; and
here and there it is not difficult to see how one theme suggested
954
or all of them could be solved at the present day and the MSS. throw
text, which it was desired to reproduce: Vol. I page 326, and Pl.
fact that the maxims and morals in verse which have been ascribed to
him, are not to be found in the manuscripts, and Prof. Uzielli has
already proved that they cannot be by him. Hence it would seem that
certainty.
I.
1220.
955
carried into the presence of a sick person, if the sick man is going
to die, the bird turns away its head and never looks at him; but if
the sick man is to be saved the bird never loses sight of him but is
Like unto this is the love of virtue. It never looks at any vile or
base thing, but rather clings always to pure and virtuous things and
than in prosperity; as light does, which shines most where the place
is darkest.
1221.
ENVY.
We read of the kite that, when it sees its young ones growing too
big in the nest, out of envy it pecks their sides, and keeps them
without food.
CHEERFULNESS.
SADNESS.
956
Sadness resembles the raven, which, when it sees its young ones born
lamentations, and does not feed them until it sees in them some few
black feathers.
1222.
PEACE.
for the virtue [contained] in its medicinal testicles and not being
bites off its testicles with its sharp teeth, and leaves them to its
enemies.
RAGE.
take their honey, the bees having begun to sting him he leaves the
ground, vainly exasperating, by his hands and feet, the foes against
957
1223.
GRATITUDE.
called hoopoes which, knowing the benefits of life and food, they
have received from their father and their mother, when they see them
grow old, make a nest for them and brood over them and feed them,
and with their beaks pull out their old and shabby feathers; and
then, with a certain herb restore their sight so that they return to
a prosperous state.
AVARICE.
The toad feeds on earth and always remains lean; because it never
1224.
INGRATITUDE.
Pigeons are a symbol of ingratitude; for when they are old enough no
longer to need to be fed, they begin to fight with their father, and
this struggle does not end until the young one drives the father out
958
CRUELTY.
its baleful gaze, it turns upon herbs and plants, and fixing its
1225.
GENEROSITY.
leave a part of its prey for the birds that are round it, which,
DISCIPLINE.
When the wolf goes cunningly round some stable of cattle, and by
1226.
FLATTERERS OR SYRENS.
The syren sings so sweetly that she lulls the mariners to sleep;
959
then she climbs upon the ships and kills the sleeping mariners.
PRUDENCE.
The ant, by her natural foresight provides in the summer for the
winter, killing the seeds she harvests that they may not germinate,
FOLLY.
The wild bull having a horror of a red colour, the hunters dress up
the trunk of a tree with red and the bull runs at this with great
frenzy, thus fixing his horns, and forthwith the hunters kill him
there.
1227.
JUSTICE.
We may liken the virtue of Justice to the king of the bees which
orders and arranges every thing with judgment. For some bees are
to fight with the wasps, others to clear away all dirt, others to
accompagny and escort the king; and when he is old and has no wings
they carry him. And if one of them fails in his duty, he is punished
without reprieve.
960
TRUTH.
1228.
FIDELITY, OR LOYALTY.
The cranes are so faithful and loyal to their king, that at night,
so that if sleep should overcome them, this stone would fall and
make so much noise that they would wake up again. And there are
others which sleep together round the king; and this they do every
night, changing in turn so that their king may never find them
wanting.
FALSEHOOD.
kind, suddenly flings himself on the ground with his mouth open to
look as he were dead; and these birds want to peck at his tongue,
961
1229.
LIES.
The mole has very small eyes and it always lives under ground; and
with lies.
VALOUR.
The lion is never afraid, but rather fights with a bold spirit and
FEAR OR COWARDICE.
The hare is always frightened; and the leaves that fall from the
trees in autumn always keep him in terror and generally put him to
flight.
1230.
MAGNANIMITY.
The falcon never preys but on large birds; and it will let itself
962
die rather than feed on little ones, or eat stinking meat.
VAIN GLORY.
its tail, which it spreads in the form of a wheel, and by its cries
1231.
CONSTANCY.
INCONSTANCY.
CONTINENCE.
963
The camel is the most lustful animal there is, and will follow the
female for a thousand miles. But if you keep it constantly with its
nature.
1232.
INCONTINENCE.
The unicorn, through its intemperance and not knowing how to control
itself, for the love it bears to fair maidens forgets its ferocity
damsel and go to sleep in her lap, and thus the hunters take it.
HUMILITY.
We see the most striking example of humility in the lamb which will
submit to any animal; and when they are given for food to imprisoned
very often it has been seen that the lions forbear to kill them.
1233.
PRIDE.
964
it and rule over all the other birds of prey, and longs to be sole
and supreme; and very often the falcon has been seen to assault the
ABSTINENCE.
The wild ass, when it goes to the well to drink, and finds the water
GLUTTONY.
armies.
1234.
CHASTITY.
The turtle-dove is never false to its mate; and if one dies the
UNCHASTITY.
965
The bat, owing to unbridled lust, observes no universal rule in
pairing, but males with males and females with females pair
MODERATION.
The ermine out of moderation never eats but once in the day; it will
1235.
THE EAGLE.
if its young ones cannot bear to gaze on the sun [Footnote 6: The
meaning is obscure.]--; it does not feed them with any bird, that
does not wish to die. Animals which much fear it do not approach its
nest, although it does not hurt them. It always leaves part of its
prey uneaten.
LUMERPA,--FAME.
966
its own shadow, and when it dies it does not lose this light, and
its feathers never fall out, but a feather pulled out shines no
longer.
1236.
THE PELICAN.
This bird has a great love for its young; and when it finds them in
its nest dead from a serpent's bite, it pierces itself to the heart,
and with its blood it bathes them till they return to life.
THE SALAMANDER.
This has no digestive organs, and gets no food but from the fire, in
virtue.
THE CAMELEON.
This lives on air, and there it is the prey of all the birds; so in
967
At that height nothing can go unless it has a gift from Heaven, and
1237.
THE OSTRICH.
This bird converts iron into nourishment, and hatches its eggs by
THE SWAN.
The swan is white without any spot, and it sings sweetly as it dies,
THE STORK.
male finds his mate unfaithful, he abandons her; and when it grows
old its young ones brood over it, and feed it till it dies.
1238.
968
THE GRASSHOPPER.
This silences the cuckoo with its song. It dies in oil and revives
THE BAT.
The more light there is the blinder this creature becomes; as those
who gaze most at the sun become most dazzled.--For Vice, that cannot
THE PARTRIDGE.
This bird changes from the female into the male and forgets its
former sex; and out of envy it steals the eggs from others and
hatches them, but the young ones follow the true mother.
THE SWALLOW.
This bird gives sight to its blind young ones by means of celandine.
1239.
969
This creature, when the moon is full opens itself wide, and when the
cannot close again, whereby it serves for food to that crab. This is
what happens to him who opens his mouth to tell his secret. He
THE BASILISK.--CRUELTY.
All snakes flie from this creature; but the weasel attacks it by
THE ASP.
This carries instantaneous death in its fangs; and, that it may not
1240.
THE DRAGON.
falls upon it, and so both die, and in its death it is avenged.
THE VIPER.
She, in pairing opens her mouth and at last clenches her teeth and
970
kills her husband. Then the young ones, growing within her body rend
THE SCORPION.
Saliva, spit out when fasting will kill a scorpion. This may be
ills which result from that gluttony, and opens the path of virtue.
1241.
dead, it weeps for him with a lamentable voice and many tears. Then,
hypocrite, who, for the smallest matter, has his face bathed with
tears, but shows the heart of a tiger and rejoices in his heart at
THE TOAD.
The toad flies from the light of the sun, and if it is held there by
force it puffs itself out so much as to hide its head below and
shield itself from the rays. Thus does the foe of clear and radiant
971
up courage.
1242.
round itself a new dwelling place with marvellous artifice and fine
THE SPIDER.
The spider brings forth out of herself the delicate and ingenious
[Footnote: Two notes are underneath this text. The first: 'nessuna
1243.
THE LION.
972
This animal, with his thundering roar, rouses his young the third
day after they are born, teaching them the use of all their dormant
senses and all the wild things which are in the wood flee away.
This may be compared to the children of Virtue who are roused by the
more and more elevated; while all that is base flies at the sound,
Again, the lion covers over its foot tracks, so that the way it has
conceal the secrets of his mind so that the enemy may not know his
purpose.
1244.
THE TARANTULA.
The bite of the tarantula fixes a man's mind on one idea; that is on
These punish those who are scoffing at them by pecking out their
eyes; for nature has so ordered it, that they may thus be fed.
973
1245.
THE ELEPHANT.
The huge elephant has by nature what is rarely found in man; that is
as when the moon is new, these beasts go down to the rivers, and
saluted the planet, return to the woods. And when they are ill,
being laid down, they fling up plants towards Heaven as though they
would offer sacrifice. --They bury their tusks when they fall out
from old age.--Of these two tusks they use one to dig up roots for
food; but they save the point of the other for fighting with; when
they are taken by hunters and when worn out by fatigue, they dig up
1246.
They are merciful, and know the dangers, and if one finds a man
alone and lost, he kindly puts him back in the road he has missed,
These beasts always go in troops, and the oldest goes in front and
974
the second in age remains the last, and thus they enclose the troop.
Out of shame they pair only at night and secretly, nor do they then
rejoin the herd but first bathe in the river. The females do not
1247.
it puts them aside with its trunk, so as not to trample them under
foot; and it never hurts any thing unless when provoked. When one
has fallen into a pit the others fill up the pit with branches,
earth and stones, thus raising the bottom that he may easily get
out. They greatly dread the noise of swine and fly in confusion,
doing no less harm then, with their feet, to their own kind than to
the enemy. They delight in rivers and are always wandering about
near them, though on account of their great weight they cannot swim.
They devour stones, and the trunks of trees are their favourite
food. They have a horror of rats. Flies delight in their smell and
settle on their back, and the beast scrapes its skin making its
1248.
When they cross rivers they send their young ones up against the
stream of the water; thus, being set towards the fall, they break
975
the united current of the water so that the current does not carry
them away. The dragon flings itself under the elephant's body, and
with its tail it ties its legs; with its wings and with its arms it
also clings round its ribs and cuts its throat with its teeth, and
the elephant falls upon it and the dragon is burst. Thus, in its
THE DRAGON.
manner of roots, and with their heads raised they cross lakes, and
swim to where they find better pasture; and if they did not thus
combine
1249.
THE SERPENT.
The serpent is a very large animal. When it sees a bird in the air
it draws in its breath so strongly that it draws the birds into its
mouth too. Marcus Regulus, the consul of the Roman army was
attacked, with his army, by such an animal and almost defeated. And
64 1/2 braccia and its head was high above all the trees in a wood.
976
THE BOA(?)
This is a very large snake which entangles itself round the legs of
the cow so that it cannot move and then sucks it, in such wise that
1250.
horse, excepting that the great length of its neck and of its ears
grass. Its legs are all in one piece; for this reason when it wants
to sleep it leans against a tree, and the hunters, spying out the
place where it is wont to sleep, saw the tree almost through, and
thus the hunters take it. And every other mode of taking it is in
1251.
977
THE BISON WHICH DOES INJURY IN ITS FLIGHT.
This beast is a native of Paeonia and has a neck with a mane like a
horse. In all its other parts it is like a bull, excepting that its
horns are in a way bent inwards so that it cannot butt; hence it has
distance of 400 braccia in its course, and this burns like fire
wherever it touches.
These keep their claws in the sheath, and never put them out unless
THE LIONESS.
When the lioness defends her young from the hand of the hunter, in
order not to be frightened by the spears she keeps her eyes on the
ground, to the end that she may not by her flight leave her young
ones prisoners.
1252.
THE LION.
978
This animal, which is so terrible, fears nothing more than the noise
covered.
This has the form of the lioness but it is taller on its legs and
slimmer and long bodied; and it is all white and marked with black
spots after the manner of rosettes; and all animals delight to look
1253.
animals grow bold and come close, the better to enjoy the sight of
devours it.
CAMELS.
The Bactrian have two humps; the Arabian one only. They are swift in
979
greater weight than it is used to, and if it is taken too far it
does the same, and suddenly stops and so the merchants are obliged
to lodge there.
1254.
THE TIGER.
terrible swiftness; the hunter when he finds its young ones carries
them off hastily, placing mirrors in the place whence he takes them,
the mirrors fixed on the ground and looking into them believes it
sees its young; then scratching with its paws it discovers the
hunter, and when this hunter sees the tigress he drops one of the
young ones and she takes it, and having carried it to the den she
1255.
CATOBLEPAS.
980
It is found in Ethiopia near to the source Nigricapo. It is not a
very large animal, is sluggish in all its parts, and its head is so
to man, for any one on whom it fixes its eyes dies immediately.
Catoblepas from Pliny, Hist. Nat. VIII. 21 (al. 32): Apud Hesperios
beasts not by its gaze, but by its venomous breath. Athenaeus 221 B,
THE BASILISK.
fingers long. It has on its head a white spot after the fashion of a
snake, but does not move by wriggling but from the centre forwards
1256.
981
of these, being killed with a spear by one who was on horse-back,
and its venom flowing on the spear, not only the man but the horse
also died. It spoils the wheat and not only that which it touches,
but where it breathes the grass dries and the stones are split.
THE WEASEL.
This beast finding the lair of the basilisk kills it with the smell
of its urine, and this smell, indeed, often kills the weasel itself.
THE CERASTES.
This has four movable little horns; so, when it wants to feed, it
hides under leaves all of its body except these little horns which,
as they move, seem to the birds to be some small worms at play. Then
they immediately swoop down to pick them and the Cerastes suddenly
1257.
THE AMPHISBOENA.
This has two heads, one in its proper place the other at the tail;
as if one place were not enough from which to fling its venom.
982
THE IACULUS.
This lies on trees, and flings itself down like a dart, and pierces
THE ASP.
cutting out the bitten part. This pestilential animal has such a
love for its mate that they always go in company. And if, by mishap,
him who has killed it; and it is so determined and eager for
troop it seeks to hurt none but its enemy. And it will travel any
and by very swift flight. It has its eyes turned inwards, and large
1258.
THE ICHNEUMON.
and when it sees an asp near its place, it runs at once to the bed
or mud of the Nile and with this makes itself muddy all over, then
it dries itself in the sun, smears itself again with mud, and thus,
983
drying one after the other, it makes itself three or four coatings
like a coat of mail. Then it attacks the asp, and fights well with
him, so that, taking its time it catches him in the throat and
destroys him.
THE CROCODILE.
This is found in the Nile, it has four feet and lives on land and in
length of forty feet and has claws and is armed with a hide that
will take any blow. By day it is on land and at night in the water.
It feeds on fishes, and going to sleep on the bank of the Nile with
1259.
trochilus, a very small bird, runs at once to its mouth and hops
among its teeth and goes pecking out the remains of the food, and so
flings itself into its mouth and perforates its stomach and bowels,
THE DOLPHIN.
984
Nature has given such knowledge to animals, that besides the
their foes. Thus the dolphin understands what strength lies in a cut
from the fins placed on his chine, and how tender is the belly of
1260.
THE HIPPOPOTAMUS.
This beast when it feels itself over-full goes about seeking thorns,
or where there may be the remains of canes that have been split, and
it rubs against them till a vein is opened; then when the blood has
a twisted tail and the teeth of a wild boar, his neck has a mane;
plants in the fields and goes into them backwards so that it may
THE IBIS.
985
This bird resembles a crane, and when it feels itself ill it fills
its craw with water, and with its beak makes an injection of it.
THE STAG.
1261.
THE LIZARD.
This, when fighting with serpents eats the sow-thistle and is free.
THE SWALLOW.
This [bird] gives sight to its blind young ones, with the juice of
the celandine.
THE WEASEL.
986
THE SNAKE.
This creature when it wants to renew itself casts its old skin,
beginning with the head, and changing in one day and one night.
THE PANTHER.
This beast after its bowels have fallen out will still fight with
1262.
THE CHAMELEON.
THE RAVEN.
1263.
Moderation checks all the vices. The ermine will die rather than
987
besmirch itself.
OF FORESIGHT.
The cock does not crow till it has thrice flapped its wings; the
parrot in moving among boughs never puts its feet excepting where it
has first put its beak. Vows are not made till Hope is dead.
1264.
MAGNANIMITY.
The falcon never seizes any but large birds and will sooner die than
II.
FABLES.
1265.
A FABLE.
988
An oyster being turned out together with other fish in the house of
a fisherman near the sea, he entreated a rat to take him to the sea.
The rat purposing to eat him bid him open; but as he bit him the
oyster squeezed his head and closed; and the cat came and killed
him.
1266.
A FABLE.
The thrushes rejoiced greatly at seeing a man take the owl and
deprive her of liberty, tying her feet with strong bonds. But this
losing not only their liberty, but their life. This is said for
liberty, when by that means they themselves lose all succour, and
1267.
A FABLE.
perceiving the odour of the greasy wool, judged that this must be a
989
land of better living, and also more secure from the teeth and nails
of the dog than where he fed on the dog; and without farther
reflection he left the dog and went into the thick wool. There he
began with great labour to try to pass among the roots of the hairs;
but after much sweating had to give up the task as vain, because
these hairs were so close that they almost touched each other, and
there was no space where fleas could taste the skin. Hence, after
much labour and fatigue, he began to wish to return to his dog, who
1268.
A FABLE.
The vain and wandering butterfly, not content with being able to fly
at its ease through the air, overcome by the tempting flame of the
candle, decided to fly into it; but its sportive impulse was the
cause of a sudden fall, for its delicate wings were burnt in the
dried the tears from its swimming eyes, and raising its face
exclaimed: O false light! how many must thou have miserably deceived
in the past, like me; or if I must indeed see light so near, ought I
not to have known the sun from the false glare of dirty tallow?
990
A FABLE.
went to his abode; and having begun to look at the little bird he
took to kissing it, and from excess of love he kissed it so much and
turned it about and squeezed it till he killed it. This is said for
those who by not punishing their children let them come to mischief.
1269.
A FABLE.
imminent peril through a little hole. Meanwhile the cat came by and
suddenly seized the weasel and forthwith devoured it. Then the rat
thanking His providence, and came out of his hole to enjoy his
with his life, by the cruel claws and teeth of the lurking cat.
1270.
A FABLE.
991
The ant found a grain of millet. The seed feeling itself taken
prisoner cried out to her: "If you will do me the kindness to allow
A Spider found a bunch of grapes which for its sweetness was much
she had found a most convenient spot to spread her snare, and having
settled herself on it with her delicate web, and entered into her
made by the spaces between the grapes, she fell like a thief on the
wretched creatures which were not aware of her. But, after a few
days had passed, the vintager came, and cut away the bunch of grapes
and put it with others, with which it was trodden; and thus the
grapes were a snare and pitfall both for the treacherous spider and
An ass having gone to sleep on the ice over a deep lake, his heat
dissolved the ice and the ass awoke under water to his great grief,
duck, which, flying before him had plunged under water, wished to
follow it under water, and having soaked his feathers had to remain
in the water while the duck rising to the air mocked at the falcon
992
as he drowned.
The spider wishing to take flies in her treacherous net, was cruelly
1271.
The water finding that its element was the lordly ocean, was seized
with a desire to rise above the air, and being encouraged by the
though it were really as thin as air. But having risen very high, it
reached the air that was still more rare and cold, where the fire
forsook it, and the minute particles, being brought together, united
itself to flight and it fell from the sky, and was drunk up by the
dry earth, where, being imprisoned for a long time, it did penance
1272.
A FABLE.
993
The razor having one day come forth from the handle which serves as
its sheath and having placed himself in the sun, saw the sun
reflected in his body, which filled him with great pride. And
shall I return again to that shop from which I have just come?
Certainly not; such splendid beauty shall not, please God, be turned
shave the lathered beards of rustic peasants and perform such menial
service! Is this body destined for such work? Certainly not. I will
hide myself in some retired spot and there pass my life in tranquil
repose." And having thus remained hidden for some months, one day he
came out into the air, and issuing from his sheath, saw himself
The same thing happens to those minds which instead of exercise give
themselves up to sloth. They are like the razor here spoken of, and
lose the keenness of their edge, while the rust of ignorance spoils
their form.
A FABLE.
994
A stone of some size recently uncovered by the water lay on a
it could let itself fall down there, saying to itself: "What have I
those, my sisters." And letting itself fall, its rapid course ended
among these longed for companions. When it had been there sometime
rolled it over, that one trod upon it; sometimes it lifted itself a
little and then it was covered with mud or the dung of some animal,
and it was in vain that it looked at the spot whence it had come as
infinite evil.
1273.
candlestick. With ardent longing they strove to reach it; and one of
995
them, quitting its natural course, writhed up to an unburnt brand on
which it fed and passed at the opposite end out by a narrow chink to
the candle which was near. It flung itself upon it, and with fierce
tried to return to the furnace whence it had come. But in vain, for
into foul smoke, while leaving all its sisters in brilliant and
1274.
which was lying on the topmost height of a very high mountain and
saying to itself: "Now, shall not I be thought vain and proud for
seen here around me, should take a place lower than mine? Certainly
all, in a few hours, destroyed by the sun. And this happened from
their having placed themselves higher than became them. I will flee
from the wrath of the sun, and humble myself and find a place
996
befitting my small importance." Thus, flinging itself down, it began
to descend, hurrying from its high home on to the other snow; but
the more it sought a low place the more its bulk increased, so that
when at last its course was ended on a hill, it found itself no less
in size than the hill which supported it; and it was the last of the
snow which was destroyed that summer by the sun. This is said for
1275.
The cedar, being desirous of producing a fine and noble fruit at its
summit, set to work to form it with all the strength of its sap. But
this fruit, when grown, was the cause of the tall and upright
The peach, being envious of the vast quantity of fruit which she saw
loaded herself with her own in such a way that the weight of the
fruit pulled her up by the roots and broke her down to the ground.
its fruit to the passers by, and every one cast stones at it.
997
produce fruits that it might be praised by men, it was bent and
The fig-tree, standing by the side of the elm and seeing that its
boughs were bare of fruit, yet that it had the audacity to keep the
Sun from its own unripe figs with its branches, said to it: "Oh elm!
art thou not ashamed to stand in front of me. But wait till my
offspring are fully grown and you will see where you are!" But when
the fig-tree and her figs were all torn off her, and her boughs cut
away and broken. Then, when she was thus maimed in all her limbs,
the elm asked her, saying: "O fig-tree! which was best, to be
plight!"
1276.
The plant complains of the old and dry stick which stands by its
1277.
A FABLE.
998
A nut, having been carried by a crow to the top of a tall campanile
and released by falling into a chink from the mortal grip of its
allowing it to be so high and thick, and to own such fine bells and
not been able to fall under the verdurous boughs of its venerable
father and lie in the fat earth covered up by his fallen leaves it
would not abandon it; because, finding itself in the beak of the
cruel crow, it had there made a vow that if it escaped from her it
would end its life in a little hole. At these words the wall, moved
fallen; and after a short time the nut began to split open and put
forth roots between the rifts of the stones and push them apart, and
to throw out shoots from its hollow shell; and, to be brief, these
rose above the building and the twisted roots, growing thicker,
began to thrust the walls apart, and tear out the ancient stones
from their old places. Then the wall too late and in vain bewailed
1278.
A FABLE.
The privet feeling its tender boughs loaded with young fruit,
999
complained to the blackbird with pitious remonstrance entreating her
that since she stole its delicious fruits she should not deprive it
of the leaves with which it preserved them from the burning rays of
the sun, and that she should not divest it of its tender bark by
know that Nature made you produce these fruits for my nourishment;
do you not see that you are in the world [only] to serve me as food;
do you not know, base creature, that next winter you will be food
and prey for the Fire?" To which words the tree listened patiently,
and not without tears. After a short time the blackbird was taken in
a net and boughs were cut to make a cage, in which to imprison her.
Branches were cut, among others from the pliant privet, to serve for
the small rods of the cage; and seeing herself to be the cause of
Blackbird, I am here, and not yet burnt by fire as you said. I shall
A FABLE.
The laurel and the myrtle seeing the pear tree cut down cried out
with a loud voice: "O pear-tree! whither are you going? Where is the
pride you had when you were covered with ripe fruits? Now you will
replied: "I am going with the husbandman who has cut me down and who
will take me to the workshop of a good sculptor who by his art will
1000
make me take the form of Jove the god; and I shall be dedicated in a
temple and adored by men in the place of Jove, while you are bound
A FABLE.
The chesnut, seeing a man upon the fig-tree, bending its boughs down
and pulling off the ripe fruits, which he put into his open mouth
destroying and crushing them with his hard teeth, it tossed its long
boughs and with a noisy rustle exclaimed: "O fig! how much less are
set in close array; first clothed in soft wrappers over which is the
hard but softly lined husk; and not content with taking this care of
me, and having given them so strong a shelter, on this she has
placed sharp and close-set spines so that the hand of man cannot
hurt me." Then the fig-tree and her offspring began to laugh and
having laughed she said: "I know man to be of such ingenuity that
with rods and stones and stakes flung up among your branches he will
bereave you of your fruits; and when they are fallen, he will
trample them with his feet or with stones, so that your offspring
touched carefully by their hands, and not like you with sticks and
stones."
1279.
1001
The hapless willow, finding that she could not enjoy the pleasure of
seeing her slender branches grow or attain to the height she wished,
or point to the sky, by reason of the vine and whatever other trees
that grew near, but was always maimed and lopped and spoiled,
brought all her spirits together and gave and devoted itself
seeking, in all the world of plants, with which of them she might
ally herself and which could not need the help of her withes. Having
flash the gourd presented itself to her thoughts and tossing all her
branches with extreme delight, it seemed to her that she had found
the companion suited to her purpose, because the gourd is more apt
she awaited eagerly some friendly bird who should be the mediator of
her wishes. Presently seeing near her the magpie she said to him: "O
gentle bird! by the memory of the refuge which you found this
falcon wanted to devour you, and by that repose which you have
always found in me when your wings craved rest, and by the pleasure
you have enjoyed among my boughs, when playing with your companions
or making love--I entreat you find the gourd and obtain from her
some of her seeds, and tell her that those that are born of them I
will treat exactly as though they were my own flesh and blood; and
in this way use all the words you can think of, which are of the
1002
language, I need not teach you. And if you will do me this service I
shall be happy to have your nest in the fork of my boughs, and all
your family without payment of any rent." Then the magpie, having
principally that she should never admit upon her any snake or
polecat, cocked his tail, and put down his head, and flung himself
from the bough, throwing his weight upon his wings; and these,
beating the fleeting air, now here, now there, bearing about
came to a gourd; then with a handsome bow and a few polite words, he
obtained the required seeds, and carried them to the willow, who
received him with a cheerful face. And when he had scraped away with
his foot a small quantity of the earth near the willow, describing a
circle, with his beak he planted the grains, which in a short time
began to grow, and by their growth and the branches to take up all
the beauty of the sun and sky. And not content with so much evil,
the gourds next began, by their rude hold, to drag the ends of the
tender shoots down towards the earth, with strange twisting and
distortion.
Then, being much annoyed, it shook itself in vain to throw off the
gourd. After raving for some days in such plans vainly, because the
firm union forbade it, seeing the wind come by it commended itself
to him. The wind flew hard and opened the old and hollow stem of the
willow in two down to the roots, so that it fell into two parts. In
1003
vain did it bewail itself recognising that it was born to no good
end.
III.
1280.
A JEST.
pictures. The painter turned round, somewhat angered, and asked him
why this sprinkling had been bestowed on his pictures; then said the
priest, that it was the custom and his duty to do so, and that he
was doing good; and that he who did good might look for good in
return, and, indeed, for better, since God had promised that every
from above. Then the painter, waiting till he went out, went to an
upper window and flung a large pail of water on the priest's back,
said would come from the good you had done me with your holy water,
1004
1281.
drinker.
1282.
Wine, the divine juice of the grape, finding itself in a golden and
rejoice, and not perceive that I am now near to my death and shall
leave my golden abode in this cup to enter into the foul and fetid
delicious liquor into a foul and base one. Nay, and as though so
much evil as this were not enough, I must for a long time lie in
put to such contempt; and that, since that country produced the
finest and best grapes in the whole world, at least they should not
be turned into wine. Then Jove made that wine drunk by Mahomet to
that it made him mad, and gave birth to so many follies that when he
wine, and henceforth the vine and its fruit were left free.
1005
As soon as wine has entered the stomach it begins to ferment and
swell; then the spirit of that man begins to abandon his body,
rising as it were skywards, and the brain finds itself parting from
the body. Then it begins to degrade him, and make him rave like a
1283.
definite purpose, the gentleman asked him what he did this for. The
other said that he came there to have a pleasure which his lordship
greater than himself, as is the way with the populace; while the
gentleman could only see men of less consequence than himself; and
1284.
at an inn, in company with a certain merchant, and sat down with him
at the same table, where, from the poverty of the inn, nothing was
served to them but a small roast chicken. The merchant, seeing this
1006
to be but little even for himself, turned to the friars and said:
"If my memory serves me, you do not eat any kind of flesh in your
by their rule to admit, without cavil, that this was the truth; so
the merchant had his wish, and eat the chicken and the friars did
the best they could. After dinner the messmates departed, all three
some width and depth. All three being on foot--the friars by reason
the custom of company that one of the friars, being barefoot, should
shoes into his keeping, he took up his man. But it so happened that
when the friar had got to the middle of the river, he again
like Saint Christopher, to the burden on his back and said: "Tell
me, have you any money about you?"--"You know I have", answered the
any money on our persons," and forthwith he dropped him into the
revenged on the indignity he had done them; so, with a smiling face,
1285.
A JEST.
1007
A man wishing to prove, by the authority of Pythagoras, that he had
formerly been in the world, while another would not let him finish
his argument, the first speaker said to the second: "It is by this
token that I was formerly here, I remember that you were a miller."
The other one, feeling himself stung by these words, agreed that it
was true, and that by the same token he remembered that the speaker
A JEST.
which were but dead things, his children were so ugly; to which the
painter replied that he made his pictures by day, and his children
by night.
1286.
A man saw a large sword which another one wore at his side. Said he
"Poor fellow, for a long time I have seen you tied to that weapon;
why do you not release yourself as your hands are untied, and set
stung, replied: "I know that you are acquainted with so few things
in this world, that I thought anything I could tell you would be new
to you."
1008
1287.
A man gave up his intimacy with one of his friends because he often
spoke ill of his other friends. The neglected friend one day
him to say what might be the cause that had made him forget so much
you because I love you, and I do not choose that you, by speaking
intimate.
1288.
A man was arguing and boasting that he knew many and various tricks.
Another among the bystanders said: "I know how to play a trick which
will make whomsoever I like pull off his breeches." The first man--
the boaster--said: "You won't make me pull off mine, and I bet you a
pair of hose on it." He who proposed the game, having accepted the
offer, produced breeches and drew them across the face of him who
1009
A man said to an acquaintance: "Your eyes are changed to a strange
colour." The other replied: "It often happens, but you have not
noticed it." "When does it happen?" said the former. "Every time
that my eyes see your ugly face, from the shock of so unpleasing a
The other replied: "It is because my eyes behold your strange ugly
face."
A man said that in his country were the strangest things in the
world. Another answered: "You, who were born there, confirm this as
1289.
An old man was publicly casting contempt on a young one, and boldly
showing that he did not fear him; on which the young man replied
that his advanced age served him better as a shield than either his
1290.
1010
A JEST.
door, and asking one of his servants who was knocking, the servant
went out, and answered that it was a woman calling herself Madonna
Bona. Then the sick man lifting his arms to Heaven thanked God with
a loud voice, and told the servants that they were to let her come
1291.
A JEST.
A man was desired to rise from bed, because the sun was already
1292.
IV.
1011
PROPHECIES.
1293.
of those things which, the more is taken from them, the more they
grow. And reserve the great matters till the end, and the small
matters give at the beginning. And first show the evils and then the
(Of Ants.)
themselves and their young ones and victuals in dark caverns, and
they will feed themselves and their families in dark places for many
beginning with the text of line 11. At the end of the column is the
1012
head: Lines 56--79 form a second column, lines 80--97 a third one
(Of Bees.)
And many others will be deprived of their store and their food, and
Justice of God! Why dost thou not wake and behold thy creatures thus
ill used?
from them ripped open and flayed and most barbarously quartered.
(Of Nuts, and Olives, and Acorns, and Chesnuts, and such like.)
1013
males--tightly bound, arms and legs, with strong withes by folks who
will not understand your language. And you will only be able to
and sighing and lamentation among yourselves; for those who will
bind you will not understand you, nor will you understand them.
their own houses by most cruel and rapacious beasts of your own
country.
advantage, and instead of remuneration for the good they do, they
are paid with the severest suffering, and spend their whole life in
Men shall sleep, and eat, and dwell among trees, in the forests and
open country.
1014
(Of Dreaming.)
Men will seem to see new destructions in the sky. The flames that
fall from it will seem to rise in it and to fly from it with terror.
They will hear every kind of animals speak in human language. They
without motion. They will see the greatest splendour in the midst of
darkness. O! marvel of the human race! What madness has led you
thus! You will speak with animals of every species and they with you
in human speech. You will see yourself fall from great heights
without any harm and torrents will accompany you, and will mingle
(Of Christians.)
Many who hold the faith of the Son only build temples in the name of
the Mother.
[84] A great portion of bodies that have been alive will pass into
furnishing them with good things, and carrying with them their
evils. That is to say the life of man is formed from things eaten,
1015
and these carry with them that part of man which dies . . .
1294.
(Of Funeral Rites, and Processions, and Lights, and Bells, and
Followers.)
The greatest honours will be paid to men, and much pomp, without
their knowledge.
right, but the writing is larger than the other notes on the same
1295.
There will be many who will eagerly and with great care and
(Of those men, who, the older they grow, the more avaricious they
become, whereas, having but little time to stay, they should become
more liberal.)
1016
We see those who are regarded as being most experienced and
judicious, when they least need a thing, seek and cherish it with
most avidity.
Many will be busied in taking away from a thing, which will grow in
proportion as it is diminished.
And it will be seen in many bodies that by raising the head they
swell visibly; and by laying the raised head down again, their size
And many will be hunters of animals, which, the fewer there are the
more will be taken; and conversely, the more there are, the fewer
will be taken.
And many will be busily occupied, though the more of the thing they
1017
(Of the Tongues of Pigs and Calves in Sausage-skins.)
Oh! how foul a thing, that we should see the tongue of one animal in
We shall see the food of animals pass through their skin everyway
(Of Lanterns.)
(Of Feather-beds.)
The mire will be so great that men will walk on the trees of their
country.
1018
(Of the Soles of Shoes, which are made from the Ox.)
And in many parts of the country men will be seen walking on the
There will be great winds by reason of which things of the East will
become things of the West; and those of the South, being involved in
Men will speak to men who hear not; having their eyes open, they
will not see; they will speak to these, and they will not be
answered. They will implore favours of those who have ears and hear
(Of Sawyers.)
There will be many men who will move one against another, holding in
their hands a cutting tool. But these will not do each other any
injury beyond tiring each other; for, when one pushes forward the
other will draw back. But woe to him who comes between them! For he
1019
(Of Silk-spinning.)
Dismal cries will be heard loud, shrieking with anguish, and the
last left naked and motionless; and this by reason of the mover,
(Of putting Bread into the Mouth of the Oven and taking it out
again.)
In every city, land, castle and house, men shall be seen, who for
want of food will take it out of the mouths of others, who will not
The Earth will be seen turned up side down and facing the opposite
Then many of the men who will remain alive, will throw the victuals
they have preserved out of their houses, a free prey to the birds
and beasts of the earth, without taking any care of them at all.
1020
(Of the Rains, which, by making the Rivers muddy, wash away the
Land.)
[Footnote 81: Compare No. 945.] Something will fall from the sky
which will transport a large part of Africa which lies under that
sky towards Europe, and that of Europe towards Africa, and that of
The trees and shrubs in the great forests will be converted into
cinder.
Finally the earth will turn red from a conflagration of many days
(Of the Olives which fall from the Olive trees, shedding oil which
makes light.)
1021
And things will fall with great force from above, which will give us
(Of Owls and screech owls and what will happen to certain birds.)
Many will perish of dashing their heads in pieces, and the eyes of
That which was at first bound, cast out and rent by many and various
(Of Flagellants.)
Men will hide themselves under the bark of trees, and, screaming,
1022
We shall see the horns of certain beasts fitted to iron tools, which
(Of Swords and Spears which by themselves never hurt any one.)
One who by himself is mild enough and void of all offence will
become terrible and fierce by being in bad company, and will most
cruelly take the life of many men, and would kill many more if they
were not hindered by bodies having no soul, that have come out of
Many dead things will move furiously, and will take and bind the
living, and will ensnare them for the enemies who seek their death
and destruction.
(Of Metals.)
That shall be brought forth out of dark and obscure caves, which
1023
will put the whole human race in great anxiety, peril and death. To
many that seek them, after many sorrows they will give delight, and
to those who are not in their company, death with want and
this will take away the lives of many; this will make men torment
creature! How much better would it be for men that every thing
should return to Hell! For this the vast forests will be devastated
of their trees; for this endless animals will lose their lives.
(Of Fire.)
One shall be born from small beginnings which will rapidly become
vast. This will respect no created thing, rather will it, by its
power, transform almost every thing from its own nature into
another.
1024
The masters of estates will eat their own labourers.
Men will be seen so deeply ungrateful that they will turn upon that
which has harboured them, for nothing at all; they will so load it
with blows that a great part of its inside will come out of its
(Of Things which are eaten and which first are killed.)
merciless deaths.
Ditches.)
The high walls of great cities will be seen up side down in their
ditches.
(Of Water, which flows turbid and mixed with Soil and Dust; and of
Mist, which is mixed with the Air; and of Fire which is mixed with
1025
mass, now borne towards the centre of the world, now towards the
sky; and now furiously rushing from the South towards the frozen
North, and sometimes from the East towards the West, and then again
(The division of the East from the West may be made at any point.)
All living creatures will be moved from the East to the West; and in
Bodies devoid of life will move by themselves and carry with them
bystanders.
Oh! how many will they be that never come to the birth!
1026
Endless generations will be lost by the death of the pregnant.
(Of Dreaming.)
Men will walk and not stir, they will talk to those who are not
Shapes and figures of men and animals will be seen following these
animals and men wherever they flee. And exactly as the one moves the
they assume.
(Of our Shadow cast by the Sun, and our Reflection in the Water at
Many a time will one man be seen as three and all three move
1027
Within walnuts and trees and other plants vast treasures will be
Many persons puffing out a breath with too much haste, will thereby
making divers harmonies, with great labour to those who hear them
most closely.
(Of Asses.)
The severest labour will be repaid with hunger and thirst, and
discomfort, and blows, and goadings, and curses, and great abuse.
1028
furiously carrying men to the destruction of their lives.
By the aid of the stars men will be seen who will be as swift as any
swift animal.
The motions of a dead thing will make many living ones flee with
(Of Tinder.)
With a stone and with iron things will be made visible which before
1296.
We shall see the trees of the great forests of Taurus and of Sinai
and of the Appenines and others, rush by means of the air, from East
to West and from North to South; and carry, by means of the air,
great multitudes of men. Oh! how many vows! Oh! how many deaths! Oh!
how many partings of friends and relations! Oh! how many will those
1029
be who will never again see their own country nor their native land,
and who will die unburied, with their bones strewn in various parts
of the world!
Many will forsake their own dwellings and carry with them all their
How many will they be who will bewail their deceased forefathers,
(Of Friars, who spending nothing but words, receive great gifts and
bestow Paradise.)
Invisible money will procure the triumph of many who will spend it.
Many will there be who will die a painful death by means of the
horns of cattle.
1030
Men will speak with each other from the most remote countries, and
reply.
infinite number of Lines, so that every Man always has one of these
other and embrace each other, and understand each other's language.
There will be many men who, when they go to their labour will put on
the richest clothes, and these will be made after the fashion of
aprons [petticoats].
And unhappy women will, of their own free will, reveal to men all
Many will there be who will give up work and labour and poverty of
1031
acceptable to God.
of the very highest price, without leave from the Master of it;
while it never was theirs nor in their power; and human justice will
the road for those who have entirely lost the power of sight.
strong walls, the time will come when the fathers and parents of
those girls will pay a large price to a man who wants to marry them,
even if they are rich, noble and most handsome. Certainly this seems
1032
Animals will be seen on the earth who will always be fighting
against each other with the greatest loss and frequent deaths on
strong limbs we shall see a great portion of the trees of the vast
forests laid low throughout the universe; and, when they are filled
and grief and labour and wars and fury to every living thing; and
from their immoderate pride they will desire to rise towards heaven,
but the too great weight of their limbs will keep them down. Nothing
will remain on earth, or under the earth or in the waters which will
removed into another. And their bodies will become the sepulture and
O Earth! why dost thou not open and engulf them in the fissures of
thy vast abyss and caverns, and no longer display in the sight of
1297.
PROPHECIES.
1033
There will be many who, forgetting their existence and their name,
The East will be seen to rush to the West and the South to the North
in confusion round and about the universe, with great noise and
trembling or fury.
The solar rays will kindle fire on the earth, by which a thing that
is under the sky will be set on fire, and, being reflected by some
(The Concave Mirror kindles a Fire, with which we heat the oven, and
A great part of the sea will fly towards heaven and for a long time
There remains the motion which divides the mover from the thing
moved.
Those who give light for divine service will be destroyed.(The Bees
1034
Dead things will come from underground and by their fierce movements
will send numberless human beings out of the world. (Iron, which
comes from under ground is dead but the Weapons are made of it which
The greatest mountains, even those which are remote from the sea
(This is by Rivers which carry the Earth they wash away from the
Mountains and bear it to the Sea-shore; and where the Earth comes
The water dropped from the clouds still in motion on the flanks of
mountains will lie still for a long period of time without any
motion whatever; and this will happen in many and divers lands.
The great rocks of the mountains will throw out fire; so that they
will burn the timber of many vast forests, and many beasts both wild
and tame.
(The Flint in the Tinder-box which makes a Fire that consumes all
the loads of Wood of which the Forests are despoiled and with this
1035
Oh! how many great buildings will be ruined by reason of Fire.
1298.
The Lion tribe will be seen tearing open the earth with their clawed
paws and in the caves thus made, burying themselves together with
Animals will come forth from the earth in gloomy vesture, which will
their ferocious bites will make confusion of blood among those they
devour.
Again the air will be filled with a mischievous winged race which
will assail men and beasts and feed upon them with much noise--
1299.
1036
Blood will be seen issuing from the torn flesh of men, and trickling
Men will have such cruel maladies that they will tear their flesh
Plants will be seen left without leaves, and the rivers standing
The waters of the sea will rise above the high peaks of the
The largest trees of the forest will be seen carried by the fury of
Men will cast away their own victuals. (That is, in Sowing.)
1300.
Human beings will be seen who will not understand each other's
Fathers will be seen giving their daughters into the power of man
and giving up all their former care in guarding them. (When Girls
1037
are married.)
Men will come out their graves turned into flying creatures; and
they will attack other men, taking their food from their very hand
Many will there be who, flaying their mother, will tear the skin
Happy will they be who lend ear to the words of the Dead. (Who read
1031.
Feathers will raise men, as they do birds, towards heaven (that is,
The works of men's hands will occasion their death. (Swords and
Spears.)
Men out of fear will cling to the thing they most fear. (That is
Things that are separate shall be united and acquire such virtue
that they will restore to man his lost memory; that is papyrus
[sheets] which are made of separate strips and have preserved the
1038
memory of the things and acts of men.
The bones of the Dead will be seen to govern the fortunes of him who
Cattle with their horns protect the Flame from its death. (In a
The Forests will bring forth young which will be the cause of their
1302.
Men will deal bitter blows to that which is the cause of their life.
The skins of animals will rouse men from their silence with great
union. (That is the Comb made of split Cane which unites the threads
of Silk.)
The wind passing through the skins of animals will make men dance.
1039
1303.
Those which have done best will be most beaten, and their offspring
(Of Sculpture.)
Great noise will issue from the sepulchres of those who died evil
(Of the Skins of Animals which have the sense of feeling what is in
The more you converse with skins covered with sentiments, the more
Then almost all the tabernacles in which dwells the Corpus Domini,
1040
roads of the world.
1304.
And those who feed on grass will turn night into day (Tallow.)
And many creatures of land and water will go up among the stars
(that is Planets.)
The dead will be seen carrying the living (in Carts and Ships in
various places.)
Food shall be taken out of the mouth of many ( the oven's mouth.)
And those which will have their food in their mouth will be deprived
1305.
I see Christ sold and crucified afresh, and his Saints suffering
Martyrdom.
1041
Men will come into so wretched a plight that they will be glad that
others will derive profit from their sufferings or from the loss of
(Of the Religion of Friars, who live by the Saints who have been
Those who are dead will, after a thou- sand years be those who will
(Of Stones converted into Lime, with which prison walls are made.)
Many things that have been before that time destroyed by fire will
1306.
other times was eaten by others, who for some months to come will
(Of Cockles and Sea Snails which are thrown up by the sea and which
1042
How many will there be who, after they are dead, will putrefy inside
their own houses, filling all the surrounding air with a fetid
smell.
1307.
(Of Mules which have on them rich burdens of silver and gold.)
Much treasure and great riches will be laid upon four-footed beasts,
1308.
Huge figures will appear in human shape, and the nearer you get to
occurs in the note book used in 1502, when Leonardo, in the service
1309.
1043
(Of Snakes, carried by Storks.)
Creatures will come from underground which with their terrific noise
will stun all who are near; and with their breath will kill men and
1310.
Men will fling out of their houses those victuals which were
Fathers and mothers will be seen to take much more delight in their
1044
Some will go about in white garments with arrogant gestures
threatening others with metal and fire which will do no harm at all
to them.
1311.
(Of the Life of Men, who every year change their bodily substance.)
1312.
(Shoemakers.)
Men will take pleasure in seeing their own work destroyed and
injured.
1313.
(Of Kids.)
1045
The time of Herod will come again, for the little innocent children
will be taken from their nurses, and will die of terrible wounds
V.
1314.
A FABLE.
The crab standing under the rock to catch the fish which crept under
it, it came to pass that the rock fell with a ruinous downfall of
THE SAME.
The spider, being among the grapes, caught the flies which were
feeding on those grapes. Then came the vintage, and the spider was
The vine that has grown old on an old tree falls with the ruin of
that tree, and through that bad companionship must perish with it.
1046
The torrent carried so much earth and stones into its bed, that it
The net that was wont to take the fish was seized and carried away
every other plant, from having associated itself with the vine which
1315.
The cedar puffed up with pride of its beauty, separated itself from
the trees around it and in so doing it turned away towards the wind,
which not being broken in its fury, flung it uprooted on the earth.
The traveller's joy, not content in its hedge, began to fling its
branches out over the high road, and cling to the opposite hedge,
1047
1316.
The goldfinch gives victuals to its caged young. Death rather than
1317.
(Of Bags.)
1318.
All those things which in winter are hidden under the snow, will be
remain hidden).
1319.
A FABLE.
The lily set itself down by the shores of the Ticino, and the
1320.
1048
A JEST.
1321.
A SIMILE.
baked one.
1322.
Seeing the paper all stained with the deep blackness of ink, it he
deeply regrets it; and this proves to the paper that the words,
1323.
The pen must necessarily have the penknife for a companion, and it
is a useful companionship, for one is not good for much without the
other.
1049
1324.
1325.
death, by being used for snares and nets for birds, animals and
wrapped when they are buried, and who become corrupt in these
winding sheets.-- And again, this flax does not separate its fibre
till it has begun to steep and putrefy, and this is the flower with
1326.
Shadows will come from the East which will blacken with great colour
1050
All men will take refuge in Africa.
1327.
stream, in the waters of which the cloth leaves all its foulness and
which of themselves were not disposed towards virtue, but by the aid
1328.
A COMMON THING.
The image of the sun where it falls appears as a thing which covers
Out of cavernous pits a thing shall come forth which will make all
1051
the nations of the world toil and sweat with the greatest torments,
itself in men that they will rush together, with a rapid motion,
(Of Advice.)
The man who may be most necessary to him who needs him, will be
1329.
(Of Bees.)
take the honey from them. Many and very great nations will be
1330.
1052
This animal has a horror of the poor, because they eat poor food,
and it loves the rich, because they have good living and especially
meat. And the excrement of animals always retains some virtue of its
Now dogs have so keen a smell, that they can discern by their nose
the virtue remaining in these faeces, and if they find them in the
streets, smell them and if they smell in them the virtue of meat or
of other things, they take them, and if not, they leave them: And to
know that dog to be well fed, they respect him, because they judge
that he has a powerful and rich master; and if they discover no such
smell with the virtue of meet, they judge that dog to be of small
account and to have a poor and humble master, and therefore they
1331.
men never stop in their work; and it is done in many ways. By one of
shoulders first fills the tub on the ground, and he loses time in
1053
Irony (1332).
1332.
in sausages and with tunny; I cannot put any value on their foolery.
Tricks (1333-1335).
1333.
saying it makes it appear that the two brothers have become four.
1334.
TRICKS OF DIVIDING.
Take in each hand an equal number; put 4 from the right hand into
the left; cast away the remainder; cast away an equal number from
the left hand; add 5, and now you will find 13 in this [left] hand;
1054
that is-I made you put 4 from the right hand into the left, and cast
away the remainder; now your right hand has 4 more; then I make you
throw away as many from the right as you threw away from the left;
so, throwing from each hand a quantity of which the remainder may be
equal, you now have 4 and 4, which make 8, and that the trick may
not be detec- ted I made you put 5 more, which made 13.
TRICKS OF DIVIDING.
Take any number less than 12 that you please; then take of mine
enough to make up the number 12, and that which remains to me is the
number which you at first had; because when I said, take any number
you took such a number as made up your number of 12; and what you
added to your number, you took from mine; that is, if you had 8 to
1335.
1055
If you want to teach someone a subject you do not know yourself, let
learn the measure you did not know before;--Master Giovanni da Lodi.
XXI.
Leonardo's life written some time after his death by Vasari and
others, any notes or letters which can throw more light on his
1056
accompanying sketches, are the work of Leonardo's own hand. Not
merely is the character of the handwriting his, but the spelling and
the language are his also. In one respect only does the writing
betray any marked deviation from the rest of the notes, especially
Giuliano de' Medici, and what can be more natural, I may ask, than
interests are in the scale? The finished copies as sent off are not
service of the Egyptian Sultan, and that Leonardo had copied his
that this unknown writer must have been so far one in mind with
Leonardo as to use the same style of language and even the same
possible, if only we had the finished letters. But why should these
actually and obviously are? If Leonardo had been a man of our own
saying that Leonardo, without having been in the East himself, might
1057
have undertaken to write a Romance of which the scene was laid in
been put forward (see No. 1336 note 5); and it would certainly seem
to which these letters point, and their bearing on the life of the
have written them with the intention of mystifying those who, after
publishing them? But if, in fact, no objection that will stand the
fact, especially as the details of his life for some few years are
1058
undertaking such a journey. We have no information as to Leonardo's
office--, and Leonardo on his return home may have kept silence on
disappointment.
From the text of No. 1379 we can hardly doubt that Leonardo intended
there, they show beyond a doubt that, next to the Nile, the
Italy.
1059
If the style of these letters were less sober, and the expressions
passages as No. 1354, Nos. 670-673, and the Fables and Prophecies.
Leonardo and this prince were certainly far less closely connected,
seem, that what kept him there, in spite of his sore need of the
money owed him by the prince, was the hope of some day being able to
1336.
BABYLON.
1060
will terrify not you alone but the whole world, which
1061
Mamelook supremacy over Syria, which corresponded in date with
in the State.
not that Babylon which stood on the further shore of the river
by Cairo and the twain are but one and not two towns; one half is
called Cairo and the other Babylon, whence they are called together
Memphis and then Babylon, but now it is called Cairo." Compare No.
1085, 6.
of these, Sultan Kait Bey, ruled from 1468-1496 during whose reign
the Gama (or Mosque) of Kait Bey and tomb of Kait Bey near the
Okella Kait Bey were erected in Cairo, which preserve his name to
this day. Under the rule of this great and wise prince many
of Bale) Kait Bey's most helpful engineer was a German who in about
1062
Felix Fabri knew him and mentions him in his Historia Suevorum,
written in 1488."
shall be related to you in due order, showing first the effect and
then the cause. [Footnote 4: The text here breaks off. The following
same person, but, as it would seem, written at a later date than the
to choose such words and phrases as might best express his own
ideas.]
governed the Eastern, and the Arabs the Southern portions. Arabic
1063
territory between Cappadocia and the Euphrates. It was not till
1522, or even 1574 that the whole country came under the dominion of
visiting Antioch and the valleys of the Tigris and Euphrates with a
1064
his superior, had a special interest in the welfare of those
prince who had allied himself with the Osmanli to threaten the
which broke out in the following year between the contending powers.
Only a few years earlier the same province had been the scene of the
position to prove with regard to these texts, that they are draughts
1065
subject in the Zeitschrift fur bildende Kunst (Vol. XVI), Prof.
Leonardo volesse farne un libro, che poi non venne compiuto. A ogni
the sources from which Leonardo could be supposed to have drawn his
1066
the same time, I cannot but admit that the solution of the
tale; for it needs only a glance at the sketches on PI. CXVI to CXIX
to perceive that they are connected with the texts; and of course
East, the greater part of which are here published for the first
von Soler, the other by Olivez de Majorca, in l584-I find this place
1067
Leonardo seems to prove that it was a place of no great importance
dall'Eitfrates.
peak of the Taurus is here meant; and I greatly regret that I had no
and Cilicia, and had to travel for some time in view of the imposing
landscape. 4 ore inanzi seems to mean, four hours before the sun's
to carry into effect with due love and care the task for which you
1068
seemed to me to be most to our purpose, I entered into the city of
base of that part of the Taurus mountains which is divided from the
Euphrates and looks towards the peaks of the great Mount Taurus [8]
to the West [9]. These peaks are of such a height that they seem to
touch the sky, and in all the world there is no part of the earth,
higher than its summit[10], and the rays of the sun always fall upon
it on its East side, four hours before day-time, and being of the
towards the West, illuminated by the sun after its setting the third
part of the night. This it is, which with you [Footnote 14:
and sometimes short. And this is caused by the clouds on the horizon
1069
of the sky which interpose between part of this mountain and the
sun, and by cutting off some of the solar rays the light on the
THE DIVISIONS OF THE BOOK [Footnote 19: The next 33 lines are
writing.].
The preacher's search, his release and benevolence [Footnote 28: The
1070
meaning to be worth hazarding.]
His prophesy.
Mountains.
shaken by an earthquake; and the earth shall cast forth her burdens;
and a man shall say, what aileth her? On that day the earth shall
declare her tidings, for that thy Lord will inspire her. On that day
1071
men shall go forward in distinct classes, that they may behold their
works. And whoever shall have wrought good of the weight of an ant,
shall behold the same. And whoever shall have wrought evil of the
as he had foretold.
Why the mountain shines at the top, from half to a third of the
night, and looks like a comet to the inhabitants of the West after
and now long, and now again divided into two or three parts, and now
seem to hint; but your excessive love for me, which gave rise to the
effect. And this could not be done without time; now, in order to
1072
satisfy you fully as to the cause of so great an effect, it is
requisite that I should explain to you the form of the place, and
amply satisfied.
the Taurus range near the influx of the Kura Shai; it rushes through
a rift in the wildest cliffs from 2000 to 3000 feet high and runs on
only 35 paces across. Compare the map on Pl. CXIX and the
annoyance which is absent from the second. I do not see how these
your pressing request, for those things which you require of me are
1073
lapse of time; particularly because, in order to explain the cause
it. The purport of both is essentially the same, but the first is
second. I do not see how these two versions can be reconciled with
what seas or lands form the limits of its outline and extent,
which is the cause of this stupendous and harmful marvel, and which
give evidence that this must be the true Caucasus, and that though
their mountains bear the same name, yet these are higher; and to
West, any mountain so high. And the proof of this is that the
1074
inhabitants of the countries to the West see the rays of the sun
the longest night. And in the same way, in those countries which lie
to the East.
Taurus is of such a height that when, in the middle of June, the Sun
to the North [75]. And the side which faces the wind is always free
from clouds and mists, because the wind which is parted in beating
on the rock, closes again on the further side of that rock, and in
its motion carries with it the clouds from all quarters and leaves
the great quantity of clouds which accumulate there, whence the rock
is all riven and full of huge debris [Footnote 77: Sudden storms are
observe that Ararat cannot be meant here. Its summit is formed like
Near the solitary peak, Pl. CXVIII these three names are written
1075
CXVI and CXVII are in the original on a single sheet folded down the
half of the sheet are notes on peso and bilancia (weight and
balance), on the other are the 'prophecies' printed under Nos. 1293
and 1294. It is evident from the arrangement that these were written
subsequently, on the space which had been left blank. These pages
than in the original; the map of Armenia, Pl. CXVIII, is on Pl. CXIX
is on its slope).
for Thospitis = Lake Van, Arm. Dgov Vanai, Tospoi, and the Mountain
from the high land of 'Argeo' on the West, is the Tochma Su, which
1076
joins the main river at Malatie. I have not been able to discover
any map of Armenia of the XVth or XVIth century in which the course
of the Euphrates is laid down with any thing like the correctness
trees, and beech and other similar trees; after this, for a space of
three more miles, there are meadows and vast pastures; and all the
height of a mile the clouds never pass away; thus we have fifteen
miles, that is, a height of about five miles in a straight line; and
the summit of the peaks of the Taurus are as much, or about that.
There, half way up, we begin to find a scorching air and never feel
a breath of wind; but nothing can live long there; there nothing is
brought forth save a few birds of prey which breed in the high
fissures of Taurus and descend below the clouds to seek their prey.
Above the wooded hills all is bare rock, that is, from the clouds
walk to the high summit on account of the rough and perilous ascent.
1077
1337.
refer to the same event. (Compare also No. 1337 l. 10-l2 and 17 with
No. 1336 l. 23, 24 and 32.) But the text No. 1336, including the
fragment l. 3-4, was obviously written later than the draft here
that it was written to some other patron and friend whose name and
Having many times rejoiced with you by letters over your prosperous
fortunes, I know now that, as a friend you will be sad with me over
the miserable state in which I find myself; and this is, that during
the last few days I have been in so much trouble, fear, peril and
loss, besides the miseries of the people here, that we have been
envious of the dead; and certainly I do not believe that since the
1078
man. As far as regards us here, what we have seen and gone through
is such that I could not imagine that things could ever rise to such
In the first place we were assailed and attacked by the violence and
fury of the winds [10]; to this was added the falling of great
great part of our city [Footnote 11: Della nostra citta (Leonardo
first wrote di questa citta). From this we may infer that he had
And not content with this the tempest sent a sudden flood of water
to submerge all the low part of this city [12]; added to which there
sand, mud, and stones, entangled with roots, and stems and fragments
of various trees; and every kind of thing flying through the air
fell upon us; finally a great fire broke out, not brought by the
ceased. And those few who remain unhurt are in such dejection and
such terror that they hardly have courage to speak to each other, as
here together in the ruins of some churches, men and women mingled
to speak of as churches.
1079
usually strict rule of the separation of the sexes.], just like
[Footnote 18: I vicini, nostri nimici. The town must then have
near Lake Como". We do in fact find, among other loose sheets in the
(see Nos. 1030, 1031 and note p. 237) and in the arrangement of the
loose sheets, of which the Codex Atlanticus has been formed, these
the same folio sheet; and if this is not the reason for Dr. JORDAN'S
Leonardo.]
it had not been for certain people who succoured us with victuals,
all would have died of hunger. Now you see the state we are in. And
all these evils are as nothing compared with those which are
promised to us shortly.
1080
I know that as a friend you will grieve for my misfortunes, as I, in
1338.
I have seen motions of the air so furious that they have carried,
mixed up in their course, the largest trees of the forest and whole
roofs of great palaces, and I have seen the same fury bore a hole
gravel, sand and water more than half a mile through the air.
mountain No. 610, l. 17-30 were written from the vivid impressions
1081
derived from personal experience. Compare also Pl. XXXIV-XL.]
1339.
this passage was written between 1470 and 1480. As the figure 6 at
the end of the text indicates, it was continued on another page, but
I have searched in vain for it. The reverse of this leaf is coloured
red for drawing in silver point, but has not been used for that
purpose but for writing on, and at about the same date. The passages
are given as Nos. 1217, 1218, 1219, 1162 and No. 994 (see note page
Like a whirling wind which rushes down a sandy and hollow valley,
and which, in its hasty course, drives to its centre every thing
progress ...
Nor does the tempestuous sea bellow so loud, when the Northern blast
dashes it, with its foaming waves between Scylla and Charybdis; nor
Stromboli, nor Mount Etna, when their sulphurous flames, having been
1082
forcibly confined, rend, and burst open the mountain, fulminating
stones and earth through the air together with the flames they
vomit.
Nor when the inflamed caverns of Mount Etna [Footnote 13: Mongibello
of the Volcano with a great flow of lava on Sept. 21, 1447. The next
records of the mountain are from the years 1533 and 1536. A. Percy
neither does mention any eruptions of Etna during the years to which
time, when passing the island on the way from Naples to Messina.],
Unable to resist my eager desire and wanting to see the great ... of
1083
the various and strange shapes made by formative nature, and having
left hand on my knee and held my right hand over my down-cast and
contracted eye brows: often bending first one way and then the
remained there some time, two contrary emotions arose in me, fear
1340.
(l. 18) and the absence of any signature prove that this is merely
very few manuscripts which are written from left to right--see the
the usual manner. Leonardo no doubt very rarely wrote so, and this
1084
exceptional. But such superficial peculiarities are not enough to
But whether the fragment, as we here see it, was written from
himself, but the notes in his own hand found on the reverse pages of
With regard to the probable date of this projected letter see Vol.
II, p. 3.]
instruments of war, and that the invention and operation of the said
1085
opportune moments as well as all those things which, in part, shall
be most easily carried, and with them you may pursue, and at any
time flee from the enemy; and others, secure and indestructible by
fire and battle, easy and convenient to lift and place. Also methods
the trenches, and make endless variety of bridges, and covered ways
on a rock, &c.
and with these can fling small stones almost resembling a storm; and
with the smoke of these causing great terror to the enemy, to his
9) [8] And when the fight should be at sea I have kinds of many
machines most efficient for offence and defence; and vessels which
1086
will resist the attack of the largest guns and powder and fumes.
5) Item. I have means by secret and tortuous mines and ways, made
men so great but they would break them. And behind these, infantry
7) Item. In case of need I will make big guns, mortars and light
buildings public and private; and in guiding water from one place to
another.
Item: I can carry out sculpture in marble, bronze or clay, and also
1087
in painting whatever may be done, and as well as any other, be he
whom he may.
the immortal glory and eternal honour of the prince your father of
1341.
Florence-- Leonardo.
Duke, and written, like the foregoing from left to right. The
proclaimed and styled Duke of Milan till September 1494. The Dukedom
1342.
You would like to see a model which will prove useful to you and to
1088
me, also it will be of use to those who will be the cause of our
usefulness.
[Footnote: 1342. 1343. These two notes occur in the same not very
voluminous MS. as the former one and it is possible that they are
1343.
There are here, my Lord, many gentlemen who will undertake this
admission to the waters, the mills, and the passage of vessels and
canal of Martesana.
1344.
1089
I am greatly annoyed that you should have found me in necessity, and
hope in a short time to have earned so much that I may carry it out
myself; and if your Lordship thought that I had money, your Lordship
was deceived. I had to feed 6 men for 56 months, and have had 50
ducats.
1345.
by any ...
1090
My Lord, I knowing your Excellency's
1091
living ...
myself ...
rooms ...
you ...
the concluding sentence (No. 1346, l. 33. 34 and No. 1347), that
1092
whose name and signature a copy of it was sent to the Commission.]
1346.
in bronze, will remind you of certain things: first that you should
master; and some man of small merit may be chosen, who by his
judging that this age was but ill supplied with men of good counsel
and with good masters; seeing that other cities, and chiefly the
endowed with beautiful and grand works in bronze; among which are
pass; who, seeing that the works are fine and of good quality, carry
away a good impression, and will say that that city is well filled
their opinion; and on the other hand, I say seeing so much metal
expended and so badly wrought, it were less shame to the city if the
Now the principal parts which are sought for in cities are their
1093
cathedrals, and of these the first things which strike the eye are
great a work as that which I hear you have ordered, be the cause
that that which was intended for the honour of God and of men should
lack of diligence you were to put your trust in some vaunter, who by
his tricks or by favour shown to him here should obtain such work
from you, by which lasting and very great shame would result to him
and to you. Thus I cannot help being angry when I consider what men
those are who have conferred with you as wishing to undertake this
great work without thinking of their sufficiency for it, not to say
more. This one is a potter, that one a maker of cuirasses, this one
26: Messer Ambrogio Ferrere was Farmer of the Customs under the
Duke. Piacenza at that time belonged to Milan.], who has some power
and who has made him some promises; and if this were not enough he
would mount on horseback, and go to his Lord and obtain such letters
that you could never refuse [to give] him the work. But consider
where masters of real talent and fit for such work are brought when
1094
they have to compete with such men as these. Open your eyes and look
disgrace. I can declare to you that from that place you will procure
Duke Francesco and who has no need to bring himself into notice,
because he has work for all his life time; and I doubt, whether
The miserable painstakers ... with what hope may they expect a
1347.
There is one whom his Lordship invited from Florence to do this work
and who is a worthy master, but with so very much business he will
never finish it; and you may imagine that a difference there is to
1348.
1095
per la Vita di Leonardo da Vinci. Atti e Memorie delle R. R.
Vol. III. It is the only text throughout this work which I have not
myself examined and copied from the original. The learned discoverer
1096
autentica e fornita della menzione e del suggello che fresca ancora
at Ferrare.
I arrived from Milan but a few days since and finding that my elder
brother refuses to
carry into effect a will, made three years ago when my father
into the hands of the said Ser Raphaello, that his Worship may have
able, that your Highness will write a letter to the said Ser
1097
servant as I am, and shall always be; requesting him and pressing
not the least doubt, from many things that I hear, that Ser
E. V. R. D.
1349.
I am afraid lest the small return I have made for the great
benefits, I have received from your Excellency, have not made you
somewhat angry with me, and that this is why to so many letters
myself with you this Easter, and to carry with me two pictures of
two Madonnas of different sizes. These were done for our most
1098
Christian King, or for whomsoever your Lordship may please. I should
for I would not give any more trouble to your Lordship. Also, as I
king granted me, and which I was not put in possession of because at
that time there was a dearth in the canal by reason of the great
has noted the payment of the pension from the king in 1505.] its
Lordship that you will take so much trouble, now that these outlets
make there instruments and other things which will greatly please
for business connected with his estate. The letter written with
1099
letters Nos. 1349 and 1350. Amoretti tells us, Memorie Storiche,
ch. II, that the following note existed on the same leaf in MS. C.
thus: Jo sono quasi al fine del mio letizio che io o con mie
offerse di conciar le cose nostre fra noi fratelli del comune della
1350.
the bearer of this, and from him you will hear by word of mouth the
cause of my...
did not enter into possession, because at that time when it was
1100
given to me there was a dearth of water in the canal, as well by
reason of the great drought as also because the outlets were not
done, I should have my rights. Afterwards hearing that the canal was
Girolamo da Cusano,who has in his keeping the deed of this gift; and
may tell by word of mouth all that happened in the matter about
two pictures of our Lady which I have begun, and at the present time
have brought them on to a very good end; nothing else occurs to me.
My Lord the love which your Excellency has always shown me and the
I am fearful lest the small return I have made for the great
benefits I have received from your Excellency may not have made you
somewhat annoyed with me. And this is why, to many letters which I
with you this Easter and carry with me two pictures on which are two
1101
where, on my return from this place, I shall have to reside, because
reason of the dearth in the canal, caused by the great drought and
possession of it; I therefore pray you that, if you should meet the
said President, you would be good enough, now that the outlets are
Good day to you Messer Francesco. Why, in God's name, of all the
letters I have written to you, have you never answered one. Now wait
till I come, by God, and I shall make you write so much that perhaps
the canal had been ordered, because His Magnificence the President
is now some time since I heard that the canal was in order, as also
1102
and then I repeated it, and never had an answer. So you will have
to hurry the matter, would you take the trouble, for the love of me,
like Cesare da Sesto and others (See LERMOLIEFF, Die Galerien &c.,
p. 476).]
135l.
your...]
restoration of your health, that it almost had the effect that [my
illness left me-- --of your Excellency's almost restored health. But
1103
deceiver, for whom I left nothing undone which could be done for him
his allowances were paid to him before the time, which I believe he
would willingly deny, if I had not the writing signed by myself and
the interpreter. And I, seeing that he did not work for me unless he
can there be any doubt that they were addressed to Leonardo's patron
the head of the Florentine Republic. The Pope invited him to Rome,
ceremonial. The medal struck in honour of the event bears the words
139) thus describes the character of Giuliano de' Medici, who died
1104
See too GREGOROVIUS, Geschichte der Stadi Rom, VIII (book XIV.
III, 2): Die Luftschlosser furstlicher Grosse, wozu ihn der Papst
eine dunkle Gestalt die wie ein Schatten voruberzog. Giuliano lived
M. Eug. Muntz, librarian of the Ecole des Beaux arts, Paris, has
From this we learn, that seven ducats formed the German's monthly
1105
never do so. And this I did also, because that Giovanni, the German
who makes the mirrors, was there always in the workshop, and wanted
to see and to know all that was being done there and made it known
outside ... strongly criticising it; and because he dined with those
of the Pope's guard, and then they went out with guns killing birds
among the ruins; and this went on from after dinner till the
evening; and when I sent Lorenzo to urge him to work he said that he
would not have so many masters over him, and that his work was for
went on; and one day finding Gian Niccolo of the Wardrobe and asking
whether the German had finished the work for your Magnificence, he
told me this was not true, but only that he had given him two guns
workshop and began to work in his room, and lost much time in making
another pair of pincers and files and other tools with screws; and
there he worked at mills for twisting silk which he hid when any one
restoration of your health, that my own illness almost left me. But
deceiver, for whom I left nothing undone by which I could have hope
to please him; and secondly I invited him to lodge and board with
me, by which means I should constantly see the work he was doing and
1106
with greater ease correct his errors while, besides this, he would
learn the Italian tongue, by means of which be could with more ease
to carry them away to his own country. But this I refused him,
telling him that I would give him, in drawing, the breadth, length,
ill-will.
The next thing was that he made himself another workshop and pincers
and tools in his room where he slept, and there he worked for
where there are idle fellows, in which he beat them all; and most
times they went two or three together with guns, to shoot birds
At last I found how this master Giovanni the mirror-maker was he who
had done it all, for two reasons; the first because he had said that
your Lordship which always... The other is that he said that his
this he gave proof; for besides making him my enemy, he made him
sell all he had and leave his workshop to him, where he works with a
1107
1352.
recovery of your health, that my own ills have almost left me; and I
say God be praised for it. But it vexes me greatly that I have not
him to lodge and board with me, by which means I should see
constantly the work he was doing, for which purpose I would have a
table fixed at the foot of one of these windows, where he could work
with the file and finish the things made below; and so I should
constantly see the work he might do, and it could be corrected with
greater ease.
1353.
likewise at the hospital; and he has filled [4] this whole Belvedere
with workshops for mirrors; and he did the same thing in Maestro
Giorgio's room. He said that he had been promised [7] eight ducats
every month, beginning with the first day, when he set out, or at
1108
Seeing that he seldom stayed in the workshop, and that he ate a
great deal, I sent him word that, if he liked I could deal with him
separately for each thing that he might make, and would give him
neighbour and gave up his room, selling every thing, and went to
find...
1354.
Perhaps Leonardo had the Giant Antaeus in his mind. Of him the myth
contact with his mother earth; but that Hercules lifted him up and
Dear Benedetto de' Pertarti. When the proud giant fell because of
the bloody and miry state of the ground it was as though a mountain
terror fell on Pluto in hell. From the violence of the shock he lay
1109
as stunned on the level ground. Suddenly the people, seeing him as
over the body of the fallen oak, so these rushing over his ample
suddenly perceives the smarting of the stabs, and sent forth a roar
which sounded like a terrific clap of thunder; and placing his hands
on the ground he raised his terrible face: and having lifted one
like the minute creatures which not unfrequently are found there;
wherefore with a shake of his head he sends the men flying through
the air just as hail does when driven by the fury of the winds. Many
And clinging to his hair, and striving to hide in it, they behaved
like sailors in a storm, who run up the ropes to lessen the force of
who came from the Lybian desert... mad with rage like ants....
This great Giant was born in Mount Atlas and was a hero ... and had
1110
lived in the sea on whales, grampuses and ships.
Mars fearing for his life took refuge under the... of Jove.
And at the great fall it seemed as though the whole province quaked.
1355.
This spirit returns to the brain whence it had departed, with a loud
O blessed and happy spirit whence comest thou? Well have I known
with every vice. But of what use is it to fatigue myself with vain
words? Nothing is to be found in them but every form of sin ... And
if there should be found among them any that possesses any good,
1111
and worse if they are friendly.
1356.
All the ills that are or ever were, if they could be set to work by
him, would not satisfy the desires of his iniquitous soul; and I
could not in any length of time describe his nature to you, but I
conclude...
1357.
I know one who, having promised me much, less than my due, being
all my friends; and as he has found them wise and not pliable to his
Lordship of this, to the end [that this man who wishes to sow the
usual scandals, may find no soil fit for sowing the thoughts and
deeds of his evil nature] so that he, trying to make your Lordship,
1358.
1112
[Footnote: Below this text we read gusstino--Giustino and in another
passage on the same page Justin is quoted (No. 1210, 1. 48). The two
And in this case I know that I shall make few enemies seeing that no
one will believe what I can say of him; for they are but few whom
his vices have disgusted, and he only dislikes those men whose
natures are contrary to those vices. And many hate their fathers,
and break off friendship with those who reprove their vices; and he
will not permit any examples against them, nor any advice.
If you meet with any one who is virtuous do not drive him from you;
do him honour, so that he may not have to flee from you and be
him honour, for these are our Saints upon earth; these are they who
deserve statues from us, and images; but remember that their images
Sikhism. In central Thibet the ashes of the dead, when burnt, are
out of them and some are laid in the grave while others are
1113
distributed among the relations. The custom spoken of by Leonardo
may have prevailed there but I never heard of it." Possibly Leonardo
cut them in pieces, being of wood, and give them to all the people
of the country, not without payment; and each one grates his portion
very fine, and puts it upon the first food he eats; and thus
believes that by faith he has eaten his saint who then preserves him
from all perils. What do you think here, Man, of your own species?
Are you so wise as you believe yourselves to be? Are these things to
be done by men?
1359.
1360.
1361.
1114
14inferri\\\ 15abuss\\\ 16in viagg\\\ 17alorz\\\ [Footnote: This
the lines have been preserved, the leaf being torn down the middle.
No translation is possible.]
1362.
And so may it please our great Author that I may demonstrate the
nature of man and his customs, in the way I describe his figure.
[Footnote: A preparatory note for the passage given as No. 798, 11.
41--42.]
1363.
with its tail, and struck me several times with its tail inside my
lips.
1364.
1115
it being grown up, you will do worse to me.]
1365.
1366.
1367.
of love.
1368.
Nos. 1341, 1348 and 1374 (see also No. 1346, l. 33). The form
1116
diminished--on Pl. I, has in the original two lines of writing
only an imitation.]
1369.
The day of Santa Maria della Neve [of the Snows] August the 2nd
a rocky landscape. See Chronique des Arts 1881 no. 23: Leonard de
Geymuller. The next following date in the MSS. is 1478 (see No.
663).
1370.
On the 2nd of April 1489, book entitled 'Of the human figure'.
[Footnote: While the letters in the MS. notes of 1473 and 1478 are
very ornate, this note and the texts on anatomy on the same sheet
(for instance No. 805) are in the same simple hand as we see on Pl.
CXVI and CXIX. No 1370 is the only dated note of the years between
1480 and 1489, and the characters are in all essential points
1117
identical with those that we see in the latest manuscripts written
No. 2; No. 664, note, Vol. I p. 346. This shows already a marked
The text No. 720 belongs to the year 1490; No. 1510 to the year
1492; No. 1459, No. 1384 and No. 1460 to the year 1493; No. 1463,
No. 1517, No. 1024, 1025 and 1461 to the year 1494; Nos. 1523 and
1371.
Storiche, chap. XIX: Sembra pertanto che non nel 1499 ma nel 1500,
1118
l'ogetto delle sue idrostatiche ricerche. At that time Melzi was
only six years of age. The next date is 1502; to this year belong
No. 1034, 1040, 1042, 1048 and 1053. The note No. 1525 belongs to
1372.
On the 9th of July 1504, Wednesday, at seven o'clock, died Ser Piero
o'clock, being eighty years old, leaving behind ten sons and two
daughters.
and 146. Leonardo was, as is well known, a natural son. His mother
1119
halfbrothers, Antonio (b. 1476), Ser Giuliano (b. 1479), Lorenzo (b.
1484), a girl, Violante (b. 1485), and another boy Domenico (b.
Pandolfo (b. 1494), Guglielmo (b. 1496), Bartolommeo (b. 1497), and
children. The dates of their deaths are not known, but we may infer
from the above passage that they were all still living in 1505.]
1373.
July 1504.
[Footnote: This and the previous text it may be remarked are the
only mention made by Leonardo of his father; Nos. 1526, 1527 and No.
1374.
[Footnote: Thus he writes on the first page of the MS. The title is
1120
disstrafformatione coe (cioe) d'un corpo nvn (in un) altro sanza
1375.
[Footnote: No. 1528 and No. 1529 belong to the same year. The text
Vol. I, No. 4 belongs to the following year 1509 (1508 old style);
so also does No. 1009.-- Nos. 1022, 1057 and 1464 belong to 1511.]
1376.
[Footnote: No. 1465 belongs to the same year. No. 1065 has the next
date 1514.]
1377.
The Magnifico Giuliano de' Medici left Rome on the 9th of January
1515, just at daybreak, to take a wife in Savoy; and on the same day
1121
daughter of Filippo, Duke of Savoy, and aunt to Francis I, Louis
XII's successor on the throne of France. Louis XII died on Jan. 1st,
1378.
of...
XXII.
Miscellaneous Notes.
MSS. can have been for the most part intelligible to the writer
only; in many cases their meaning and connection are all the more
Leonardo used to converse nor can we say what part he may have
played in the various events of his time. Vasari and other early
1122
towards supplying this deficiency, they are nevertheless of some
explain the meaning of some other note of a similar kind. The first
to his pupils and to other artists and artificers who lived in his
1490 and 1500, when Leonardo was living at Milan under the patronage
Milan, it seems hardly likely that we should not find a single note
the numerous loose leaves in his writing that exist. Leonardo's life
uneventful. The MSS. and memoranda of those years seem to prove that
1123
than of bustling court life. Whatever may have been the fate of the
his pupils are few and meagre. Excepting for the record of money
him to make any written observations on the persons with whom he was
read (see Nrs. 10, 11, 1159) and he more than once expressly states
admiration for the illustrious Greek to whose genius his own was so
1124
much akin (see No. 1476). All his notes on various authors,
convenience (1469--1508).
wealth, the splendid mode of life and lavish expenditure which have
may therefore have occasionally used paper on which others had made
short memoranda, for the most part as it would seem, for his use. At
the end of all I have given Leonardo's will from the copy of it
1125
original document.
1379.
Find Longhi and tell him that you wait for him at Rome and will go
with him to Naples; make you pay the donation [Footnote 2: Libro di
Vitolone see No. 1506 note.] and take the book by Vitolone, and the
jerkin of... and skins, to make new ones; the lake of Alessandro.
[Footnote: 7 and fol. It would seem from the text that Leonardo
Sell what you cannot take with you. Get from Jean de Paris the
1126
evidently the name of a person; for amor a: a Roma, for ilopan
on some secrets of his art Nos. 641 and 729, the only other places
There can be no doubt, from the tenor of this passage, that Leonardo
we may infer that Leonardo really had at the time plans for
that he purposed, after selling every thing that was not easily
His luggage was to be packed into two trunks especially adapted for
salt, and how to make tinted paper; sheets of paper folded up; and
dissolve gum lac, linseed ... white, of the garlic of Piacenza; take
small furnace ... seed of lilies and of... Sell the boards of the
1127
support. Make him who stole it, give you the ... learn levelling and
1380.
This was done by Leone in the piazza of the castle with a chain and
1381.
NAMES OF ENGINEERS.
IV, I, 9), and of the method of boring marble (Paus. I, 26, 7), was
identified.]
1382.
1128
Ask maestro Lodovico for 'the conduits of water'. [Footnote:
1383.
1384.
Messer Mariolo's Morel the Florentin, has a big horse with a fine
The white stallion belonging to the falconer has fine hind quarters;
Nos. 1522 and 1517. Caterina seems to have been his housekeeper.]
1385.
1129
OF THE INSTRUMENT.
Any one who spends one ducat may take the instrument; and he will
not pay more than half a ducat as a premium to the inventor of the
instrument and one grosso to the workman every year. I do not want
1386.
1387.
1388.
1130
1389.
Chiliarch--captain of 1000.
Prefects--captains.
1390.
1391.
Needle,--Niccolao,--thread,--Ferrando, -lacopo
Andrea,--canvas,--stone,--colours, --brushes,--pallet,--sponge,--the
1392.
1131
1393.
1394.
1395.
1396.
1397.
1398.
1132
1399.
1400.
Give your master the instance of a captain who does not himself win
1401.
1402.
1403.
1404.
1133
Hospital. [Footnote: Compare the text on the same page: No. 667.]
1405.
1406.
Evangelista is 75.
page and that which faces it, MS.I2 7la, are two diagrams with
of a street.]
1407.
I ask at what part of its curved motion the moving cause will leave
1408.
1134
Antonio de' Risi is at the council of Justice.
1409.
Paolo said that no machine that moves another .... [Footnote: The
1410.
No. I (above, to the left). On Pl. XIII, No. 2 above to the right we
read cerovazo.]
1411.
Pulleys,--nails,--rope,--mercury,--cloth, Monday.
1412.
MEMORANDUM.
1135
Maghino, Speculus of Master Giovanni the Frenchman; Galenus on
utility.
1413.
the text No. 710. Corduso, Cordusio (curia ducis) = Cordus in the
Moro it was the centre of the town. The persons here named were
1414.
1414.
Paul of Vannochio at Siena ... The upper chamber for the apostles.
1136
[6] Visconti carried away and his son killed. [Footnote 6: Visconti.
Chi fosse quel Visconte non sapremmo indovinare fra tanti di questo
nome. Arluno narra che allora atterrate furono le case de' Viconti,
lo stesso Cronista che per essersi rallegrati del ritorno del duca
il Moro, alla cui fuga la casa sua fu pur messa a sacco da'
The Duke has lost the state, property and liberty and none of his
1415.
1137
Ambrosio Petri, St. Mark, 4 boards for the window, 2 ..., 3 the
1416.
1417.
Borges shall get for you the Archimedes from the bishop of Padua,
and Vitellozzo the one from Borgo a San Sepolcro [Footnote 3: Borgo
1418.
Marzocco's tablet.
1419.
1138
Marcello lives in the house of Giacomo da Mengardino.
1420.
1421.
1479, and Venice 1490.] the books of Avicenna Italian and Latin
1139
vocabulary; Messer Ottaviano Palavicino or his Vitruvius [Footnote
every Saturday to the hot bath where you will see naked men;
Niccolo della Croce; Inflate the lungs of a pig and observe whether
length.
Albertus, on heaven and earth [Footnote 15: See No. 1469, 1. 7.],
the heavens.
1140
[Footnote: Filosofia d'Aristotele see No. 1481 note.]
1422.
disparage the Ancients, who were the originators of grammar and the
1423.
house. On the same page is the date 1513 (see No. 1376).]
1424.
The figures you will have to reserve for the last book on shadows
that they may appear in the study of Gerardo the illuminator at San
Marco at Florence.
1141
scarcely possible to devine the meaning of the following sentence.
Sansoni 1879).
1425.
1426.
1427.
d thrust downwards.
[Footnote: The sketch on the same page as this text represents two
poles one across the other. At the ends of the longest are the
clearer.]
1142
1428.
The great bird will take its first flight;-- on the back of his
(compare p. 271).]
1429.
This stratagem was used by the Gauls against the Romans, and so
laid his sword in the scale when the tribute was weighed.]
1430.
1431.
1143
1432.
Ask the wife of Biagio Crivelli how the capon nurtures and hatches
1433.
1434.
with the case, steel and fork and...., charcoal, boards, and paper,
and chalk and white, and wax;.... .... for glass, a saw for bones
with fine teeth, a chisel, inkstand ........ three herbs, and Agnolo
mostrare, prese una penna (percioche in quel tempo il lapis non era
in uso) e con tal leggiadria gli dipinse una mano ecc. The incident
1144
is of the year l496.--Lapis means pencil, and chalk (matita).
Between lines 7 and 8 are the texts given as Nos. 819 and No. 7.]
1435.
1436.
MEMORARDUM.
of his life are known. The title of his principal work is:
1145
There are sketches by the side of lines 8 and 10.] lathe and have
taken the stone,--out leave the books belonging to Messer Andrea the
German,-- make scales of a long reed and weigh the substance when
hot and again when cold. The mirror of Master Luigi; A b the flow
1437.
1438.
1439.
Giovanni Argimboldi.
1146
1440.
Colours, formula,--Archimedes,--Marcantonio.
1441.
1442.
science.
1443.
VI.]
1444.
1147
Pandolfino's book [Footnote 1: Pandolfino, Agnolo, of Florence. It
probable that Leonardo should have meant this work by the words il
sharp knife,--Spectacles,--fractions....,
world which Giovanni Benci has [Footnote 25: Leonardo here probably
alludes to the map, not executed by him (See p. 224), which is with
1148
of Giovanni Benci,--a print, the districts about Milan--Market book.
Get the Friar di Brera to show you [the book] 'de Ponderibus'
Brera, now Palazzo delle Scienze ed Arti. Until 1571 it was the
Jesuits.
night,--
1149
On proportions by Alchino, with notes by Marliano, from Messer
Fazio,--
Frenchman,--
The measurement of the canal, locks and supports, and large boats;
1150
Try to get Vitolone, which is in the library at Pavia [Footnote 26:
After the victory of Novara in April 1500, Louis XII had it conveyed
explain the repairs and the costs, and a lock and a canal and a mill
works.
[Footnote 12: Sco Lorenzo. A church at Milan, see pp. 39, 40 and
50.]
[Footnote 13. 24: Gruppi. See Vol. I p. 355, No. 600, note 9.]
families of Florence.]
1449.
1151
Francesco d'Antonio at Florence.
1450.
1498 this was pulled down to make room for the fine Palazzo built on
the Piazza San Firenze by Giuliano di San Gallo, which still exists.
1152
alive at the time of Leonardo's death. But Leonardo must have been
on intimate terms with the family till the end of his life, for in a
letter dated June 1. 1519, in which Fr. Melzi, writing from Amboise,
Florentine families.]
1451.
Pandolfino.
1452.
1453.
1153
youthful Marcantonio Colonna, who, like his brothers Prospero and
gave to him Frascati and made him a present of the palazzo he had
built, when Cardinal, near the church of Santi Apostoli which is now
251).]
1454.
the air. Compare No. 703.],-- Pandolfino's book, mortar [?],-- Small
phenomena,--
1154
Book from Maestro small box,--
Paolo Infermieri,--
hose,
Lac, .......,--
models,
for...,--the broken
Sansovino, the....
1462-1521. See VASARI, Vite (Vol. IV, p. 134 ed. Sansoni 1880)
1155
Filippo and Lorenzo [Footnote 17: Filippo e Lorenzo; probably the
bound,--Show the book to Serigatto,-- and get the rule of the clock
[Footnote 41: Possibly this refers to the clock on the tower of the
spectacles.
1455.
1156
Search in Florence for......
1456.
Bernardo da Ponte ... Val di Lugano ... many veins for anatomical
demonstration.
1457.
Vasari, which was exhibited in Florence at the time and which now
paper (read before the Royal Soc. of Literature, June 28, 1882) "On
the St. Anne of Leonardo da Vinci", has adduced proof that the
cartoon now in the Royal Academy was executed earlier at Milan. The
note here given, which is written on the sheet containing the study
1157
not any opening here for discussing this question of the cartoon, it
writing in this note does not confirm the opinion hitherto held that
the Royal Academy cartoon was the one described by Vasari, but, on
1458.
della Maddalena. July 22.] day, 1490, aged 10 years. The second day
I had two shirts cut out for him, a pair of hose, and a jerkin, and
when I put aside some money to pay for these things he stole 4
lire the money out of the purse; and I could never make him
obstinate, glutton.
The day after, I went to sup with Giacomo Andrea, and the said
Giacomo supped for two and did mischief for four; for he brake 3
cruets, spilled the wine, and after this came to sup where I ....
1158
Che stava con meco. We may infer from this that he left the master
shortly after this, his term of study having perhaps expired.] who
was living with me, 4 lire this being of silver; and he took it
from his studio, and when the said Marco had searched for it a long
was arranging the festival for his jousting, and certain footmen
having undressed to try on some costumes of wild men for the said
festival, Giacomo went to the purse of one of them which lay on the
bed with other clothes, 2 lire 4 S, and took out such money as was
in it.
Item: when I was in the same house, Maestro Agostino da Pavia gave
Item: again, on the 2nd April, Giovan Antonio [Footnote 16: Giovan
point on a drawing of his, Giacomo stole it, and this was of the
1159
The first year-
A cloak, 2 lire,
6 shirts, 4 lire,
3 jerkins, 6 lire,
A cap, 1 lira,
laces, 1 lira.
loss he and others incurred through Giacomo but of the wild tricks
of the youth, and we may therefore assume that the note was not made
1459.
Thursday the 27th day of September Maestro Tommaso came back and
worked for himself until the last day but one of February. On the
1160
On the 6th day of October.
1460.
fire-tongs 15 days work. Then he worked for himself till the 27th
May, and worked for me at a lever till the 18th July; then for
himself till the 7th of August, and for one day, on the fifteenth,
for a lady. Then again for me at 2 locks until the 20th of August.
1461.
March 1494, Galeazzo came to live with me, agreeing to pay 5 lire a
month for his cost paying on the l4th day of each month.
1462.
1494.
1161
1463.
Saturday morning the 3rd of August 1504 Jacopo the German came to
live with me in the house, and agreed with me that I should charge
1464.
1511. On the 26th of September Antonio broke his leg; he must rest
40 days.
1465.
I left Milan for Rome on the 24th day of September, 1513, with
less known pupil Giovan Pietrino (see No. 1467, 5).], Francesco di
1162
[Footnote 4: Lorenzo. See No. 1351, l. 10 (p. 408). Amoretti gives
a MS. marked S, in quarto. This MS. seems to have vanished and left
no trace behind; Amoretti himself had not seen it, but copied from a
sculptor Lorenzetto was born in 1490. Amoretti has been led by the
Cotesto Lorenzo, che poi gli fu sempre compagno, almeno sin che
Vinci (?).
1466.
1163
Benedetto came on the 17th of October; he stayed with me two months
and 8 dinari; he had of this 26 lire and 8 soldi, and there remains
and stayed with me 3 months and 24 days, and earned 59 lire 14 soldi
Benedetto, 24 grossoni.
of the second is scarcely legible. The year is not given. The note
date when the note was registered, January 3d, and the observations
that follow refer to events of the previous month 'of last year'
beginning in the month of March (see Vol. I, No. 4, note 2). He must
learn how to date the beginning of the year in all the notes written
1164
prescegliere lo stile che era in uso a Firenze. (Ricerche, p. 84,
note.)]
1467.
Gian Maria 4,
Benedetto 4,
Salai 3,
Bartolomeo 3,
Gherardo 4.
1468.
Salai, 20 lire,
Bonifacio, 2 lire,
Bartolomeo, 4 lire,
1469.
1165
Venetia a corni. 2 augusto. 1484. fu imposto fine ala presente
opera." Segn. a--p. quaderni. V'ha pero un' altra opera simile di
1166
Potrebbe essere una traduzione del poema latino (Liber lapidum seu
'Lapidary',
mine. After the much regretted death of the elder Marchese, his son,
with the initials G. d'A. are prints from the valuable notes in that
1167
publication, the MS. additions I have marked. I did not however
enumerated.]
The first decade, [5] 'On the preservation of health', The third
decade, [6] Ciecho d'Ascoli, The fourth decade, [7] Albertus Magnus,
questo stesso libro, ms. (G. D'A.)] 'On the immortality of the
soul,
1168
Guido [Footnote 13: Forse "la Historia Trojana Guidonis" od il
Gerbert.
francese.--
Driadeo,
Morgante [Footnote 15: Una delle edizioni del Morgante impresse nel
1169
secolo XV, ecc.--
D'A.)]
1170
in Europa. (G. D'A.)]
alchune additione cavate del testo & istorie de la Bibia & del libro
1171
Sphere, [Footnote 22: "Jo: de Sacrobusto," o "Goro Dati," o
(G. D'A.)]
The Jests of Poggio, [Footnote 23: Tre edizioni delle facezie del
Poggio abbiamo in lingua italiana della fine del secolo XV, tutte
composizione del testo, non a quello della stampa del volume benche
Bologna per Ugo di Rugerii," in-40, del secolo XV. Altra edizione di
1172
Five books out of this list are noted by Leonardo in another MS.
1470.
ancienne edition qui reunisse ces trois auteurs est celle de Parme,
1471.
Maffeo;--there for seven years the earth rises and for seven years
1472.
1173
See 'On Ships' Messer Battista, and Frontinus 'On Acqueducts'
1473.
Anaxagoras: Every thing proceeds from every thing, and every thing
becomes every thing, and every thing can be turned into every thing
elements.
1474.
1475.
circle. Hence Archimedes never squared any figure with curved sides.
1174
He squared the circle minus the smallest portion that the intellect
1476.
If any man could have discovered the utmost powers of the cannon, in
all its various forms and have given such a secret to the Romans,
with what rapidity would they have conquered every country and have
vanquished every army, and what reward could have been great enough
fail of being offered great rewards from these very Romans; and when
Syracuse was taken, diligent search was made for Archimedes; and he
being found dead greater lamentation was made for him by the Senate
and people of Rome than if they had lost all their army; and they
did not fail to honour him with burial and with a statue. At their
in the ruins of a temple. So Cato had the temple restored and the
said that he was not so proud of any thing he had done as of having
[Footnote: Where Leonardo found the statement that Cato had found
1175
and restored the tomb of Archimedes, I do not know. It is a merit
that Cicero claims as his own (Tusc. V, 23) and certainly with a
according to the passage in Cicero, the grave was not found 'nelle
1477.
1478.
given time, the same force will move half the same body twice as far
1479.
1176
Aristotle in Book 3 of the Ethics: Man merits praise or blame solely
1480.
1481.
1482.
Avicenna will have it that soul gives birth to soul as body to body,
1177
[Footnote: Avicenna, see too No. 1421, 1. 2.]
1483.
Avicenna on liquids.
1484.
death.]
1485.
1486.
CORNELIUS CELSUS.
1178
The highest good is wisdom, the chief evil is suffering in the body.
which the first is the better, the body is the inferior; wisdom
belongs to the better part, and the chief evil belongs to the worse
part and is the worst of all. As the best thing of all in the soul
bodily pain is the chief evil, wisdom is the chief good of the soul,
that is with the wise man; and nothing else can be compared with it.
eight Books 'De Medicina', are preserved. The earliest editions are:
and 1497.]
1487.
Demetrius was wont to say that there was no difference between the
speech and words of the foolish and ignorant, and the noises and
the noise issued; whether their lower parts or their mouth, since
1179
1488.
Euclid De Ponderibus.
1489.
By the first we define the lesser [magnitude] and by the second the
1490.
1180
1491.
Hippocrates says that the origin of men's sperm derives from the
brain, and from the lungs and testicles of our parents, where the
final decocture is made, and all the other limbs transmit their
Leonardo's death.]
1492.
Lucretius in his third [book] 'De Rerum Natura'. The hands, nails
They also use for a standard a bunch of grass tied to a pole (167).
and in 1515, and at Florence in 1515. The numbers 165 and 167 noted
but if so, none of the editions just mentioned can here be meant,
1493.
1181
Ammianus Marcellinus asserts that seven hundred thousand volumes of
Cesar.
1494.
Mondino says that the muscles which raise the toes are in the
outward side of the thigh, and he adds that there are no muscles in
the back [upper side] of the feet, because nature desired to make
them light, so as to move with ease; and if they had been fleshy
"1498," con fig. Queste figure per altro non sono, come si e
1182
Gregoriis, 1491, in-fol., contengonsi intagli in legno (si vogliono
edizione del "fasciculus" del 1491, sta fra nostri libri e potrebbe
D'A.)]
1495.
[Footnote: A 3-5 are written on the margin at the side of the title
1496.
Pelacano.
1497.
1183
1498.
warfare he ordered that the ships should have tall masts, and that
1115.] of 40 feet long and one third of a foot thick. At one end of
this was a small grappling iron and at the other a counterpoise; and
there was also attached 12 feet of chain; and, at the end of this
chain, as much rope as would reach from the chain to the base of the
top, where it was fixed with a small rope; from this base it ran
down to the bottom of the mast where a very strong spar was attached
and to this was fastened the end of the rope. But to go on to the
use of his machine; I say that below this grappling iron was a fire
[Footnote 14: Compare No. 1128.] which, with tremendous noise, threw
down its rays and a shower of burning pitch; which, pouring down on
the [enemy's] top, compelled the men who were in it to abandon the
top to which the grappling-iron had clung. This was hooked on to the
edges of the top and then suddenly the cord attached at the base of
the top to support the cord which went from the grappling iron, was
cut, giving way and drawing in the enemy's ship; and if the
1184
mentioned cannot be explained. Leonardo seems to quote here from a
the sources from which this story may have been derived.]
1499.
Theophrastus on the ebb and flow of the tide, and of eddies, and on
the phenomenon of the ebb and flow of the tide and none of them
wrote about it. The movement of the waters in the Euripus however
1500.
1501.
Messer Vincenzio Aliprando, who lives near the Inn of the Bear, has
1502.
1185
Vitruvius says that small models are of no avail for ascertaining
the effects of large ones; and I here propose to prove that this
with only double the exertion of the man's strength, but needs much
1503.
cause the superficies of a body of the same form but twice as large
1504.
ACCIDENT.
the wheels which move vehicles, extended over many Stadia the lines
1186
of the circumferences of the circles of these wheels. He became
aware of them by the animals that moved the vehicles. But he did not
1505.
Virgil says that a blank shield is devoid of merit because among the
1506.
1187
note de Maximilien Curtze, professeur a Thorn', ove sono descritti i
citata due volte da Paolo Lomazzo nel Trattato dell' arte della
113. 114).]
1188
1507.
San Marco (See Indagini Storiche ... per cura di G. D'A. Parte
I, p. 97).]
1508.
1509.
1189
On the 28th day of April I received from the Marchesino 103 lire and
1510.
-----------------------------
1. 811 in all
1511.
1512.
The hall towards the court is 126 paces long and 27 braccia wide.
1513.
1190
The cornice beneath that, being one for each picture, lire 7, and
for the cost of blue, gold, white, plaster, indigo and glue 3 lire;
time 3 days.
each.
I calculate the cost for smalt, blue and gold and other colours at 1
1/2 lire.
1514.
time, 4 days
1191
item for 24 pictures of Roman history 14 lire each
1515.
1516.
1517.
1192
How many braccia high is the level of the walls?--
123 braccia
30 ducats.
lining S 16
making S 8
to Salai S 3
a jasper ring S 13
a sparkling stone S 11
to Caterina S 10
1193
to Caterina S 10
1518.
conduit lire 10
S.K.M.II.2 4a]
1519.
Parsley 10 parts
mint 1 part
1194
thyme 1 part
Vinegar ... and a little salt two pieces of canvas for Salai.
mention of Salai, and the last is of the year 1513 (see No. 1465,
3). From the various notes in the MSS. he seems to have been
point.]
1520.
1521.
The cistern ... at the Hospital, --2 ducats, --beans, --white maize,
1195
1522.
To the senior 8 S
106 S
The doctor 2 S
120 S
1523.
1196
4 braccia of silver cloth l. 15 S 4
binding l.-- S 9
loops l.-- S 12
the making l. 1 S 5
stitching
1524.
1525.
carried them to him and gave them into his own hand, and he said he
Memorandum. That on the same day I paid to Salai 3 gold ducats which
1197
Memorandum. That I gave Salai 21 braccia of cloth to make a shirt,
at 10 soldi the braccio, which I gave him on the 20th day of April
1503.
read; see Zeitschrift fur Bild. Kunst, 1879, p. 155), and Vasari,
1526.
1198
Saturday morning 1 florin to Tommaso.
To Salai, 1 florin.
1199
Sunday, the 4th of August, 1 florin.
Friday, the 9th day of August 1504, I took 10 ducats out of the box.
1527.
... [3] on Friday the 9th day of August fifteen grossoni that is fl.
the workman to spend; that is on the day of our Lady's birth. On the
who is there mentioned. The first words of these lines are very
illegible.]
1200
1528.
1529.
Memorandum of the money I have had from the King as my salary from
July 1508 till April next 1509. First 100 scudi, then 70, then 50,
1530.
Saturday the 2nd day of March I had from Santa Maria Novella 5 gold
ducats, leaving 450. Of these I gave 2 the same day to Salai, who
Firenze, 1872, pp. 164, 165, 218 and 219. The date here given by
1531.
1201
the same Thursday in the morning I gave to Salai 22 soldi for the
expenses.
1532.
To Salai 4 grossoni, and for one braccio of velvet, 5 lire, and 1/2;
viz. 10 soldi for loops of silver; Salai 14 soldi for binding, the
1533.
1534.
To Salai S 42
2 dozen of laces S 8
for papers S 3 d 8
a pair of shoes S 14
for velvet S 14
1202
a sword and knife S 21
to the barber S 11
1535.
On Friday morning,
bread S.. d
wine S.. d
grapes S.. d
mushrooms S.. d
fruit S.. d
1203
bran S.. d
1536.
1537.
1538.
46 soldi 12 grossoni.
1539.
For paper S 18
for canvas S 30
1204
for paper S 10 d 19
Total S 73
1540.
20 pounds of German
2 pounds of cinnabar at
6 pounds of green at S 12
4 pounds of yellow at S 12
1 pound of minium at S 8
1205
4 pounds of ... at S 2
6 pounds of ochre at S 1
for 20 lire 2 S 0 d
58
1541.
Two large hatchets and one very small one, 8 brass spoons, 4
1206
tablecloths, 2 towels, 15 small napkins, 2 coarse napkins, 2 coarse
1542.
Bed 7 0 S
ring 7 0
crockery 2 5
gardener 1 2
..... 2 8
porters 2 1
glasses 1
fuel 3 6
a lock 1
1543.
1207
New tin-ware 3 pairs of sheets
4 bowls,
3 square stones,
2 small bowls,
1 large bowl,
1 platter,
4 candlesticks,
1 small candlestick.
1544.
Hose S 40
straw S 60
wheat S 42
wine S 54
bread S 18
meat S 54
eggs S 5
1208
salad S 3
the Barber S 2 d 6
horses S1
1545.
Sunday
meat S 10 d
wine S 12 d
bran S 5d4
herbs S 10 d
buttermilk S 4 d 4
melon S 3d
bread S 3d1
Monday S 9 8
..... S 6d
wine S 12 d
bran S 9d4
buttermilk S 4 d 4
herbs S 8d
Tuesday S d
1209
meat S 0d8
wine S 12 d
bread S 3d
meal S 5d4
herbs S 8d
Wednesday
wine S 5d
melon S 2d
meal S 5d4
vegetables S 8
1546.
1210
success(ores) cujus similiter officium ministratus qui
something, which had to be proved, has been proved. The rest of the
1547.
pass and does not grow in virtue, the more I think of it the more I
for gain. Good fortune is valueless to him who knows not toil. The
without great suffering. Our glories and our triumphs pass away.
Foul lust, and dreams, and luxury, and sloth have banished every
virtue from the world; so that our Nature, wandering and perplexed,
has almost lost the old and better track. Henceforth it were well to
rouse thyself from sleep. The master said that lying in down will
not bring thee to Fame; nor staying beneath the quilts. He who,
1211
himself on earth than wind-blown smoke, or the foam upon the sea.
[Footnote: From the last sentence we may infer that this text is by
the hand of a pupil of Leonardo's.-- On the same sheet are the notes
1548.
to Mona Margarita S 62 d 4
clothes S 13
good beef S 4
eggs S 6
velvet S 12
wine S 6d4
meat S 4
mulberries S 2d4
mushrooms S 3d4
salad S 1
fruit S 1d4
candles S 3
... S 1
flour S 2
1212
Sunday 198 8
bread S 6
wine S 9d4
meat S 7
soup S 2
fruit S 3d4
candles S 3d
Monday 31
bread S 6d4
meat S 10 d 8
wine S 9d4
fruit S 4
soup S 1d8
32
1549.
Tuesday
bread S 6
meat S 11
1213
wine S 7
fruit S 9
soup S 2
salad S 1
[Footnote 1548 and 1549: On the same sheet is the text No. 1015 in Leonardo's
own handwriting.]
1550.
To Monna Margarita S 5
to Tomaso S 14
to Monna Margarita d 5S 2
payment d 13 S 2 d 4
of Monna Margarita
altogether d 14 S 5 d 4
1551.
spend, Friday d 7.
1214
given as No. 1549.]
1552.
at S. Apostoli.
1553.
and waits for time, will lose his friends and his money.
1554.
brother about this business, and I made him satisfied with the
that I had from the parties and I say that between us there is no
1555.
1215
Of things seen through a mist that which is nearest its farthest
limit will be least visible, and all the more so as they are more
remote.
1556.
1557.
Either you say Hesperia alone, and it will mean Italy, or you add
[Footnote: The notes in Greek, Nos. 1557, 1558 and 1562 stand in
close connection with each other, but the meaning of some words is
1558.
1559.
sisters and cousin I herewith inform you that thanks to God I am ...
about the sword which I ... bring it to Maso at the piazza ... and I
1216
will settle the business of Piero so that ...
[Footnote: AMORETTI, Mem. Stor. XXIV, quotes the first three lines
does not favour this hypothesis, and still less the contents. I
1560.
Hujus quam cernis nomen Lucretia, Divi Omnia cui larga contribuere
manu. Rara huic forma data est; pinxit Leonardos, amavit Maurus,
1217
Naturam, ac superas hac laesit imagine Divas Pictor: tantum hominis
posse manum haec doluit, Illae longa dari tam magnae tempera formae,
1561.
Lyons.].
AMORETTI gave it, Mem. Star. XXV: A Monsieur Lyonard Peintre du Roy
pour Amboyse. He says too that this address is of the year 1509,
XII ... Pour conclure je crois qu'il n'est pas prouve que Leonard de
Vinci n'ait pas fait un voyage de quelques mois en France sous Louis
1218
this explanation is the right one, it can be easily explained by the
contents of Nos. 1350 and 1529. The note, line 1, was perhaps added
same sheet some geometrical explanations. I must also point out that
the statement that this sheet belongs to the year 1509 has
[6] Amboise.
1562.
1563.
1564.
1565.
1219
XVI C. 6 de Ciuitate Dei, se Antipodes.
1566.
Leonardo's Will.
death and the uncertainty of its time, has acknowledged and declared
in the said court and before us that he has made, according to the
last will, as follows. And first he commends his soul to our Lord,
Almighty God, and to the Glorious Virgin Mary, and to our lord Saint
Michael, to all the blessed Angels and Saints male and female in
Paradise.
Saint Florentin at Amboise, and that his body shall be borne thither
1220
Item. That his body may be followed from the said place to the said
that is to say by the rector and the prior, or by their vicars and
friars of the place, and before his body shall be carried to the
said church this Testator desires, that in the said church of Saint
sub-deacon and that on the day when these three high masses are
Gregoire.
Item. That in the said church of Saint Denis similar services shall
be performed, as above.
Item. That the same shall be done in the church of the said friars
and all of the books the Testator is at present possessed of, and
a painter.
1221
Item. The same Testator gives and bequeaths henceforth for ever to
Battista de Vilanis his servant one half, that is the moity, of his
garden which is outside the walls of Milan, and the other half of
Salai has built and constructed a house which shall be and remain
heirs and successors; and this is in remuneration for the good and
kind services which the said de Vilanis and Salai, his servants have
Item. The said Testator gives to Maturina his waiting woman a cloak
of good black cloth lined with fur, a ... of cloth and two ducats
which shall be borne by sixty poor men, to whom shall be given money
for carrying them; at the discretion of the said Melzo, and these
Item. The said Testator gives to each of the said churches ten lbs.
Item. That alms shall be given to the poor of the Hotel-Dieu, to the
1222
poor of Saint Lazare d'Amboise and, to that end, there shall be
given and paid to the treasurers of that same fraternity the sum and
Item. The said Testator gives and bequeaths to the said Messer
pension and the sums of money which are owing to him from the past
M. Johan Sapin, and each and every sum of money that he has already
received from the aforesaid Sapin of his said pension, and in case
he should die before the said Melzo and not otherwise; which moneys
to the said Melzo all and each of his clothes which he at present
the good and kind services done by him in past times till now, as
well as in payment for the trouble and annoyance he may incur with
And he orders and desires that the sum of four hundred scudi del
now living in Florence with all the interest and usufruct that may
have accrued up to the present time, and be due from the aforesaid
1223
hundred crowns, since they were given and consigned by the Testator
Item. He desires and orders that the said Messer Francesco de Melzo
shall be and remain the sole and only executor of the said will of
the said Testator; and that the said testament shall be executed in
its full and complete meaning and according to that which is here
narrated and said, to have, hold, keep and observe, the said Messer
these presents the said his heirs and successors with all his goods
moveable and immoveable present and to come, and has renounced and
which to that are contrary. Given at the said place of Cloux in the
personally and has sworn to us never to do nor say nor act in any
way to the contrary. And it is sealed by his request with the royal
faith.
1224
Given on the XXIIIrd day of April MDXVIII, before Easter.
of water which the King Louis XII, of pious memory lately deceased
ever in such wise and manner that the said gentleman made him this
and in mine.
And on the aforesaid day in the said month of April in the said year
MDXVIII the same M. Leonardo de Vinci by his last will and testament
his house at present at the said place of Cloux, in the event of the
1225